* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download Unit I: Introduction to Economic Concepts - AP
Survey
Document related concepts
Transcript
AP Government and Economics 2010-11 Reader Introduction First: I’d like to congratulate you at reaching this point, only the most dedicated student even attempt to take an AP class. Hopefully this class will be intellectually rewarding, interesting, and at times even fun. Second: Don’t panic! This booklet is designed to cover the whole year. If you were given most of your assignments for any class, it might seem overwhelming. I’ve created this booklet so that you can get ahead, but more importantly so you can plan your time well. I know that you will have other classes and activities; this is my attempt to give you a way to manage your time effectively. Third For those of you who apply for the ACE program for the Second Semester, at the time of creating this reader, I haven’t quite decided what the additional assignment will be, but don’t worry, it will come to me! Fourth: You can write in this book, it’s yours. You can underline important passages, make corrections as needed and make notes in the margins. For the readings, because they are primary sources, spelling was left as it was originally written, but that doesn’t mean everything is perfect. Fifth: Don’t get over confident. This is not “everything” that you will be doing this year. You will also be reading, completing some small assignments, taking notes, reviewing your material, and just plain studying for quizzes and exams. Additionally, if time is short, I may modify an assignment listed in this reader, especially with the changing nature of a school day, who knows when we may have a fire drill or a rally to interrupt our perfect plan. Syllabus Abbreviation Key Wilson - The APGOV Textbook Course Unit Topics General Assignments Assignments Multiple Choice Hints FRQ Rubric In Class Debates Study Guides and Notes Prompted Essay Assignment Summer Assignment Semester Bridge Assignment Online Class Component Unit I- Constitutional Underpinning of the U.S. Government. Assessments Chapter 1 Exam- Multiple Choice and 1 FRQ Exam Chapter 2 (25 multiple choice questions 1 FRQ) Section 1 Unit Exam Chapter 1,2, 3 Multiple Choice and FRQ Chapter One Study Guide Basic Politics Simulation Chapter Two Study Guide Chapter Three Study Guide Plato- The Cave Locke- Two Treaties AntiFederalist #84 Federalist #51 Federalist #10 Beard- Framing the Constitution Lawrence and Dorf- How not to read the Constitution McCulloch v. Maryland United States v. Lopez Unit II-Political Beliefs and Behaviors Unit II Exam Ch 4, 5 & 6Multiple Choice and FRQs Chapter Four Study Guide Opinion Poll Project Chapter Five Study Guide Chapter Six Study Guide Tocqueville- Democracy in America Brooks- One Nation Slightly Divisible Unit III- Political Parties, Elections Unit III Exam Ch 7 & 8Multiple Choice Chapter Seven Study Guide Chapter Eight Study Guide Election Project Jefferson- A Profession of Political Faith Unit IV- Interest Groups and Media Unit IV Exam- Chapters 9 & 10- Three FRQ’s Chapter Nine Study Guide Interest Group Project Chapter Ten Study Guide Reform the Media Project Fallows- Why Americans Hate the Media Page Unit V- Branches of GovernmentPart A Congress Chapter 11 ExamMultiple Choice and One FRQ Study Guide for Chapter 11 Article on Congress Essay Mock Legislation Simulation Burke- Speech to the Electors of Bristol Ellwood- In Praise of Pork Riedl- Nine Thousand Earmarks Starobin- Pork a Time Honored Tradition Unit V- Branches of GovernmentPart B -The Presidency and the Bureaucracy Chapter 12 and 13 Exam Multiple Choice and Two FRQs Chapter 12 Study Guide Chapter 13 Study Guide Neustadt- Presidential Power and the Modern President Weber- Bureaucracy Unit V- Branches of GovernmentPart C- The Judiciary Unit V Exam- Multiple Choice Chapter 14 Study Guide Supreme Court Writing Assignment Scalia- Liberty and Abortion; A Strict Constructionist’s View Unit VI- Policy Making Economic, Foreign and Social Policy Not an error- Ch 20 is grouped in the Policy unit Not an error- Ch 21 is grouped in the Policy unit Unit Exam Multiple Choice and FRQs Chapter 15 Study Guide Chapter 16 Study Guide Chapter 17 Study Guide Chapter 20 Study Guide Chapter 21 Study Guide Public Policy Project Will- Why Didn’t Bush Ask Congress? Easterbrook- Some Convenient Truths Unit VII- Civil Liberties and Civil Rights Unit IX Exam Ch 18 & 19Multiple Choice and FRQs Chapter 18 Study Guide Chapter 19 Study Guide Supreme Decisions- Civil Rights Project Williams- Proposition 209 APGOV Multiple Choice (45 minutes for 60 questions) 1. Don't panic if you come across difficult questions. The test is supposed to have some very hard questions so they can tell the difference between more and less prepared students. 2. Use at least two go-throughs on the test. On you first run answer only the questions you are sure of. Then go back and do the other you didn’t know. Often times you will get hints or your memory will be jogged by the questions you did know. 3. Circle EXCEPT questions so you can remind yourself you are looking for a FALSE statement for the answer. 4. Do not change an answer unless you are sure it is wrong. Make sure erasers are clear. 5. If a multiple choice question is left blank, no points are deducted. Since a quarter of a point is deducted for incorrect answers, students should avoid making random guesses. Students may benefit from educated guesses though. 6. You can and should make marks on the multiple choice test itself in order to keep track of the choices that they have eliminated.You can write on the test, but not on the answer sheet. 7. Keep your eye on the clock. You have 45 minutes to answer 60 questions. If you have additional time, double check your answers. Free-Response (1 hour 45 minutes – 4 questions). For the AP exam this section accounts for 50% of your overall score. There are four questions – you must answer all four – which count equally. Because the free-response questions are open-ended, this is your opportunity to demonstrate your broad understanding of U.S. government and politics. You will be asked to analyze some of the basic concepts that form the foundation of the American political system. Most questions will ask you to characterize relationships among various political institutions, their responsibilities, and the consequences of their actions. Some questions will ask you to analyze both sides of an issue. You will see directives like analyze, assess, evaluate, examine, and discuss. This means that knowing facts is not enough. You must be able to use facts to construct a thorough and intelligent response. 1. Understand the Question: READ IT!!! Read and then reread the question for clarity. If it helps, rephrase the question for clarity. Look for key words such as who, what, when, why, argue argument, explain, and discuss. Know what the question is asking you. If you are asked to discuss the change in federalism over time, you won’t get full credit for simply defining federalism. The rest of the answer involves your interpretation of federalism changing through court cases, new policy, etc. READ THE QUESTION CORRECTLY. 2. Identify the question type There are generally three types of questions on the exam. The verbs which the question uses will tell you what kind of question is being asked I. Write about the meaning of a concept. Key verbs: define, describe, identify, list, state, summarize. II. Write about both sides of an issue or recognize similarities and differences. You don’t need a full thesis statement to answer these questions because your not asked to take a position and argue for it, however, you do need an organizing statement to orient the reader to the answer. Key verbs: compare, contrast, discuss, explain, and illustrate. III. Write about a position and argue for a specific point of view. A thesis statement is require for this type of question. Key verbs: analyze, argue, and interpret. 3. Which path do I take? Often times, FRQ’s will ask you to come up with several concepts and then to elaborate on them. They might ask for “two reasons” or “three examples.” However, there is often 7 or 8 possible right answers. Therefore, before you write, make a list of all possible answers that you know could work. Then, choose the ones that you feel most comfortable writing about. HINT – AP readers do not penalize you for wrong answers, only missing answers. Therefore, if they ask for “two examples,” then give three examples because it will give you another possibility of getting points if your other answers missed the mark.. Aim for three pieces of supporting evidence in your response. Three examples are just enough to prove your point. Any more than this will read too much like a list and will detract from your essay and could cost you points. 4. Do I need an introduction? Does the question ask you to take a position? If so, take one. Don’t sit in the middle, argue one side because they don’t care which side you argue. They only care that your argument works. ONLY WRITE AN INTRO IF THEY ASK YOU TO TAKE A DEFINITE STAND. Introductions in an other situation is a waste of time. 5. Format? Formulate and outline. Some questions are multiple-portioned and it will help to formulate an outline in order to properly answer the entire question. Answers to some questions, even if they are multiple-portioned, might be answered better in a more traditional format, with each paragraph addressing a piece of evidence. It may help to use this basic outline format: Paragraph 1: your position or interpretation of the given information. Paragraph 2: your first piece of evidence and any supporting details. (The details can be in bullet form) Paragraph 3: your second piece of evidence and any supporting details. Paragraph 4: your third piece of evidence and any supporting details. Paragraph 5: summary of your points and restatement of your position. The example below is a good way to think about answering most FRQs. It is very mechanical in that you number your answers, and it is also easy on the reader, which they will appreciate. ALWAYS WRITE LEGIBLY IN BLUE OR BLACK PEN. Sample Response from the 2005 Exam Question: Explain how two factors keep the United States Supreme Court from deviating too far from public opinion. (AP accepted 6 possible answers) 1. Presidents nominate Supreme Court justices so they can’t deviate too far from public opinion. Since the president is elected, the general public shares his opinion on a lot of issues. When there is an opening on the court, the President wants to make a choice that the people agree with, especially if he plans to run for reelection. If he nominates a person who deviates too far from public opinion, there will be a backlash in his approval ratings. 2. Supreme Court rulings can be overruled with new laws or constitutional amendments so they can’t deviate too far from public opinion. The members of Congress are responsible to the people, so they must guarantee that law follows public opinion if they hope to be reelected. 6. Re-read your answers Students always are in a rush to turn in their tests, but if you have to sit in the room for 100 minutes anyway, why not re-read your answers? Each question is scored independently. Therefore, you will not be able to “make up” points on questions that you feel you did not answer well by overcompensating. Go back and make sure you answered each question fully. If you did not, you can write more at the end, and then draw an arrow to the appropriate place where the information belongs. General Tips Give concrete examples. Specific examples of your answers help solidify your answers. Answer all part of the question. Exam graders will reward students for more for answering all parts of the question than for doing well on only one part. Understand what you are being asked before you start writing. Don’t panic and start making things up. It is better to just make a brainstorm list and you might get lucky and stumble across a right answer. Do’s and Don’ts of the FRQ Do’s Write as neatly as possible. If they can’t read it, they can’t grade it. Neatly draw a line through a mistake, write correct information above. Read the question. Then read the question again. Make sure you’re answering only what is being asked. Reread your work if you have time. Make sure you LINK THE QUESTION TO THE ANSWER! There is no penalty for wrong information, so write as much as you can. If they ask for two examples, give three. Use the EXACT VOCABULARY from the question in each component of your answer. Most rubrics ask for linkage back to the question. This is the sure fire way to move in that direction. Don’ts 1. Don’t give personal opinions (like your political affiliation or whether you like the president’s policy). The exam tests your knowledge of political process, not opinion. 2. Don’t give long, unnecessary introductions, get right to the point. 3. Don’t give information they didn’t ask for. There are no extra credit or “brownie” points. 4. Don’t spend more than 25 minutes on any free response question. 5. Don’t fall asleep. Fight the fatigue. Time is generally not a factor. Do not look back and think about how you wasted it because your were tired, bored, or indifferent. Bring a strong peppermint to the test. This will jolt you awake, and stimulate your senses. Scoring and Credit The raw scores of the exam are converted into the following five-point scale: 5 - Extremely well qualified 4 – Well qualified 3 – Qualified 2 – Possibly qualified 1 – No recommendation FRQ Rubric Points given will be indicated on the left, and the reasoning behind the points circled on the chart below. Points 5 4 3 2 1 0 AP Rating 9-8 7-6 5-4 3-2 1 0 Thesis Organization Balance Analysis Evidence Errors Superior thesis Explicit and fully responsive to the question. Extremely wellorganized- Essay organization is clear, consistently followed, and effective in support of the argument Addresses all areas of the prompt evenly. If the question requires multiple arguments. at least three ideas are all covered at some length Excellent use of analysis to support thesis and main ideas. All major assertions in the essay are supported by at least three specific ideas, events, or individuals being used as relevant evidence Extremely wellwritten essay Strong thesis Explicit and responsive to the question, contains general analysis Well-organized essay – Essay organization is clear, effective in support of the argument, but not consistently followed, tends to generalize. Addresses all areas of the prompt; may lack some balance between major areas. Strong analysis in most areas; needs more detail. All major assertions in the essay are supported by more than one specific ideas, events, or individuals being used as relevant evidence Well-written essay Most of the major assertions in the essay are supported by at least one specific ideas, events, or individuals being used as relevant evidence Good Essay Only one or two specific ideas, events, or individuals are mentioned, but little to no use as relevant evidence Adequate Essay, but is somewhat incomplete (too short) Essay is incomplete Little to no relevant facts No specific ideas, events, or individuals are mentioned or used. No analysis No evidence Clear thesisThesis is explicit, but not fully responsive to the question, tends to stylistically wander before reaching the core argument to be addressed. Organization is clear, consistently followed, but not effective Underdeveloped Thesis- Thesis that merely repeats/ paraphrases the prompt Organization is unclear and ineffective, tends to jump chronologically. No discernable attempt at a thesis No discernable organization; stylistically wanders and jumps chronologically. Little to no effort shown Thesis is off topic. If the question requires multiple arguments at least three ideas suggested by the prompt are covered at least briefly Essay shows some imbalance; there is a discussion of ideas, but generalized arguments. Some important information left out Contains some analysis; much more detail is needed. Important information left out. Essay shows serious imbalance, If the question requires multiple arguments. less than three specific ideas, events, or individuals being used are discussed, and only briefly. Only one or no arguments are mentioned No arguments mentioned Lacks analysis of key issues Most major events omitted No analysis ____ Introduction contains vague or “wasted” sentences ____ Essay contains vague statements or generalizations not supported by facts. ____ Essay attempted to tell a story rather than relaying facts. ____ Essay attempted to validate your personal opinion, rather than answering the prompt. ____ Don’t use “I” or “my” statements ____ Don’t connect issues to “today” (unless asked) ____ Don’t use “flowery” or slang style writing ____ Poor spelling and grammar ____ Poor penmanship: essay difficult to read The errors that exist do not detract from the argument May contain an error that detracts from the argument such as the wrong chronology, associating the ideas of one figure with another. Contains a few errors that detract from the argument, Contains several errors that detract from the argument, Contains numerous errors that detract from the argument Completely incorrect or not turned in. OBJECTIVE: Students in this AP section are required to deliver a formal debate to their class. This requirement may be met by an individual debate (one-on-one), 2v2, or 3v3. Each student will be required to address the class for a period of at least 4-7 minutes. During this time the students will debate issues relating to US Government. GRADING THE DEBATE: SEE ATTACHED STRUCTURE AND CONTENT OF THE FORMAL DEBATE: Students will be divided into two teams; an affirmative team, that will debate/defend the resolution and a negative team that will oppose the resolution. Each side will research their position gathering facts, data, and other information to their position. Students will be encouraged to use a variety of sources including information from the library, public institutions (public libraries, local universities), and the internet. The structure of the debate is as follows: 5 minutes Affirmative Original Construction of the argument: During this time period the affirmative side will present the major arguments supporting the resolution based upon the research. Name: __________________ 4 Minutes Cross examination: During this period the Negative may ask the Affirmative questions of clarification. Name: __________________ 5 Minutes Negative Original Construction of the argument: During this period the Negative side will present the major arguments against the resolution based upon the research. Name: __________________ 4 Minutes Cross Examination: During this time the Affirmative may ask the Negative questions of clarification. Name: __________________ 4 Minutes Affirmative Rebuttal: During this time the Affirmative may challenge the validity of the Negative's original argument. This can be done by introducing information to counter the points made by the Negative side. Name: __________________ 5 Minutes Negative Rebuttal: During this period the Negative may offer information to counter any points brought up during Affirmative's original argument, defend points brought up during Negative's original argument, defend points raised by Affirmative rebuttal, and restate their original argument. Name: __________________ 1 Minute Affirmative Rebuttal: During this time period the Affirmative may rebuttal any of the Negative's major arguments and sum up their position. Name: __________________ Original Construction of Argument Speeches: Speeches will allow the Affirmative and Negative speakers to offer evidence in support of their position in addition to disprove the arguments offered by the opponent. In the original construction speech the student will research the resolution and create arguments in support of their position. HINTS: 1) 2-3 main points 3) Anticipate the other side 5) Talking is better than reading: personal experience 6) Strong opening and closing sentences 2) Have a road map 4) Quotes for support (but don’t overdo it) 7) USE note cards, do not read an ESSAY Rebuttal Speeches: Serve as an opportunity to clarify the issues presented in the debate and to question the evidence presented by the other side. This is best done by gathering information that rivals or contradicts the other side. The focus of a rebuttal speech should be only to address the information presented by the other side. No new topics should be introduced. Time Limits and Visual Aids: All time limits have an extended grace period of up to 15 seconds for each speech. This applies to speeches that go over the limit, not those that are too brief. There will be a 3-5 minute question and answer period following each debate to allow the class members or instructor to participate by questioning the speaker and/or discuss the information presented. Visual aids are optional but a good idea. The debates will be presented in front of the classroom, with the speakers standing when presenting and addressing the audience as well as the opponent. FORMAL ATTIRE IS REQUIRED! DEBATE TOPICS: To be completed over the course of the semester . Groups of no more than 3 students! Constitutional Underpinnings The Federal government has been devolving more power to the states. This trend is positive because it allows states to better meet the individual needs of their citizens. Political Beliefs and Behavior Low voter turnout among people threatens democracy in America. Because of political apathy among young people, their issues are not adequately addressed. Political Parties and Interest Groups Interest groups, PACs, and 527s have too much clout in shaping public policy. Multi-party political systems more effectively represent citizen interests than does the American two-party system. Institutions/Three Branches of Government The Supreme Court is too heavily influenced by politics. The United States should reduce the number of regulatory agencies, because they generate red tape, raise prices, and reduce competitiveness in the world market. Judicial review is undemocratic. It permits non-elected judges to decide whether or not a law is constitutional. It can frustrate the intentions of democratic governments by overruling the actions of elected officials. The president has become so powerful that there is no longer an effective balance of powers. Public Policy The Congressional committee system gives too much power to the majority party in setting the political agenda. As a result, the views of the minority party are ignored. Civil Liberties and Civil Rights— Affirmative Action programs are necessary to safeguard equal opportunity in both education and employment for minorities. In the interest of public safety, the Fourth Amendment rights of those under the age of 18 should be severely limited. Student Critique Form YOUR NAME:________________________________________________________ DEBATE TOPIC:______________________________________________________ TEAM BEING CRITIQUED:____________________________________________ Positive aspects of opening statement: How opening could have been improved: Were the questions clear and focused? Did they challenge the opponent's position? Did the debaters directly and persuasively respond to questions? Positive aspects of closing statement: How closing could have been improved: How effective was the use of statistics? How effective was the use of quotations? What would have improved this debate? What did these debaters do best? Debate Grade Sheet DEBATE TOPIC: POSITION/STANCE: TEAM BEING GRADED: 1. _________________________ 2. ___/15 OPENING STATEMENT TIME: ________ ___/10 DIRECT QUESTIONING TIME: ________ ___/15 CLOSING STATEMENT TIME: ________ ___/10 RESPONSE TO QUESTIONING ___/10 USE OF STATISTICS/QUOTATIONS ___/5 ENNUNCIATION, VOLUME, ETC. ___/5 DRESS AND APPEARANCE ___/70 Total 3. APGOV Study Guide and Note-taking Assignment For APGOV the college board has broken the course into six major themes: I. Constitutional Underpinnings of United States Government II. Political Beliefs and Behaviors III. Political Parties, Interest Groups, and Mass Media IV. Institutions of National Government V. Public Policy VI . Civil Rights and Civil Liberties Even though there are less major units than APUSH or APEH, there is still a great deal of information to learn for this course. This assignment will be the method you will use to organize the course content and how I will keep you accountable for keeping pace with the reading. I will check your notes on exam days. For each chapter, you will have a series of questions in a study guide. These study guides will be due on the day of the chapter or unit exam. In order to be efficient with our time in class, you will have to do some reading and notetaking at home. Here is the format for notes for APGOV. For most note taking, the typical Cornell note system follows this format: 1. Record: During the lecture, use the note taking column to record the lecture using telegraphic sentences. 2. Questions: As soon after class as possible, formulate questions based on the notes in the right-hand column. Writing questions helps to clarify meanings, reveal relationships, establish continuity, and strengthen memory. Also, the writing of questions sets up a perfect stage for exam-studying later. 3. Recite: Cover the note taking column with a sheet of paper. Then, looking at the questions or cue-words in the question and cue column only, say aloud, in your own words, the answers to the questions, facts, or ideas indicated by the cue-words. 4. Reflect: Reflect on the material by asking yourself questions, for example: “What’s the significance of these facts? What principle are they based on? How can I apply them? How do they fit in with what I already know? What’s beyond them? 5. Review: Spend at least ten minutes every week reviewing all your previous notes. If you do, you’ll retain a great deal for current use, as well as, for the exam. For the notes that I give you in class, or my powerpoints via the web page, they should be written on the right hand side of your note sheet as you would on typical Cornell notes. For the left hand side however, I would like you to “Enhance” your notes. What I am looking for, is that you go through the chapter and that you add anything I may have missed, specficially incorporating the list of terms included on each study guide. Most of the terms are included in the chapter, but others are not. These terms become important for two major reasons: 1. They serve as the basis of information for many of your multiple choice exams 2. They serve as factual hooks that you can use in your FRQ essays. For the question area of your notes, you should indicate as you review your notes, which themes did the particular topic, person, or event address? You could streamline your note-taking with symbols, numbers or letters indicating which part or parts relates to the PERSIA acronym. This will help with your overall review of your notes. APGOV Note Organization Your notes should have the following parts Enhanced Notes: Notes you have added to the Core Notes Chapter Terms Core Notes: Notes provided by Guemmer Your Notes should look something like this: APGOV Note Sheet Enhanced Notes _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ _________________________________ Summary Core Notes ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ ______________________________________________ Prompted Essay Assignment In a democracy the free flow of opinions is critical for a vital government. To be an active member of society, you need to be able to express your opinion in an informed way. The assignment: Choose eight of the following prompts, and write a 5 paragraph persuasive essay for each of your chosen prompts. Choose a position either pro or con to argue. Each essay is worth 20 points, and will be graded on the strength of your arguments and the clarity of your writing. Each prompted essay will be due every week throughout the term on Fridays, unless there is no Friday that week, in that case they will be due on Thursday. These essays will be due on the day assigned and will not be accepted late, except in the case of a legitimate medical absence. Individuals who are participating in athletic events are still obligated to turn their essays in on the due date. 1. A just government ought to value the redistribution of wealth over property rights. 2. In the US, the use of race as a deciding factor in college admissions is just. 3. As general principle, individuals have an obligation to value the common good above their own interests 4. Individual claims of privacy ought to be valued above competing claims of societal welfare. 5. The US has a moral obligation to promote democratic ideals in other nations. 6. The government’s obligation to protect the environment ought to take precedence over its obligation to promote economic development. 7. Even if disclosure is legally permissible, journalists have an ethical obligation to limit material released to the public. 8. A just society ought to value the legal rights of people with mental illness above its obligation to protect itself. 9. The US has a moral obligation to mitigate international conflicts 10. A society has a moral obligation to redress its historical injustices, such as slavery. 11. When in conflict a business' responsibility to itself ought to be valued above responsibility to society. 12. In the US Judicial system, truth seeking ought to take precedence over privileged communication 13. In the near future we will be able to build robots that are as intelligent and powerful as humans, and will therefore have the ability to take over from humans. We should therefore stop conducting research into robotic intelligence. 14. Should voting in elections be compulsory? 15. The US Constitution prohibits people originally from other countries from being President, and should be amended to change this 16. The constitutional limit preventing US Presidents from serving more than two terms should be repealed 17. Young people should be subjected to night-time curfews as a way to reduce crime 18. America should change its Immigration Policy, so children born to illegal immigrants would not automatically become citizens. 19. The United States federal government should substantially decrease its authority either to detain without charge or to search without probable cause in the name of national security. 20. The Federal Government should punish states that knowingly attempt to violate Federal Drug laws. 21. Congress should establish English as the national language 22. The government should set minimum education standards as part of voting rights 23. The state of California should be split into two or three parts in order to govern it more efficiently 24. The Federal government should create national identity cards in order to eliminate the problem of illegal immigration and terrorism in the United States. 25. Teenagers who commit a felony should be charged and tried as adults. 26. California high schools should adopt a statewide uniform dress code in order to eliminate inappropriate attire. 27. Private businesses should have the right to ban cell phone signals. 28. The age to vote should be raised to the drinking age in order to be more consistent 29. The U.S. should reinstitute a military draft 30. Restrictions on stem cell research should be eliminated in order research cures for neurological diseases such as Parkinson’s 31. The United States should limit its involvement in international conflicts to those countries that pose an economic or military threat. 32. Congress should reinstitute the “Fairness Doctrine” on broadcast media. 33. Corporal punishment should be reinstituted in California schools to improve student discipline. 34. The California High School Exit Exam should be expanded to include science and history 35. The California government should allow private corporations to manage their prisons like other states allow. ATTENTION !!! ARE YOU READING THIS !! THE SUMMER ASSIGNMENT IS ONLY FOR STUDENTS WHO ARE ENROLLED IN THE FIRST AND THIRD TERM CLASS. !!! Summer 2010 Assignments AP Government with Economics A.P. Government requires different thinking and writing skills than you used in U.S. History. Writing for government requires the understanding and analysis of abstract concepts and principles. You will depend less on recitation of facts than on your interpretation of the facts. That means those of you who basically bluffed your way through World and US History by knowing a laundry list of terms and dates will have to change your methodology. With the current state of our government and economy, both on a national and a local level, we will be watching the political battles for spending and foreign policy initiatives unfold. Throughout the year you will become aware of politics and economics in general and specifically, have an opportunity to explore your own political and economic ideologies. This summer assignment is designed to help you to transition from thinking historically to thinking and writing from a political and economic perspective. There are four parts to this assignment and each part is described below. Assignments will be due the first day of class. ASSIGNMENT # 1: Follow the News Your first assignment is to read the newspaper, weekly news magazines, the internet news sources, and/or the nightly network news. Keep track of the major news stories that are national or international in scope. (You may want to keep a journal with a few sentences about the stories) This assignment does not require that you turn in anything but you will have a quiz on the important big news events of the summer. This will be good practice for the regular news quizzes you will have throughout the year. ASSIGNMENT # 2: Comparison Essay (Relating to Smith and Marx/Engels readings) These two documents have completely opposite views on the role of the market in society. In a comparative essayWhat does Adam Smith say a free market provides to society? What does Marx/Engels say a free market does to society? Also, how is change accomplished in society according to Adam Smith? What has to occur to create change for Marx/Engels? Most students will be required to write a comparative essay at some point in their academic career. A comparative essay is an academic paper which compares two or more topics, items, concepts, and more. Comparative essays seek to discuss how items or concepts are similar, not how they are different. Comparative essays are generally easy to write and should follow the same basic paper structure as any other academic writing assignment. A comparative essay should have an introduction, a paper body, and a conclusion. The introduction part of the paper should introduce the topic and should contain a thesis statement which will be supported throughout the remainder of the paper. The body of the paper is where the student should discuss the similarities of the items being compared. Although a comparative essay is intended to primarily discuss the how items are similar, there can be some, very basic, references to what makes the items different. However, it is imperative that students keep discussions of differences to a minimum because then the paper becomes a compare and contrast essay instead of a comparative essay. The conclusion of the comparative essay is where students should restate the thesis and wrap up the discussion. This is generally where comparative essays give students trouble. It’s difficult to know when to stop comparing. It is not necessary to compare each and every factor of the items or concepts in the paper. Students should select how many comparisons to make based on the length of the paper. For instance, in a one-page paper, students might want to select the number of comparisons based on the number of body paragraphs. Since a one-page comparative essay generally has one introduction paragraph, three body paragraphs, and one conclusion paragraph, the student might want to highlight three short comparisons, one per body paragraph, or one in-depth comparison to discuss throughout the entire three body paragraphs. Longer papers invite longer discussions and more comparisons. Finally, comparative essays should follow the basic rules of paper writing. Students should proof their papers to ensure that they have followed the citation guidelines given to them by the instructor. The paper should also be proofed for grammar, spelling, and punctuation errors. Paragraphs should hold complete thoughts and the paper should be solid and well-written to ensure the best grade possible. Your essay should be 1-2 pages, typed using Times New Roman 12 point font, double spaced. If you use a specific quote, indicate (Author) following the quote. ASSIGNMENT # 3: Textbook Reading and Review: Read and review the first two chapters of the Economics Textbook, you can also refer to the Introduction to Economics notes I have available online. You must have them read and reviewed thoroughly enough to prepare for the Chapter 1 and 2 Test on the second day of the semester. Additionally, the terms in the two chapters will help you with the last portion of the summer assignment. You can find the Chapter 1 and 2 Term list in Unit I of the Economics Section toward the end of this reader. By completing the first couple of chapters during the summer, it allows for some additional time to cover both more Economics and US Government this year. Assignment # 4: Local Business Project- Refer to the specific assignment sheet found in Unit I of the Economics Section. TITLE: Adam Smith and the Origin of Capitalism SUBTITLE:: SOURCE:: Excerpt and condensation of Chapter 4 from The Worldly Philosophers: The Lives, Times, and Ideas of the Great Economic Thinkers by Robert L. Heilbroner, 7th ed., 1999. COPYRIGHT:: TAGS:: Adam Smith, Smith, The Wealth of Nations, capitalism, market, markets, free market, system of perfect liberty, liberty and profit, self interest, competition COUNTRIES:: Europe YEARS:: 1776-1800 INTRO:: Robert Heilbroner's The Worldly Philosophers is a uniquely readable introduction to the lives and ideas of the great economic theorists of the last three centuries. The book has enlivened the study of economics for beginning students for more than 40 years. Adam Smith published his Inquiry into the Nature and Causes of the Wealth of Nations in 1776, adding a second revolutionary event to that fateful year. A political democracy was born on one side of the ocean; an economic blueprint was unfolded on the other. But while not all Europe followed America's political lead, after Smith had displayed the first true tableau of modern society, all the Western world became the world of Adam Smith: his vision became the prescription for the spectacles of generations. Adam Smith would never have thought of himself as a revolutionist; he was only explaining what to him was very clear sensible, and conservative. But he gave the world the image of itself for which it had been searching. After The Wealth of Nations, men began to see the world about themselves with new eyes; they saw how the tasks they did fitted into the whole of society, and they saw that society as a whole was proceeding at a majestic pace toward a distant but clearly visible goal. In a word, a new vision had come into being. What was that new vision? As we might expect, it was not a State but a System -- more precisely, a System of Perfect Liberty. Smith's vision is like a blueprint for a whole new mode of social organization, a mode called Political Economy, or, in today's terminology, economics. The Laws of the Market At the center of this blueprint are the solutions to two problems that absorb Smith's attention. First, he is interested in laying bare the mechanism by which society hangs together. How is it possible for a community in which everyone is busily following his self-interest not to fly apart from sheer centrifugal force? What is it that guides each individual's private business so that it conforms to the needs of the group? With no central planning authority and no steadying influence of age-old tradition, how does society manage to get those tasks done which are necessary for survival? These questions lead Smith to a formulation of the laws of the market. What he sought was "the invisible hand," as he called it, whereby "the private interests and passions of men" are led in the direction "which is most agreeable to the interest of the whole society." But the laws of the market will be only a part of Smith's inquiry. There is another question that interests him: whither society? The laws of the market are like the laws that explain how a spinning top stays upright; but there is also the question of whether the top, by virtue of its spinning, will be moved along the table. To Smith and the great economists who followed him, society is not conceived as a static achievement of mankind which will go on reproducing itself, unchanged and unchanging, from one generation to the next. On the contrary, society is seen as an organism that has its own life history. Indeed, in its entirety The Wealth of Nations is a great treatise on history, explaining how "the system of perfect liberty" (also called "the system of natural liberty") -- the way Smith referred to commercial capitalism -- came into being, as well as how it worked. Adam Smith's laws of the market are basically simple. They tell us that the outcome of a certain kind of behavior in a certain social framework will bring about perfectly definite and foreseeable results. Specifically they show us how the drive of individual self-interest in an environment of similarly motivated individuals will result in competition; and they further demonstrate how competition will result in the provision of those goods that society wants, in the quantities that society desires, and at the prices society is prepared to pay. But self-interest is only half the picture. It drives men to action. Something else must prevent the pushing of profit hungry individuals from holding society up to exorbitant ransom. This regulator is competition, the conflict of the selfinterested actors on the marketplace. A man who permits his self-interest to run away with him will find that competitors have slipped in to take his trade away. Thus the selfish motives of men are transmuted by interaction to yield the most unexpected of results: social harmony. But the laws of the market do more than impose a competitive price on products. They also see to it that the producers of society heed society's demands for the quantities of goods it wants. Let us suppose that consumers decide they want more gloves than are being turned out, and fewer shoes. Accordingly the public will scramble for the stock of gloves on the market, while the shoe business will be dull. As a result glove prices will tend to rise, and shoe prices will tend to fall. But as glove prices rise, profits in the glove industry will rise, too; and as shoe prices fall, profits in shoe manufacture will slump. Again self-interest will step in to right the balance. Workers will be released from the shoe business as shoe factories contract their output; they will move to the glove business, where business is booming. The result is quite obvious: glove production will rise and shoe production fall. Through the mechanism of the market, society will have changed the allocation of its elements of production to fit its new desires. Yet no one has issued a dictum, and no planning authority has established schedules of output. Self-interest and competition, acting one against the other, have accomplished the transition. And one final accomplishment. Just as the market regulates both prices and quantities of goods according to the final arbiter of public demand, so it also regulates the incomes of those who cooperate to produce those goods. If profits in one line of business are unduly large, there will be a rush of other businessmen into that field until competition has lowered surpluses. If wages are out of line in one kind of work, there will be a rush of men into the favored occupation until it pays no more than comparable jobs of that degree of skill and training. Conversely, if profits or wages are too low in one trade area, there will be an exodus of capital and labor until the supply is better adjusted to the demand. All this may seem somewhat elementary. But consider what Adam Smith has done, he has found in the mechanism of the market a self-regulating system for society's orderly provisioning. Does the world really work this way? To a very real degree it did in the days of Adam Smith. Business was competitive, the average factory was small, prices did rise and fall as demand ebbed and rose, and changes in prices did invoke changes in output and occupation. And today? Does the competitive market mechanism still operate? This is not a question to which it is possible to give a simple answer. The nature of the market has changed vastly since the 18th century. We no longer live in a world of atomistic competition in which no man can afford to swim against the current. Today's market mechanism is characterized by the huge size of its participants: giant corporations and strong labor unions obviously do not behave as if they were individual proprietors and workers. Their very bulk enables them to stand out against the pressures of competition, to disregard price signals, and to consider what their self-interest shall be in the long run rather than in the immediate press of each day's buying and selling. That these factors have weakened the guiding function of the market mechanism is apparent. But for all the attributes of modern-day economic society, the great forces of self-interest and competition, however watered down or hedged about, still provide basic rules of behavior that no participant in a market system can afford to disregard entirely. Although the world in which we live is not that of Adam Smith, the laws of the market can still be discerned if we study its operations.... Smith's View of Economic Growth "No society can surely be flourishing and happy, of which by far the greater part of the numbers are poor and miserable," he wrote. And not only did he have the temerity to make so radical a statement, but he proceeded to demonstrate that society was in fact constantly improving; that it was being propelled, willy-nilly, toward a positive goal. It was not moving because anyone willed it to, or because Parliament might pass laws, or England win a battle. It moved because there was a concealed dynamic beneath the surface of things which powered the social whole like an enormous engine. For one salient fact struck Adam Smith as he looked at the English scene. This was the tremendous gain in productivity which sprang from the minute division and specialization of labor. There is hardly any need to point out how infinitely more complex present-day production methods are than those of the 18th century. Smith was sufficiently impressed with a small factory of ten people to write about it; what would he have thought of one employing ten thousand! But the great gift of the division of labor lies in its capacity to increase what Smith calls "that universal opulence which extends itself to the lowest ranks of the people." That universal opulence of the 18th century looks like a grim existence from our modern vantage point. But if we view the matter in its historical perspective , it is clear that, mean as his existence was, it constituted a considerable advance. What is it that drives society to this wonderful multiplication of wealth and riches? Partly it is the market mechanism itself, for the market harnesses man's creative powers in a milieu that encourages him, even forces him, to invent, innovate, expand, take risks. But there are more fundamental pressures behind the restless activity of the market. In fact, Smith sees two deep-seated laws of behavior which propel the market system in an ascending spiral of productivity. The first of these is the Law of Accumulation. The object of the great majority of the rising capitalists was first, last, and always, to accumulate their savings. But Adam Smith did not approve of accumulation for accumulation's sake. He was, after all, a philosopher, with a philosopher's disdain for the vanity of riches. Rather, in the accumulation of capital Smith saw a vast benefit to society. For capital -- if put to use in machinery -- provided just that wonderful division of labor which multiplies man's productive energy. Accumulate and the world will benefit, says Smith. But here is a difficulty: accumulation would soon lead to a situation where further accumulation would be impossible. For accumulation meant more machinery, and more machinery meant more demand for workmen. And this in turn would sooner or later lead to higher and higher wages, until profits -- the source of accumulation -- were eaten away. How is this hurdle surmounted? It is surmounted by the second great law of the system: the Law of Population. To Adam Smith, laborers, like any other commodity, could be produced according to the demand. If wages were high, the number of workpeople would multiply; if wages fell, the numbers of the working class would decrease. Smith put it bluntly: "... the demand for men, like that for any other commodity, necessarily regulates the production of men." If the first effect of accumulation would be to raise the wages of the working class, this in turn would bring about an increase in the number of workers. And now the market mechanism takes over. Just as higher prices on the market will bring about a larger production of gloves and the larger number of gloves in turn press down the higher prices of gloves, so higher wages will bring about a larger number of workers, and the increase in their numbers will set up a reverse pressure on the level of their wages. And this meant that accumulation might go safely on. The rise in wages which it caused and which threatened to make further accumulation unprofitable is tempered by the rise in population. Smith has constructed for society a giant endless chain. As regularly and as inevitably as a series of interlocked mathematical propositions, society is started on an upward march. From any starting point the probing mechanism of the market first equalizes the returns to labor and capital in all their different uses, sees to it that those commodities demanded are produced in the right quantities, and further ensures that prices for commodities are constantly competed down to their costs of production. But further than this, society is dynamic. From its starting point accumulation of wealth will take place, and this accumulation will result in increased facilities for production and in a greater division of labor. This is no business cycle that Smith describes. It is a long-term process, a secular evolution. And it is wonderfully certain. Provided only that the market mechanism is not tampered with, everything is inexorably determined by the preceding link. A vast reciprocating machinery is set up with all of society inside it: only the tastes of the public -- to guide producers -- and the actual physical resources of the nation are outside the chain of cause and effect. But observe that what is foreseen is not an unbounded improvement of affairs. There will assuredly be a long period of what we call economic growth but the improvement has its limits. In the very long run, well beyond the horizon, he saw that a growing population would push wages back to their "natural" level. Growth would come to an end when the economy had extended its boundaries to their limits, and then fully utilized its increased economic "space." Smith did not see the organizational and technological core of the division of labor as a self-generating process of change, but as a discrete advance that would impart its stimulus and then disappear. For all its optimistic boldness, Smith's vision is bounded, careful, sober -- for the long run, even sobering. No wonder, then, that the book took hold slowly. It was not until 1800 that the book achieved full recognition. By that time it had gone through nine English editions and had found its way to Europe and America. Its protagonists came from an unexpected quarter. They were the rising capitalist class excoriated for its "mean rapacity." AII this was ignored in favor of the great point that Smith made in his inquiry: let the market alone. In Smith's panegyric of a free and unfettered market the rising industrialists found the theoretical justification they needed to block the first government attempts to remedy the scandalous conditions of the times. For Smith's theory does unquestionably lead to a doctrine of laissez-faire. To Adam Smith the least government is certainly the best: governments are spendthrift, irresponsible, and unproductive. And yet Adam Smith is not necessarily opposed to government action that has as its end the promotion of the general welfare. Government's Economic Role Smith specifically stresses three things that government should do in a society of natural liberty. First, it should protect that society against "the violence and invasion of other societies. Second, it should provide an "exact administration of justice" for all citizens. And third, government has the duty of "erecting and maintaining those public institutions and those public works which may be in the highest degree advantageous to a great society," but which "are of such a nature that the profit could never repay the expense to any individual or small number of individuals." Put into today's language, Smith explicitly recognizes the usefulness of public investment for projects that cannot be undertaken by the private sector – he mentions roads and education as two examples. What Smith is against is the meddling of the government with the market mechanism. He is against restraints on imports and bounties on exports, against government laws that shelter industry from competition, and against government spending for unproductive ends. These activities of the government all bear against the proper working of the market system. Smith never faced the problem that was to cause such intellectual agony for later generations of whether the government is weakening or strengthening that system when it steps in with welfare legislation. The Danger of Monopoly The great enemy to Adam Smith's system is not so much government per se as monopoly in any form. The trouble with such goings-on is not so much that they are morally reprehensible in themselves -- they are, after all, only the inevitable consequence of man's self-interest -- as that they impede the fluid working of the market. Whatever interferes with the market does so only at the expense of the true wealth of the nation. In a sense the vision of Adam Smith is a testimony to the 18th-century belief in the inevitable triumph of rationality and order over arbitrariness and chaos. Don't try to do good, says Smith. Let good emerge as the by-product of selfishness. Smith was the economist of pre-industrial capitalism; he did not live to see the market system threatened by enormous enterprises; or his laws of accumulation and population upset by sociological developments fifty years off. When Smith lived and wrote, there had not yet been a recognizable phenomenon that might be called a "business cycle." The world he wrote about actually existed, and his systematization of it provides a brilliant analysis of its expansive propensities. Yet something must have been missing from Smith's conception. For although he saw an evolution for society, he did not see a revolution -- the Industrial Revolution. Smith did not see in the ugly factory system, in the newly tried corporate form of business organization, or in the weak attempts of journeymen to form protective organizations, the first appearance of new and disruptively powerful social forces. In a sense his system presupposes that 18th-century England will remain unchanged forever. Only in quantity will it grow: more people, more goods, more wealth; its quality will remain unchanged. His are the dynamics of a static community; it grows but it never matures. But, although the system of evolution has been vastly amended, the great panorama of the market remains as a major achievement. For Smith's encyclopedic scope and knowledge there can be only admiration. The Wealth of Nations and The Theory of Moral Sentiments, together with his few other essays, reveal that Smith was much more than just an economist. He was a philosopher-psychologist-historian-sociologist who conceived a vision that included human motives and historic "stages" and economic mechanisms, all of which expressed the plan of the Great Architect of Nature (as Smith called him). From this viewpoint, The Wealth of Nations is more than a masterwork of political economy. It is part of a huge conception of the human adventure itself. Karl Marx and Fredrich Engels - Manifesto of the Communist Party A spectre is haunting Europe -- the spectre of communism. All the powers of old Europe have entered into a holy alliance to exorcise this spectre: Pope and Tsar, Metternich and Guizot, French Radicals and German police-spies. Where is the party in opposition that has not been decried as communistic by its opponents in power? Where is the opposition that has not hurled back the branding reproach of communism, against the more advanced opposition parties, as well as against its reactionary adversaries? Two things result from this fact: I. Communism is already acknowledged by all European powers to be itself a power. II. It is high time that Communists should openly, in the face of the whole world, publish their views, their aims, their tendencies, and meet this nursery tale of the spectre of communism with a manifesto of the party itself. To this end, Communists of various nationalities have assembled in London and sketched the following manifesto, to be published in the English, French, German, Italian, Flemish and Danish languages. I -- BOURGEOIS AND PROLETARIANS The history of all hitherto existing society [2] is the history of class struggles. Freeman and slave, patrician and plebian, lord and serf, guild-master [3] and journeyman, in a word, oppressor and oppressed, stood in constant opposition to one another, carried on an uninterrupted, now hidden, now open fight, a fight that each time ended, either in a revolutionary reconstitution of society at large, or in the common ruin of the contending classes. In the earlier epochs of history, we find almost everywhere a complicated arrangement of society into various orders, a manifold gradation of social rank. In ancient Rome we have patricians, knights, plebians, slaves; in the Middle Ages, feudal lords, vassals, guild-masters, journeymen, apprentices, serfs; in almost all of these classes, again, subordinate gradations. The modern bourgeois society that has sprouted from the ruins of feudal society has not done away with class antagonisms. It has but established new classes, new conditions of oppression, new forms of struggle in place of the old ones. Our epoch, the epoch of the bourgeoisie, possesses, however, this distinct feature: it has simplified class antagonisms. Society as a whole is more and more splitting up into two great hostile camps, into two great classes directly facing each other -- bourgeoisie and proletariat. From the serfs of the Middle Ages sprang the chartered burghers of the earliest towns. From these burgesses the first elements of the bourgeoisie were developed. The discovery of America, the rounding of the Cape, opened up fresh ground for the rising bourgeoisie. The East-Indian and Chinese markets, the colonisation of America, trade with the colonies, the increase in the means of exchange and in commodities generally, gave to commerce, to navigation, to industry, an impulse never before known, and thereby, to the revolutionary element in the tottering feudal society, a rapid development. The feudal system of industry, in which industrial production was monopolized by closed guilds, now no longer suffices for the growing wants of the new markets. The manufacturing system took its place. The guild-masters were pushed aside by the manufacturing middle class; division of labor between the different corporate guilds vanished in the face of division of labor in each single workshop. Meantime, the markets kept ever growing, the demand ever rising. Even manufacturers no longer sufficed. Thereupon, steam and machinery revolutionized industrial production. The place of manufacture was taken by the giant, MODERN INDUSTRY; the place of the industrial middle class by industrial millionaires, the leaders of the whole industrial armies, the modern bourgeois. Modern industry has established the world market, for which the discovery of America paved the way. This market has given an immense development to commerce, to navigation, to communication by land. This development has, in turn, reacted on the extension of industry; and in proportion as industry, commerce, navigation, railways extended, in the same proportion the bourgeoisie developed, increased its capital, and pushed into the background every class handed down from the Middle Ages. We see, therefore, how the modern bourgeoisie is itself the product of a long course of development, of a series of revolutions in the modes of production and of exchange. Each step in the development of the bourgeoisie was accompanied by a corresponding political advance in that class. An oppressed class under the sway of the feudal nobility, an armed and self-governing association of medieval commune [4]: here independent urban republic (as in Italy and Germany); there taxable "third estate" of the monarchy (as in France); afterward, in the period of manufacturing proper, serving either the semi-feudal or the absolute monarchy as a counterpoise against the nobility, and, in fact, cornerstone of the great monarchies in general -- the bourgeoisie has at last, since the establishment of Modern Industry and of the world market, conquered for itself, in the modern representative state, exclusive political sway. The executive of the modern state is but a committee for managing the common affairs of the whole bourgeoisie. The bourgeoisie, historically, has played a most revolutionary part. The bourgeoisie, wherever it has got the upper hand, has put an end to all feudal, patriarchal, idyllic relations. It has pitilessly torn asunder the motley feudal ties that bound man to his "natural superiors", and has left no other nexus between people than naked self-interest, than callous "cash payment". It has drowned out the most heavenly ecstacies of religious fervor, of chivalrous enthusiasm, of philistine sentimentalism, in the icy water of egotistical calculation. It has resolved personal worth into exchange value, and in place of the numberless indefeasible chartered freedoms, has set up that single, unconscionable freedom -- Free Trade. In one word, for exploitation, veiled by religious and political illusions, it has substituted naked, shameless, direct, brutal exploitation. The bourgeoisie has stripped of its halo every occupation hitherto honored and looked up to with reverent awe. It has converted the physician, the lawyer, the priest, the poet, the man of science, into its paid wage laborers. The bourgeoisie has torn away from the family its sentimental veil, and has reduced the family relation into a mere money relation. The bourgeoisie has disclosed how it came to pass that the brutal display of vigor in the Middle Ages, which reactionaries so much admire, found its fitting complement in the most slothful indolence. It has been the first to show what man's activity can bring about. It has accomplished wonders far surpassing Egyptian pyramids, Roman aqueducts, and Gothic cathedrals; it has conducted expeditions that put in the shade all former exoduses of nations and crusades. The bourgeoisie cannot exist without constantly revolutionizing the instruments of production, and thereby the relations of production, and with them the whole relations of society. Conservation of the old modes of production in unaltered form, was, on the contrary, the first condition of existence for all earlier industrial classes. Constant revolutionizing of production, uninterrupted disturbance of all social conditions, everlasting uncertainty and agitation distinguish the bourgeois epoch from all earlier ones. All fixed, fast frozen relations, with their train of ancient and venerable prejudices and opinions, are swept away, all new-formed ones become antiquated before they can ossify. All that is solid melts into air, all that is holy is profaned, and man is at last compelled to face with sober senses his real condition of life and his relations with his kind. The need of a constantly expanding market for its products chases the bourgeoisie over the entire surface of the globe. It must nestle everywhere, settle everywhere, establish connections everywhere. The bourgeoisie has, through its exploitation of the world market, given a cosmopolitan character to production and consumption in every country. To the great chagrin of reactionaries, it has drawn from under the feet of industry the national ground on which it stood. All old established national industries have been destroyed or are daily being destroyed. They are dislodged by new industries, whose introduction becomes a life and death question for all civilized nations, by industries that no longer work up indigenous raw material, but raw material drawn from the remotest zones; industries whose products are consumed, not only at home, but in every quarter of the globe. In place of the old wants, satisfied by the production of the country, we find new wants, requiring for their satisfaction the products of distant lands and climes. In place of the old local and national seclusion and self-sufficiency, we have intercourse in every direction, universal inter-dependence of nations. And as in material, so also in intellectual production. The intellectual creations of individual nations become common property. National one-sidedness and narrow-mindedness become more and more impossible, and from the numerous national and local literatures, there arises a world literature. The bourgeoisie, by the rapid improvement of all instruments of production, by the immensely facilitated means of communication, draws all, even the most barbarian, nations into civilization. The cheap prices of commodities are the heavy artillery with which it forces the barbarians' intensely obstinate hatred of foreigners to capitulate. It compels all nations, on pain of extinction, to adopt the bourgeois mode of production; it compels them to introduce what it calls civilization into their midst, i.e., to become bourgeois themselves. In one word, it creates a world after its own image. The bourgeoisie has subjected the country to the rule of the towns. It has created enormous cities, has greatly increased the urban population as compared with the rural, and has thus rescued a considerable part of the population from the idiocy of rural life. Just as it has made the country dependent on the towns, so it has made barbarian and semi-barbarian countries dependent on the civilized ones, nations of peasants on nations of bourgeois, the East on the West. The bourgeoisie keeps more and more doing away with the scattered state of the population, of the means of production, and of property. It has agglomerated population, centralized the means of production, and has concentrated property in a few hands. The necessary consequence of this was political centralization. Independent, or but loosely connected provinces, with separate interests, laws, governments, and systems of taxation, became lumped together into one nation, with one government, one code of laws, one national class interest, one frontier, and one customs tariff. The bourgeoisie, during its rule of scarce one hundred years, has created more massive and more colossal productive forces than have all preceding generations together. Subjection of nature's forces to man, machinery, application of chemistry to industry and agriculture, steam navigation, railways, electric telegraphs, clearing of whole continents for cultivation, canalization or rivers, whole populations conjured out of the ground -- what earlier century had even a presentiment that such productive forces slumbered in the lap of social labor? We see then: the means of production and of exchange, on whose foundation the bourgeoisie built itself up, were generated in feudal society. At a certain stage in the development of these means of production and of exchange, the conditions under which feudal society produced and exchanged, the feudal organization of agriculture and manufacturing industry, in one word, the feudal relations of property became no longer compatible with the already developed productive forces; they became so many fetters. They had to be burst asunder; they were burst asunder. Into their place stepped free competition, accompanied by a social and political constitution adapted in it, and the economic and political sway of the bourgeois class. A similar movement is going on before our own eyes. Modern bourgeois society, with its relations of production, of exchange and of property, a society that has conjured up such gigantic means of production and of exchange, is like the sorcerer who is no longer able to control the powers of the nether world whom he has called up by his spells. For many a decade past, the history of industry and commerce is but the history of the revolt of modern productive forces against modern conditions of production, against the property relations that are the conditions for the existence of the bourgeois and of its rule. It is enough to mention the commercial crises that, by their periodical return, put the existence of the entire bourgeois society on its trial, each time more threateningly. In these crises, a great part not only of the existing products, but also of the previously created productive forces, are periodically destroyed. In these crises, there breaks out an epidemic that, in all earlier epochs, would have seemed an absurdity -- the epidemic of overproduction. Society suddenly finds itself put back into a state of momentary barbarism; it appears as if a famine, a universal war of devastation, had cut off the supply of every means of subsistence; industry and commerce seem to be destroyed. And why? Because there is too much civilization, too much means of subsistence, too much industry, too much commerce. The productive forces at the disposal of society no longer tend to further the development of the conditions of bourgeois property; on the contrary, they have become too powerful for these conditions, by which they are fettered, and so soon as they overcome these fetters, they bring disorder into the whole of bourgeois society, endanger the existence of bourgeois property. The conditions of bourgeois society are too narrow to comprise the wealth created by them. And how does the bourgeoisie get over these crises? On the one hand, by enforced destruction of a mass of productive forces; on the other, by the conquest of new markets, and by the more thorough exploitation of the old ones. That is to say, by paving the way for more extensive and more destructive crises, and by diminishing the means whereby crises are prevented. The weapons with which the bourgeoisie felled feudalism to the ground are now turned against the bourgeoisie itself. But not only has the bourgeoisie forged the weapons that bring death to itself; it has also called into existence the men who are to wield those weapons -- the modern working class – the proletarians. In proportion as the bourgeoisie, i.e., capital, is developed, in the same proportion is the proletariat, the modern working class, developed -- a class of laborers, who live only so long as they find work, and who find work only so long as their labor increases capital. These laborers, who must sell themselves piecemeal, are a commodity, like every other article of commerce, and are consequently exposed to all the vicissitudes of competition, to all the fluctuations of the market. Owing to the extensive use of machinery, and to the division of labor, the work of the proletarians has lost all individual character, and, consequently, all charm for the workman. He becomes an appendage of the machine, and it is only the most simple, most monotonous, and most easily acquired knack, that is required of him. Hence, the cost of production of a workman is restricted, almost entirely, to the means of subsistence that he requires for maintenance, and for the propagation of his race. But the price of a commodity, and therefore also of labor, is equal to its cost of production. In proportion, therefore, as the repulsiveness of the work increases, the wage decreases. What is more, in proportion as the use of machinery and division of labor increases, in the same proportion the burden of toil also increases, whether by prolongation of the working hours, by the increase of the work exacted in a given time, or by increased speed of machinery, etc. Modern Industry has converted the little workshop of the patriarchal master into the great factory of the industrial capitalist. Masses of laborers, crowded into the factory, are organized like soldiers. As privates of the industrial army, they are placed under the command of a perfect hierarchy of officers and sergeants. Not only are they slaves of the bourgeois class, and of the bourgeois state; they are daily and hourly enslaved by the machine, by the overlooker, and, above all, in the individual bourgeois manufacturer himself. The more openly this despotism proclaims gain to be its end and aim, the more petty, the more hateful and the more embittering it is. The less the skill and exertion of strength implied in manual labor, in other words, the more modern industry becomes developed, the more is the labor of men superseded by that of women. Differences of age and sex have no longer any distinctive social validity for the working class. All are instruments of labor, more or less expensive to use, according to their age and sex. No sooner is the exploitation of the laborer by the manufacturer, so far at an end, that he receives his wages in cash, than he is set upon by the other portion of the bourgeoisie, the landlord, the shopkeeper, the pawnbroker, etc. The lower strata of the middle class -- the small tradespeople, shopkeepers, and retired tradesmen generally, the handicraftsmen and peasants -- all these sink gradually into the proletariat, partly because their diminutive capital does not suffice for the scale on which Modern Industry is carried on, and is swamped in the competition with the large capitalists, partly because their specialized skill is rendered worthless by new methods of production. Thus, the proletariat is recruited from all classes of the population. The proletariat goes through various stages of development. With its birth begins its struggle with the bourgeoisie. At first, the contest is carried on by individual laborers, then by the work of people of a factory, then by the operative of one trade, in one locality, against the individual bourgeois who directly exploits them. They direct their attacks not against the bourgeois condition of production, but against the instruments of production themselves; they destroy imported wares that compete with their labor, they smash to pieces machinery, they set factories ablaze, they seek to restore by force the vanished status of the workman of the Middle Ages. At this stage, the laborers still form an incoherent mass scattered over the whole country, and broken up by their mutual competition. If anywhere they unite to form more compact bodies, this is not yet the consequence of their own active union, but of the union of the bourgeoisie, which class, in order to attain its own political ends, is compelled to set the whole proletariat in motion, and is moreover yet, for a time, able to do so. At this stage, therefore, the proletarians do not fight their enemies, but the enemies of their enemies, the remnants of absolute monarchy, the landowners, the non- industrial bourgeois, the petty bourgeois. Thus, the whole historical movement is concentrated in the hands of the bourgeoisie; every victory so obtained is a victory for the bourgeoisie. But with the development of industry, the proletariat not only increases in number; it becomes concentrated in greater masses, its strength grows, and it feels that strength more. The various interests and conditions of life within the ranks of the proletariat are more and more equalized, in proportion as machinery obliterates all distinctions of labor, and nearly everywhere reduces wages to the same low level. The growing competition among the bourgeois, and the resulting commercial crises, make the wages of the workers ever more fluctuating. The increasing improvement of machinery, ever more rapidly developing, makes their livelihood more and more precarious; the collisions between individual workmen and individual bourgeois take more and more the character of collisions between two classes. Thereupon, the workers begin to form combinations (trade unions) against the bourgeois; they club together in order to keep up the rate of wages; they found permanent associations in order to make provision beforehand for these occasional revolts. Here and there, the contest breaks out into riots. Now and then the workers are victorious, but only for a time. The real fruit of their battles lie not in the immediate result, but in the ever expanding union of the workers. This union is helped on by the improved means of communication that are created by Modern Industry, and that place the workers of different localities in contact with one another. It was just this contact that was needed to centralize the numerous local struggles, all of the same character, into one national struggle between classes. But every class struggle is a political struggle. And that union, to attain which the burghers of the Middle Ages, with their miserable highways, required centuries, the modern proletarian, thanks to railways, achieve in a few years. This organization of the proletarians into a class, and, consequently, into a political party, is continually being upset again by the competition between the workers themselves. But it ever rises up again, stronger, firmer, mightier. It compels legislative recognition of particular interests of the workers, by taking advantage of the divisions among the bourgeoisie itself. Thus, the Ten- Hours Bill in England was carried. Altogether, collisions between the classes of the old society further in many ways the course of development of the proletariat. The bourgeoisie finds itself involved in a constant battle. At first with the aristocracy; later on, with those portions of the bourgeoisie itself, whose interests have become antagonistic to the progress of industry; at all time with the bourgeoisie of foreign countries. In all these battles, it sees itself compelled to appeal to the proletariat, to ask for help, and thus to drag it into the political arena. The bourgeoisie itself, therefore, supplies the proletariat with its own elements of political and general education, in other words, it furnishes the proletariat with weapons for fighting the bourgeoisie. Further, as we have already seen, entire sections of the ruling class are, by the advance of industry, precipitated into the proletariat, or are at least threatened in their conditions of existence. These also supply the proletariat with fresh elements of enlightenment and progress. Finally, in times when the class struggle nears the decisive hour, the progress of dissolution going on within the ruling class, in fact within the whole range of old society, assumes such a violent, glaring character, that a small section of the ruling class cuts itself adrift, and joins the revolutionary class, the class that holds the future in its hands. Just as, therefore, at an earlier period, a section of the nobility went over to the bourgeoisie, so now a portion of the bourgeoisie goes over to the proletariat, and in particular, a portion of the bourgeois ideologists, who have raised themselves to the level of comprehending theoretically the historical movement as a whole. Of all the classes that stand face to face with the bourgeoisie today, the proletariat alone is a genuinely revolutionary class. The other classes decay and finally disappear in the face of Modern Industry; the proletariat is its special and essential product. The lower middle class, the small manufacturer, the shopkeeper, the artisan, the peasant, all these fight against the bourgeoisie, to save from extinction their existence as fractions of the middle class. They are therefore not revolutionary, but conservative. Nay, more, they are reactionary, for they try to roll back the wheel of history. If, by chance, they are revolutionary, they are only so in view of their impending transfer into the proletariat; they thus defend not their present, but their future interests; they desert their own standpoint to place themselves at that of the proletariat. The "dangerous class", the social scum, that passively rotting mass thrown off by the lowest layers of the old society, may, here and there, be swept into the movement by a proletarian revolution; its conditions of life, however, prepare it far more for the part of a bribed tool of reactionary intrigue. In the condition of the proletariat, those of old society at large are already virtually swamped The proletarian is without property; his relation to his wife and children has no longer anything in common with the bourgeois family relations; modern industry labor, modern subjection to capital, the same in England as in France, in America as in Germany, has stripped him of every trace of national character. Law, morality, religion, are to him so many bourgeois prejudices, behind which lurk in ambush just as many bourgeois interests. All the preceding classes that got the upper hand sought to fortify their already acquired status by subjecting society at large to their conditions of appropriation. The proletarians cannot become masters of the productive forces of society, except by abolishing their own previous mode of appropriation, and thereby also every other previous mode of appropriation. They have nothing of their own to secure and to fortify; their mission is to destroy all previous securities for, and insurances of, individual property. All previous historical movements were movements of minorities, or in the interest of minorities. The proletarian movement is the self-conscious, independent movement of the immense majority, in the interest of the immense majority. The proletariat, the lowest stratum of our present society, cannot stir, cannot raise itself up, without the whole superincumbent strata of official society being sprung into the air. Though not in substance, yet in form, the struggle of the proletariat with the bourgeoisie is at first a national struggle. The proletariat of each country must, of course, first of all settle matters with its own bourgeoisie. In depicting the most general phases of the development of the proletariat, we traced the more or less veiled civil war, raging within existing society, up to the point where that war breaks out into open revolution, and where the violent overthrow of the bourgeoisie lays the foundation for the sway of the proletariat. Hitherto, every form of society has been based, as we have already seen, on the antagonism of oppressing and oppressed classes. But in order to oppress a class, certain conditions must be assured to it under which it can, at least, continue its slavish existence. The serf, in the period of serfdom, raised himself to membership in the commune, just as the petty bourgeois, under the yoke of the feudal absolutism, managed to develop into a bourgeois. The modern laborer, on the contrary, instead of rising with the process of industry, sinks deeper and deeper below the conditions of existence of his own class. He becomes a pauper, and pauperism develops more rapidly than population and wealth. And here it becomes evident that the bourgeoisie is unfit any longer to be the ruling class in society, and to impose its conditions of existence upon society as an overriding law. It is unfit to rule because it is incompetent to assure an existence to its slave within his slavery, because it cannot help letting him sink into such a state, that it has to feed him, instead of being fed by him. Society can no longer live under this bourgeoisie, in other words, its existence is no longer compatible with society. The essential conditions for the existence and for the sway of the bourgeois class is the formation and augmentation of capital; the condition for capital is wage labor. Wage labor rests exclusively on competition between the laborers. The advance of industry, whose involuntary promoter is the bourgeoisie, replaces the isolation of the laborers, due to competition, by the revolutionary combination, due to association. The development of Modern Industry, therefore, cuts from under its feet the very foundation on which the bourgeoisie produces and appropriates products. What the bourgeoisie therefore produces, above all, are its own grave-diggers. Its fall and the victory of the proletariat are equally inevitable. FOOTNOTES [1] By bourgeoisie is meant the class of modern capitalists, owners of the means of social production and employers of wage labor. By proletariat, the class of modern wage laborers who, having no means of production of their own, are reduced to selling their labor power in order to live. [Note by Engels - 1888 English edition] [2] That is, all _written_ history. In 1847, the pre-history of society, the social organization existing previous to recorded history, all but unknown. Since then, August von Haxthausen (1792-1866) discovered common ownership of land in Russia, Georg Ludwig von Maurer proved it to be the social foundation from which all Teutonic races started in history, and, by and by, village communities were found to be, or to have been, the primitive form of society everywhere from India to Ireland. The inner organization of this primitive communistic society was laid bare, in its typical form, by Lewis Henry Morgan's (1818-1861) crowning discovery of the true nature of the gens and its relation to the tribe. With the dissolution of the primeaval communities, society begins to be differentiated into separate and finally antagonistic classes. I have attempted to retrace this dissolution in _Der Ursprung der Familie, des Privateigenthumus und des Staats_, second edition, Stuttgart, 1886. [Engels, 1888 English edition] [3] Guild-master, that is, a full member of a guild, a master within, not a head of a guild. [Engels: 1888 English edition] [4] This was the name given their urban communities by the townsmen of Italy and France, after they had purchased or conquered their initial rights of self-government from their feudal lords. [Engels: 1890 German edition] "Commune" was the name taken in France by the nascent towns even before they had conquered from their feudal lords and masters local self-government and political rights as the "Third Estate". Generally speaking, for the economical development of the bourgeoisie, England is here taken as the typical country, for its political development, France. [Engels: 1888 English edition] II -- PROLETARIANS AND COMMUNISTS In what relation do the Communists stand to the proletarians as a whole? The Communists do not form a separate party opposed to the other working-class parties. They have no interests separate and apart from those of the proletariat as a whole. They do not set up any sectarian principles of their own, by which to shape and mold the proletarian movement. The Communists are distinguished from the other working-class parties by this only: (1) In the national struggles of the proletarians of the different countries, they point out and bring to the front the common interests of the entire proletariat, independently of all nationality. (2) In the various stages of development which the struggle of the working class against the bourgeoisie has to pass through, they always and everywhere represent the interests of the movement as a whole. The Communists, therefore, are on the one hand practically, the most advanced and resolute section of the workingclass parties of every country, that section which pushes forward all others; on the other hand, theoretically, they have over the great mass of the proletariat the advantage of clearly understanding the lines of march, the conditions, and the ultimate general results of the proletarian movement. The immediate aim of the Communists is the same as that of all other proletarian parties: Formation of the proletariat into a class, overthrow of the bourgeois supremacy, conquest of political power by the proletariat. The theoretical conclusions of the Communists are in no way based on ideas or principles that have been invented, or discovered, by this or that would-be universal reformer. They merely express, in general terms, actual relations springing from an existing class struggle, from a historical movement going on under our very eyes. The abolition of existing property relations is not at all a distinctive feature of communism. All property relations in the past have continually been subject to historical change consequent upon the change in historical conditions. The French Revolution, for example, abolished feudal property in favor of bourgeois property. The distinguishing feature of communism is not the abolition of property generally, but the abolition of bourgeois property. But modern bourgeois private property is the final and most complete expression of the system of producing and appropriating products that is based on class antagonisms, on the exploitation of the many by the few. In this sense, the theory of the Communists may be summed up in the single sentence: Abolition of private property. We Communists have been reproached with the desire of abolishing the right of personally acquiring property as the fruit of a man's own labor, which property is alleged to be the groundwork of all personal freedom, activity and independence. Hard-won, self-acquired, self-earned property! Do you mean the property of petty artisan and of the small peasant, a form of property that preceded the bourgeois form? There is no need to abolish that; the development of industry has to a great extent already destroyed it, and is still destroying it daily. Or do you mean the modern bourgeois private property? But does wage labor create any property for the laborer? Not a bit. It creates capital, i.e., that kind of property which exploits wage labor, and which cannot increase except upon conditions of begetting a new supply of wage labor for fresh exploitation. Property, in its present form, is based on the antagonism of capital and wage labor. Let us examine both sides of this antagonism. To be a capitalist, is to have not only a purely personal, but a social STATUS in production. Capital is a collective product, and only by the united action of many members, nay, in the last resort, only by the united action of all members of society, can it be set in motion. Capital is therefore not only personal; it is a social power. When, therefore, capital is converted into common property, into the property of all members of society, personal property is not thereby transformed into social property. It is only the social character of the property that is changed. It loses its class character. Let us now take wage labor. The average price of wage labor is the minimum wage, i.e., that quantum of the means of subsistence which is absolutely requisite to keep the laborer in bare existence as a laborer. What, therefore, the wage laborer appropriates by means of his labor merely suffices to prolong and reproduce a bare existence. We by no means intend to abolish this personal appropriation of the products of labor, an appropriation that is made for the maintenance and reproduction of human life, and that leaves no surplus wherewith to command the labor of others. All that we want to do away with is the miserable character of this appropriation, under which the laborer lives merely to increase capital, and is allowed to live only in so far as the interest of the ruling class requires it . In bourgeois society, living labor is but a means to increase accumulated labor. In communist society, accumulated labor is but a means to widen, to enrich, to promote the existence of the laborer. In bourgeois society, therefore, the past dominates the present; in communist society, the present dominates the past. In bourgeois society, capital is independent and has individuality, while the living person is dependent and has no individuality. And the abolition of this state of things is called by the bourgeois, abolition of individuality and freedom! And rightly so. The abolition of bourgeois individuality, bourgeois independence, and bourgeois freedom is undoubtedly aimed at. By freedom is meant, under the present bourgeois conditions of production, free trade, free selling and buying. But if selling and buying disappears, free selling and buying disappears also. This talk about free selling and buying, and all the other "brave words" of our bourgeois about freedom in general, have a meaning, if any, only in contrast with restricted selling and buying, with the fettered traders of the Middle Ages, but have no meaning when opposed to the communist abolition of buying and selling, or the bourgeois conditions of production, and of the bourgeoisie itself. You are horrified at our intending to do away with private property. But in your existing society, private property is already done away with for nine-tenths of the population; its existence for the few is solely due to its non-existence in the hands of those nine-tenths. You reproach us, therefore, with intending to do away with a form of property, the necessary condition for whose existence is the non-existence of any property for the immense majority of society. In one word, you reproach us with intending to do away with your property. Precisely so; that is just what we intend. From the moment when labor can no longer be converted into capital, money, or rent, into a social power capable of being monopolized, i.e., from the moment when individual property can no longer be transformed into bourgeois property, into capital, from that moment, you say, individuality vanishes. You must, therefore, confess that by "individual" you mean no other person than the bourgeois, than the middle-class owner of property. This person must, indeed, be swept out of the way, and made impossible. Communism deprives no man of the power to appropriate the products of society; all that it does is to deprive him of the power to subjugate the labor of others by means of such appropriations. It has been objected that upon the abolition of private property, all work will cease, and universal laziness will overtake us. According to this, bourgeois society ought long ago to have gone to the dogs through sheer idleness; for those who acquire anything, do not work. The whole of this objection is but another expression of the tautology: There can no longer be any wage labor when there is no longer any capital. All objections urged against the communistic mode of producing and appropriating material products, have, in the same way, been urged against the communistic mode of producing and appropriating intellectual products. Just as to the bourgeois, the disappearance of class property is the disappearance of production itself, so the disappearance of class culture is to him identical with the disappearance of all culture. That culture, the loss of which he laments, is, for the enormous majority, a mere training to act as a machine. But don't wrangle with us so long as you apply, to our intended abolition of bourgeois property, the standard of your bourgeois notions of freedom, culture, law, etc. Your very ideas are but the outgrowth of the conditions of your bourgeois production and bourgeois property, just as your jurisprudence is but the will of your class made into a law for all, a will whose essential character and direction are determined by the economical conditions of existence of your class. The selfish misconception that induces you to transform into eternal laws of nature and of reason the social forms stringing from your present mode of production and form of property -- historical relations that rise and disappear in the progress of production -- this misconception you share with every ruling class that has preceded you. What you see clearly in the case of ancient property, what you admit in the case of feudal property, you are of course forbidden to admit in the case of your own bourgeois form of property. Abolition of the family! Even the most radical flare up at this infamous proposal of the Communists. On what foundation is the present family, the bourgeois family, based? On capital, on private gain. In its completely developed form, this family exists only among the bourgeoisie. But this state of things finds its complement in the practical absence of the family among proletarians, and in public prostitution. The bourgeois family will vanish as a matter of course when its complement vanishes, and both will vanish with the vanishing of capital. Do you charge us with wanting to stop the exploitation of children by their parents? To this crime we plead guilty. But, you say, we destroy the most hallowed of relations, when we replace home education by social. And your education! Is not that also social, and determined by the social conditions under which you educate, by the intervention direct or indirect, of society, by means of schools, etc.? The Communists have not intended the intervention of society in education; they do but seek to alter the character of that intervention, and to rescue education from the influence of the ruling class. The bourgeois claptrap about the family and education, about the hallowed correlation of parents and child, becomes all the more disgusting, the more, by the action of Modern Industry, all the family ties among the proletarians are torn asunder, and their children transformed into simple articles of commerce and instruments of labor. But you Communists would introduce community of women, screams the bourgeoisie in chorus. The bourgeois sees his wife a mere instrument of production. He hears that the instruments of production are to be exploited in common, and, naturally, can come to no other conclusion that the lot of being common to all will likewise fall to the women. He has not even a suspicion that the real point aimed at is to do away with the status of women as mere instruments of production. For the rest, nothing is more ridiculous than the virtuous indignation of our bourgeois at the community of women which, they pretend, is to be openly and officially established by the Communists. The Communists have no need to introduce free love; it has existed almost from time immemorial. Our bourgeois, not content with having wives and daughters of their proletarians at their disposal, not to speak of common prostitutes, take the greatest pleasure in seducing each other's wives. (Ah, those were the days!) Bourgeois marriage is, in reality, a system of wives in common and thus, at the most, what the Communists might possibly be reproached with is that they desire to introduce, in substitution for a hypocritically concealed, an openly legalized system of free love. For the rest, it is self-evident that the abolition of the present system of production must bring with it the abolition of free love springing from that system, i.e., of prostitution both public and private. The Communists are further reproached with desiring to abolish countries and nationality. The workers have no country. We cannot take from them what they have not got. Since the proletariat must first of all acquire political supremacy, must rise to be the leading class of the nation, must constitute itself the nation, it is, so far, itself national, though not in the bourgeois sense of the word. National differences and antagonism between peoples are daily more and more vanishing, owing to the development of the bourgeoisie, to freedom of commerce, to the world market, to uniformity in the mode of production and in the conditions of life corresponding thereto. The supremacy of the proletariat will cause them to vanish still faster. United action of the leading civilized countries at least is one of the first conditions for the emancipation of the proletariat. In proportion as the exploitation of one individual by another will also be put an end to, the exploitation of one nation by another will also be put an end to. In proportion as the antagonism between classes within the nation vanishes, the hostility of one nation to another will come to an end. The charges against communism made from a religious, a philosophical and, generally, from an ideological standpoint, are not deserving of serious examination. Does it require deep intuition to comprehend that man's ideas, views, and conception, in one word, man's consciousness, changes with every change in the conditions of his material existence, in his social relations and in his social life? What else does the history of ideas prove, than that intellectual production changes its character in proportion as material production is changed? The ruling ideas of each age have ever been the ideas of its ruling class. When people speak of the ideas that revolutionize society, they do but express that fact that within the old society the elements of a new one have been created, and that the dissolution of the old ideas keeps even pace with the dissolution of the old conditions of existence. When the ancient world was in its last throes, the ancient religions were overcome by Christianity. When Christian ideas succumbed in the eighteenth century to rationalist ideas, feudal society fought its death battle with the then revolutionary bourgeoisie. The ideas of religious liberty and freedom of conscience merely gave expression to the sway of free competition within the domain of knowledge. "Undoubtedly," it will be said, "religious, moral, philosophical, and juridicial ideas have been modified in the course of historical development. But religion, morality, philosophy, political science, and law, constantly survived this change." "There are, besides, eternal truths, such as Freedom, Justice, etc., that are common to all states of society. But communism abolishes eternal truths, it abolishes all religion, and all morality, instead of constituting them on a new basis; it therefore acts in contradiction to all past historical experience." What does this accusation reduce itself to? The history of all past society has consisted in the development of class antagonisms, antagonisms that assumed different forms at different epochs. But whatever form they may have taken, one fact is common to all past ages, viz., the exploitation of one part of society by the other. No wonder, then, that the social consciousness of past ages, despite all the multiplicity and variety it displays, moves within certain common forms, or general ideas, which cannot completely vanish except with the total disappearance of class antagonisms. The communist revolution is the most radical rupture with traditional relations; no wonder that its development involved the most radical rupture with traditional ideas. But let us have done with the bourgeois objections to communism. We have seen above that the first step in the revolution by the working class is to raise the proletariat to the position of ruling class to win the battle of democracy. The proletariat will use its political supremacy to wrest, by degree, all capital from the bourgeoisie, to centralize all instruments of production in the hands of the state, i.e., of the proletariat organized as the ruling class; and to increase the total productive forces as rapidly as possible. Of course, in the beginning, this cannot be effected except by means of despotic inroads on the rights of property, and on the conditions of bourgeois production; by means of measures, therefore, which appear economically insufficient and untenable, but which, in the course of the movement, outstrip themselves, necessitate further inroads upon the old social order, and are unavoidable as a means of entirely revolutionizing the mode of production. These measures will, of course, be different in different countries. Nevertheless, in most advanced countries, the following will be pretty generally applicable. 1. Abolition of property in land and application of all rents of land to public purposes. 2. A heavy progressive or graduated income tax. 3. Abolition of all rights of inheritance. 4. Confiscation of the property of all emigrants and rebels. 5. Centralization of credit in the banks of the state, by means of a national bank with state capital and an exclusive monopoly. 6. Centralization of the means of communication and transport in the hands of the state. 7. Extension of factories and instruments of production owned by the state; the bringing into cultivation of waste lands, and the improvement of the soil generally in accordance with a common plan. 8. Equal obligation of all to work. Establishment of industrial armies, especially for agriculture. 9. Combination of agriculture with manufacturing industries; gradual abolition of all the distinction between town and country by a more equable distribution of the populace over the country. 10. Free education for all children in public schools. Abolition of children's factory labor in its present form. Combination of education with industrial production, etc. When, in the course of development, class distinctions have disappeared, and all production has been concentrated in the hands of a vast association of the whole nation, the public power will lose its political character. Political power, properly so called, is merely the organized power of one class for oppressing another. If the proletariat during its contest with the bourgeoisie is compelled, by the force of circumstances, to organize itself as a class; if, by means of a revolution, it makes itself the ruling class, and, as such, sweeps away by force the old conditions of production, then it will, along with these conditions, have swept away the conditions for the existence of class antagonisms and of classes generally, and will thereby have abolished its own supremacy as a class. In place of the old bourgeois society, with its classes and class antagonisms, we shall have an association in which the free development of each is the condition for the free development of all. III -- SOCIALIST AND COMMUNIST LITERATURE 1. REACTIONARY SOCIALISM a. Feudal Socialism Owing to their historical position, it became the vocation of the aristocracies of France and England to write pamphlets against modern bourgeois society. In the French Revolution of July 1830, and in the English reform agitation, these aristocracies again succumbed to the hateful upstart. Thenceforth, a serious political struggle was altogether out of the question. A literary battle alone remained possible. But even in the domain of literature, the old cries of the restoration period had become impossible. [1] In order to arouse sympathy, the aristocracy was obliged to lose sight, apparently, of its own interests, and to formulate its indictment against the bourgeoisie in the interest of the exploited working class alone. Thus, the aristocracy took their revenge by singing lampoons on their new masters and whispering in his ears sinister prophesies of coming catastrophe. In this way arose feudal socialism: half lamentation, half lampoon; half an echo of the past, half menace of the future; at times, by its bitter, witty and incisive criticism, striking the bourgeoisie to the very heart's core, but always ludicrous in its effect, through total incapacity to comprehend the march of modern history. The aristocracy, in order to rally the people to them, waved the proletarian alms-bag in front for a banner. But the people, so often as it joined them, saw on their hindquarters the old feudal coats of arms, and deserted with loud and irreverent laughter. One section of the French Legitimists and "Young England" exhibited this spectacle: In pointing out that their mode of exploitation was different to that of the bourgeoisie, the feudalists forget that they exploited under circumstances and conditions that were quite different and that are now antiquated. In showing that, under their rule, the modern proletariat never existed, they forget that the modern bourgeoisie is the necessary offspring of their own form of society. For the rest, so little do they conceal the reactionary character of their criticism that their chief accusation against the bourgeois amounts to this: that under the bourgeois regime a class is being developed which is destined to cut up, root and branch, the old order of society. What they upbraid the bourgeoisie with is not so much that it creates a proletariat as that it creates a _revolutionary_ proletariat. In political practice, therefore, they join in all corrective measures against the working class; and in ordinary life, despite their high falutin' phrases, they stoop to pick up the golden apples dropped from the tree of industry, and to barter truth, love, and honor, for traffic in wool, beetroot-sugar, and potato spirits. [2] As the parson has ever gone hand in hand with the landlord, so has clerical socialism with feudal socialism. Nothing is easier than to give Christian asceticism a socialist tinge. Has not Christianity declaimed against private property, against marriage, against the state? Has it not preached in the place of these, charity and poverty, celibacy and mortification of the flesh, monastic life and Mother Church? Christian socialism is but the holy water with which the priest consecrates the heart-burnings of the aristocrat. b. Petty-Bourgeois Socialism The feudal aristocracy was not the only class that was ruined by the bourgeoisie, not the only class whose conditions of existence pined and perished in the atmosphere of modern bourgeois society. The medieval burgesses and the small peasant proprietors were the precursors of the modern bourgeoisie. In those countries which are but little developed, industrially and commercially, these two classes still vegetate side by side with the rising bourgeoisie. In countries where modern civilization has become fully developed, a new class of petty bourgeois has been formed, fluctuating between proletariat and bourgeoisie, and ever renewing itself a supplementary part of bourgeois society. The individual members of this class, however, as being constantly hurled down into the proletariat by the action of competition, and, as Modern Industry develops, they even see the moment approaching when they will completely disappear as an independent section of modern society, to be replaced in manufactures, agriculture and commerce, by overlookers, bailiffs and shopmen. In countries like France, where the peasants constitute far more than half of the population, it was natural that writers who sided with the proletariat against the bourgeoisie should use, in their criticism of the bourgeois regime, the standard of the peasant and petty bourgeois, and from the standpoint of these intermediate classes, should take up the cudgels for the working class. Thus arose petty-bourgeois socialism. Sismondi was the head of this school, not only in France but also in England. This school of socialism dissected with great acuteness the contradictions in the conditions of modern production. It laid bare the hypocritical apologies of economists. It proved, incontrovertibly, the disastrous effects of machinery and division of labor; the concentration of capital and land in a few hands; overproduction and crises; it pointed out the inevitable ruin of the petty bourgeois and peasant, the misery of the proletariat, the anarchy in production, the crying inequalities in the distribution of wealth, the industrial war of extermination between nations, the dissolution of old moral bonds, of the old family relations, of the old nationalities. In it positive aims, however, this form of socialism aspires either to restoring the old means of production and of exchange, and with them the old property relations, and the old society, or to cramping the modern means of production and of exchange within the framework of the old property relations that have been, and were bound to be, exploded by those means. In either case, it is both reactionary and Utopian. Its last words are: corporate guilds for manufacture; patriarchal relations in agriculture. Ultimately, when stubborn historical facts had dispersed all intoxicating effects of self-deception, this form of socialism ended in a miserable hangover. c. German or "True" Socialism The socialist and communist literature of France, a literature that originated under the pressure of a bourgeoisie in power, and that was the expressions of the struggle against this power, was introduced into Germany at a time when the bourgeoisie in that country had just begun its contest with feudal absolutism. German philosophers, would-be philosophers, and beaux esprits (men of letters), eagerly seized on this literature, only forgetting that when these writings immigrated from France into Germany, French social conditions had not immigrated along with them. In contact with German social conditions, this French literature lost all its immediate practical significance and assumed a purely literary aspect. Thus, to the German philosophers of the eighteenth century, the demands of the first French Revolution were nothing more than the demands of "Practical Reason" in general, and the utterance of the will of the revolutionary French bourgeoisie signified, in their eyes, the laws of pure will, of will as it was bound to be, of true human will generally. The work of the German literati consisted solely in bringing the new French ideas into harmony with their ancient philosophical conscience, or rather, in annexing the French ideas without deserting their own philosophic point of view. This annexation took place in the same way in which a foreign language is appropriated, namely, by translation. It is well known how the monks wrote silly lives of Catholic saints _over_ the manuscripts on which the classical works of ancient heathendom had been written. The German literati reversed this process with the profane French literature. They wrote their philosophical nonsense beneath the French original. For instance, beneath the French criticism of the economic functions of money, they wrote "alienation of humanity", and beneath the French criticism of the bourgeois state they wrote "dethronement of the category of the general", and so forth. The introduction of these philosophical phrases at the back of the French historical criticisms, they dubbed "Philosophy of Action", "True Socialism", "German Science of Socialism", "Philosophical Foundation of Socialism", and so on. The French socialist and communist literature was thus completely emasculated. And, since it ceased, in the hands of the German, to express the struggle of one class with the other, he felt conscious of having overcome "French onesidedness" and of representing, not true requirements, but the requirements of truth; not the interests of the proletariat, but the interests of human nature, of man in general, who belongs to no class, has no reality, who exists only in the misty realm of philosophical fantasy. This German socialism, which took its schoolboy task so seriously and solemnly, and extolled its poor stock-in-trade in such a mountebank fashion, meanwhile gradually lost its pedantic innocence. The fight of the Germans, and especially of the Prussian bourgeoisie, against feudal aristocracy and absolute monarchy, in other words, the liberal movement, became more earnest. By this, the long-wished for opportunity was offered to "True" Socialism of confronting the political movement with the socialistic demands, of hurling the traditional anathemas against liberalism, against representative government, against bourgeois competition, bourgeois freedom of the press, bourgeois legislation, bourgeois liberty and equality, and of preaching to the masses that they had nothing to gain, and everything to lose, by this bourgeois movement. German socialism forgot, in the nick of time, that the French criticism, whose silly echo it was, presupposed the existence of modern bourgeois society, with its corresponding economic conditions of existence, and the political constitution adapted thereto, the very things whose attainment was the object of the pending struggle in Germany. To the absolute governments, with their following of parsons, professors, country squires, and officials, it served as a welcome scarecrow against the threatening bourgeoisie. It was a sweet finish, after the bitter pills of flogging and bullets, with which these same governments, just at that time, dosed the German working-class risings. While this "True" Socialism thus served the government as a weapon for fighting the German bourgeoisie, it, at the same time, directly represented a reactionary interest, the interest of German philistines. In Germany, the pettybourgeois class, a relic of the sixteenth century, and since then constantly cropping up again under the various forms, is the real social basis of the existing state of things. To preserve this class is to preserve the existing state of things in Germany. The industrial and political supremacy of the bourgeoisie threatens it with certain destruction -- on the one hand, from the concentration of capital; on the other, from the rise of a revolutionary proletariat. "True" Socialism appeared to kill these two birds with one stone. It spread like an epidemic. The robe of speculative cobwebs, embroidered with flowers of rhetoric, steeped in the dew of sickly sentiment, this transcendental robe in which the German Socialists wrapped their sorry "eternal truths", all skin and bone, served to wonderfully increase the sale of their goods amongst such a public. And on its part German socialism recognized, more and more, its own calling as the bombastic representative of the petty-bourgeois philistine. It proclaimed the German nation to be the model nation, and the German petty philistine to be the typical man. To every villainous meanness of this model man, it gave a hidden, higher, socialistic interpretation, the exact contrary of its real character. It went to the extreme length of directly opposing the "brutally destructive" tendency of communism, and of proclaiming its supreme and impartial contempt of all class struggles. With very few exceptions, all the so-called socialist and communist publications that now (1847) circulate in Germany belong to the domain of this foul and enervating literature. [3] 2. CONSERVATIVE OR BOURGEOIS SOCIALISM A part of the bourgeoisie is desirous of redressing social grievances in order to secure the continued existence of bourgeois society. To this section belong economists, philanthropists, humanitarians, improvers of the condition of the working class, organizers of charity, members of societies for the prevention of cruelty to animals, temperance fanatics, hole-andcorner reformers of every imaginable kind. This form of socialism has, moreover, been worked out into complete systems. We may cite Proudhon's Philosophy of Poverty as an example of this form. The socialistic bourgeois want all the advantages of modern social conditions without the struggles and dangers necessarily resulting there from. They desire the existing state of society, minus its revolutionary and disintegrating elements. They wish for a bourgeoisie without a proletariat. The bourgeoisie naturally conceives the world in which it is supreme to be the best; and bourgeois socialism develops this comfortable conception into various more or less complete systems. In requiring the proletariat to carry out such a system, and thereby to march straightaway into the social New Jerusalem, it but requires in reality that the proletariat should remain within the bounds of existing society, but should cast away all its hateful ideas concerning the bourgeoisie. A second, and more practical, but less systematic, form of this socialism sought to depreciate every revolutionary movement in the eyes of the working class by showing that no mere political reform, but only a change in the material conditions of existence, in economical relations, could be of any advantage to them. By changes in the material conditions of existence, this form of socialism, however, by no means understands abolition of the bourgeois relations of production, an abolition that can be affected only by a revolution, but administrative reforms, based on the continued existence of these relations; reforms, therefore, that in no respect affect the relations between capital and labor, but, at the best, lessen the cost, and simplify the administrative work of bourgeois government. Bourgeois socialism attains adequate expression when, and only when, it becomes a mere figure of speech. Free trade: for the benefit of the working class. Protective duties: for the benefit of the working class. Prison reform: for the benefit of the working class. This is the last word and the only seriously meant word of bourgeois socialism. It is summed up in the phrase: the bourgeois is a bourgeois -- for the benefit of the working class. 3. CRITICAL-UTOPIAN SOCIALISM AND COMMUNISM We do not here refer to that literature which, in every great modern revolution, has always given voice to the demands of the proletariat, such as the writings of Babeuf [4] and others. The first direct attempts of the proletariat to attain its own ends, made in times of universal excitement, when feudal society was being overthrown, necessarily failed, owing to the then undeveloped state of the proletariat, as well as to the absence of the economic conditions for its emancipation, conditions that had yet to be produced, and could be produced by the impending bourgeois epoch alone. The revolutionary literature that accompanied these first movements of the proletariat had necessarily a reactionary character. It inculcated universal asceticism and social levelling in its crudest form. The socialist and communist systems, properly so called, those of Saint-Simon [5], Fourier [6], Owen [7], and others, spring into existence in the early undeveloped period, described above, of the struggle between proletariat and bourgeoisie (see Section 1. Bourgeois and Proletarians). The founders of these systems see, indeed, the class antagonisms, as well as the action of the decomposing elements in the prevailing form of society. But the proletariat, as yet in its infancy, offers to them the spectacle of a class without any historical initiative or any independent political movement. Since the development of class antagonism keeps even pace with the development of industry, the economic situation, as they find it, does not as yet offer to them the material conditions for the emancipation of the proletariat. They therefore search after a new social science, after new social laws, that are to create these conditions. Historical action is to yield to their personal inventive action; historically created conditions of emancipation to fantastic ones; and the gradual, spontaneous class organization of the proletariat to an organization of society especially contrived by these inventors. Future history resolves itself, in their eyes, into the propaganda and the practical carrying out of their social plans. In the formation of their plans, they are conscious of caring chiefly for the interests of the working class, as being the most suffering class. Only from the point of view of being the most suffering class does the proletariat exist for them. The undeveloped state of the class struggle, as well as their own surroundings, causes Socialists of this kind to consider themselves far superior to all class antagonisms. They want to improve the condition of every member of society, even that of the most favored. Hence, they habitually appeal to society at large, without the distinction of class; nay, by preference, to the ruling class. For how can people when once they understand their system, fail to see in it the best possible plan of the best possible state of society? Hence, they reject all political, and especially all revolutionary action; they wish to attain their ends by peaceful means, necessarily doomed to failure, and by the force of example, to pave the way for the new social gospel. Such fantastic pictures of future society, painted at a time when the proletariat is still in a very undeveloped state and has but a fantastic conception of its own position, correspond with the first instinctive yearnings of that class for a general reconstruction of society . But these socialist and communist publications contain also a critical element. They attack every principle of existing society. Hence, they are full of the most valuable materials for the enlightenment of the working class. The practical measures proposed in them -- such as the abolition of the distinction between town and country, of the family, of the carrying on of industries for the account of private individuals, and of the wage system, the proclamation of social harmony, the conversion of the function of the state into a more superintendence of production -- all these proposals point solely to the disappearance of class antagonisms which were, at that time, only just cropping up, and which, in these publications, are recognized in their earliest indistinct and undefined forms only. These proposals, therefore, are of a purely utopian character. The significance of critical-utopian socialism and communism bears an inverse relation to historical development. In proportion as the modern class struggle develops and takes definite shape, this fantastic standing apart from the contest, these fantastic attacks on it, lose all practical value and all theoretical justifications. Therefore, although the originators of these systems were, in many respects, revolutionary, their disciples have, in every case, formed mere reactionary sects. They hold fast by the original views of their masters, in opposition to the progressive historical development of the proletariat. They, therefore, endeavor, and that consistently, to deaden the class struggle and to reconcile the class antagonisms. They still dream of experimental realization of their social utopias, of founding isolated phalansteres, of establishing "Home Colonies", or setting up a "Little Icaria" [8] -- pocket editions of the New Jerusalem -- and to realize all these castles in the air, they are compelled to appeal to the feelings and purses of the bourgeois. By degrees, they sink into the category of the reactionary conservative socialists depicted above, differing from these only by more systematic pedantry, and by their fanatical and superstitious belief in the miraculous effects of their social science. They, therefore, violently oppose all political action on the part of the working class; such action, according to them, can only result from blind unbelief in the new gospel. The Owenites in England, and the Fourierists in France, respectively, oppose the Chartists and the Reformistes. FOOTNOTES [1] NOTE by Engels to 1888 English edition: Not the English Restoration (1660-1689), but the French Restoration (1814-1830). [2] NOTE by Engels to 1888 English edition: This applies chiefly to Germany, where the landed aristocracy and squirearchy have large portions of their estates cultivated for their own account by stewards, and are, moreover, extensive beetroot-sugar manufacturers and distillers of potato spirits. The wealthier british aristocracy are, as yet, rather above that; but they, too, know how to make up for declining rents by lending their names to floaters or more or less shady joint-stock companies. [3] NOTE by Engels to 1888 German edition: The revolutionary storm of 1848 swept away this whole shabby tendency and cured its protagonists of the desire to dabble in socialism. The chief representative and classical type of this tendency is Mr Karl Gruen. [4] Francois Noel Babeuf (1760-1797): French political agitator; plotted unsuccessfully to destroy the Directory in revolutionary France and established a communistic system. [5] Comte de Saint-Simon, Claude Henri de Rouvroy (1760-1825): French social philosopher; generally regarded as founder of French socialism. He thought society should be reorganized along industrial lines and that scientists should be the new spiritual leaders. His most important work is _Nouveau_Christianisme_ (1825). [6] Charles Fourier (1772-1837): French social reformer; propounded a system of self-sufficient cooperatives known as Fourierism, especially in his work _Le_Nouveau_Monde_industriel_ (1829-30) [7] Richard Owen (1771-1858): Welsh industrialist and social reformer. He formed a model industrial community at New Lanark, Scotland, and pioneered cooperative societies. His books include _New_View_Of_Society_ (1813). [8] NOTE by Engels to 1888 English edition: "Home Colonies" were what Owen called his communist model societies. _Phalansteres_ were socialist colonies on the plan of Charles Fourier; Icaria was the name given by Caber to his utopia and, later on, to his American communist colony. IV -- POSITION OF THE COMMUNISTS IN RELATION TO THE VARIOUS EXISTING OPPOSITION PARTIES Section II has made clear the relations of the Communists to the existing working-class parties, such as the Chartists in England and the Agrarian Reformers in America. The Communists fight for the attainment of the immediate aims, for the enforcement of the momentary interests of the working class; but in the movement of the present, they also represent and take care of the future of that movement. In France, the Communists ally with the Social Democrats* against the conservative and radical bourgeoisie, reserving, however, the right to take up a critical position in regard to phases and illusions traditionally handed down from the Great Revolution. In Switzerland, they support the Radicals, without losing sight of the fact that this party consists of antagonistic elements, partly of Democratic Socialists, in the French sense, partly of radical bourgeois. In Poland, they support the party that insists on an agrarian revolution as the prime condition for national emancipation, that party which fomented the insurrection of Krakow in 1846. In Germany, they fight with the bourgeoisie whenever it acts in a revolutionary way, against the absolute monarchy, the feudal squirearchy, and the petty-bourgeoisie. But they never cease, for a single instant, to instill into the working class the clearest possible recognition of the hostile antagonism between bourgeoisie and proletariat, in order that the German workers may straightway use, as so many weapons against the bourgeoisie, the social and political conditions that the bourgeoisie must necessarily introduce along with its supremacy, and in order that, after the fall of the reactionary classes in Germany, the fight against the bourgeoisie itself may immediately begin. The Communists turn their attention chiefly to Germany, because that country is on the eve of a bourgeois revolution that is bound to be carried out under more advanced conditions of European civilization and with a much more developed proletariat than that of England was in the seventeenth, and France in the eighteenth century, and because the bourgeois revolution in Germany will be but the prelude to an immediately following proletarian revolution. In short, the Communists everywhere support every revolutionary movement against the existing social and political order of things. In all these movements, they bring to the front, as the leading question in each, the property question, no matter what its degree of development at the time. Finally, they labor everywhere for the union and agreement of the democratic parties of all countries. The Communists disdain to conceal their views and aims. They openly declare that their ends can be attained only by the forcible overthrow of all existing social conditions. Let the ruling classes tremble at a communist revolution. The proletarians have nothing to lose but their chains. They have a world to win. Proletarians of all countries, unite! FOOTNOTES * NOTE by Engels to 1888 English edition: The party then represented in Parliament by Ledru- Rollin, in literature by Louis Blanc (1811-82), in the daily press by the Reforme. The name of Social-Democracy signifies, with these its inventors, a section of the Democratic or Republican Party more or less tinged with socialism. Term One Semester Bridge Assignment Holiday Song Project Groups of no more than 3 (you can always work by yourself if you prefer) you will write a politically-satirical version of a well-known holiday song , and then perform it in class on the Friday before break. Each group must get me a copy of their song NO LATER THAN THE LAST THURSDAY OF THE QUARTER, AT THE BEGINNING OF CLASS!!! I must approve all songs prior to the class period that we present! You will also let me know who you are working with-sign up!! Suggestions and considerations: 1. Your song should mirror the original song in terms of verse/chorus construction as well as length. You may want to expand the song if it includes too many repeating “fa-la-la-la-las.” 2. You must incorporate material from the units already covered, in combination with current political events. A minimum of SEVEN vocabulary words or concepts must be UNDERLINED in the lyrics. Also, feel free to read ahead and include material from upcoming units, or material from class discussions and past experiences. 3. Props, signs, costumes, masks, musical instruments, and other forms of creative expression (interpretive dancing anyone?) are strongly encouraged. 4. Anyone and anything in government and politics are fair game for your satire, so, by all means be funny and irreverent. In fact, that’s the point. On the other hand, try to use good taste. 5. The best songs are those which mirror the actual phrasing and syllabic structure of the original. These are the most difficult to write, but they are much easier to sing, which increases your chances of having the class sing along with you! Please give your absolute best effort. 1. Santa Claus Is Coming to Town 2. The Christmas Song 3. Have Yourself a Merry Little Christmas 4. Winter Wonderland 5. White Christmas 6. Let It Snow, Let It Snow, Let It Snow 7. I'll Be Home for Christmas 8. Jingle Bell Rock 9. Rudolph the Red-Nosed Reindeer 10. Little Drummer Boy 11. Sleigh Ride 12. Silver Bells 13. It's the Most Wonderful Time of the Year 14. Feliz Navidad 15. Rockin’ Around the Christmas Tree 16. Blue Christmas 17. Frosty The Snow Man 18. A Holly Jolly Christmas 19. I Saw Mommy Kissing Santa Claus GRADE=20 POINTS 20. Here Comes Santa Claus (Right Down Santa Claus Lane) 21. (There's No Place Like) Home For The Holidays 22. Santa Baby 23. It’s Beginning To Look A Lot Like Christmas 24. Carol of the Bells 25. Wonderful Christmastime 26. What Child is This 27. All I Want for Christmas 28. Deck the Halls 29. O Come All Ye Faithful 30. Grandma Got Ran Over by a Reindeer 31. The Twelve Days of Christmas 32. Away in a Manger 33. Hark! The Herald Angels Sing 34. Angels We Have Heard on High 35. Up on The Housetop …And Many More… GRADE ASSESSMENT NAMES: 1. PERIOD: ORIGINAL SONG: GRADE: /20pts + EC= 1. SONG LENGTH: 2-3 verses 5pts 2-3 verses and chorus 2. 3. /20 (any props, costumes, instruments) 4 3pts 1 verse and chorus 2. 5 VOCABULARY WORDS OR CONCEPTS (Underlined): 5pts 4 3pts Seven vocab/concepts are Five vocab/concepts are underlined underlined 2 2 1pt Only one vocab/concept is underlined 3. CURRENT POLITICAL EVENTS 5pts 4 Verse and chorus contain politics Current political events 3pts either verse(s) or chorus do not political material 4. SONG RESEMBLANCE: 5pts Mirrors the actual phrasing and syllabic structure of the original 3pts 2 mirrors majority of phrasing and syllabic structure of the original 4 1pt missing a chorus or does not contain a verse 2 1pt both chorus and verse(s) lack current political events 1pt does not mirror the phrasing or syllabic structure of original COMMENTS: GRADE ASSESSMENT NAMES: 1. PERIOD: ORIGINAL SONG: GRADE: /20pts + EC= 1. SONG LENGTH: 2-3 verses 5pts 2-3 verses and chorus 2. 3. /20 (any props, costumes, instruments) 4 3pts 1 verse and chorus 2. 5 VOCABULARY WORDS OR CONCEPTS (Underlined): 5pts 4 3pts Seven vocab/concepts are Five vocab/concepts are underlined underlined 2 2 1pt Only one vocab/concept is underlined 3. CURRENT POLITICAL EVENTS 5pts 4 Verse and chorus contain politics Current political events 3pts either verse(s) or chorus do not political material 4. SONG RESEMBLANCE: 5pts Mirrors the actual phrasing and syllabic structure of the original 3pts 2 mirrors majority of phrasing and syllabic structure of the original COMMENTS: 4 1pt missing a chorus or does not contain a verse 2 1pt both chorus and verse(s) lack current political events 1pt does not mirror the phrasing or syllabic structure of original Term Two Semester Project 1. Refer to the Summer Assignment, complete Assigments One and Two 2. Refer to the Term One Semester Project- you will also create a song, but since we're going to be meeting again in the middle of spring, doing holiday songs makes no sense. . . so. . instead you're going to do the same assignment but using “camp” songs, tunes one would hear at camp! 3. All of these assignment will be due the first day of the Third term. Online Class Components In an attempt to give students the closest approximation to a college class experience, without actually being there. To be efficient with our time, to increase the variety of assignments and to increase group collaboration, several assignments will have an online component. Special Note: All these assignments can be completed in one way or another without a computer or online access. Online Assessment Categories Note taking We can only cover about half of the content material in class, especially if we want to other activities besides lectures (I know I do!), so you have to complete your notes at home. All the notes are available online, in a couple of different locations- my web page at phs.wjusd.org or the online wiki page. If you have a computer but do not have the internet, if you bring in a flash drive, I can give you a copy of all of the notes. Barring that, all the notes come from the textbook directly, so you can get them from there as well. Discussions We will have several Virtual Discussions online; a specific topic(s) will be given with some questions to answer. You will go to the class wiki page, answer the questions, and then respond to at least two other individual answers. If you do not have a computer, you will have a series of similar questions to answer for the same amount of points. Collaboration Study groups can use the class wiki page to compare notes, to leave notes for each other for projects. Additionally, I can use the wiki page to send messages and reminders to the whole class. Podcasting Some of the assignments have an alternative podcast component, which do require a computer generally to complete. Specific information is available on the class wiki page. Assignments I try to put copies of all the major assignments and worksheets online in case you lose one, or you need another copy. I try not to make too many extra paper copies to save on ink. Unit I- Constitutional underpinning of the U.S. Government “The strength of the Constitution lies entirely in the determination of each citizen to defend it. Only if every single citizen feels duty bound to do his share in this defense are the constitutional rights secure.” Albert Einstein Assignments Chapter 1,2, and 3 Study Guides Declaration of Independence Rewrite Women- In the Constitution Discussion Federalism Scavenger Hunt (ws) Federalists vs. Anti- Federalist Chart (ws) Federalism Power Chart (ws) AP Government Debate #1 Assessments Chapter 1 and Chapter 2 Exams – Multiple Choice and FRQs Unit I Exam- Two FRQs Secondary Readings Plato- The Cave Locke- Two Treaties AntiFederalist #84 On the Lack of a Bill of Rights Federalist #51 Beard- Framing the Constitution Lawrence and Dorf- How not to read the Constitution McCulloch v. Maryland United Stats v. Lopez Chapter 1 Study Questions The Study of American Government 6. What is meant by power, and by political power in particular? 7. Relate the latter to authority, legitimacy, and democracy. 8. Distinguish among the three concepts of democracy mentioned in the chapter. 9. Explain the three senses in which the textbook refers to the United States government as democratic. 10. Differentiate between majoritarian politics and elitist politics. 11. Explain the four major theories. 12. Why are political scientists cautious in stating how politics works or what values dominate it when confronted by political change? Authority bureaucrats Democracy Direct or participatory democracy Elite Karl Marx Legitimacy Terms to Know Majoritarian politics Marxists Max Weber pluralists Power Representative democracy Chapter 2 Study Questions The Constitution Use your own words to answer the following questions on a separate sheet of paper. This should be typed. 1. Make a list of the points that the text makes on what the “Colonial Mind” was thinking at the time of the Revolution. 2. Make a detailed list of the weaknesses in the Articles of Confederation. 3. What was Shays’s Rebellion and what role did that play in the push for changing the Articles of Confederation? 4. Why were the Framers suspicious of democracy? What is the delicate problem for the Framers as stated on p. 25? 5. Make a chart comparing and contrasting the Virginia Plan, New Jersey Plan, and the Great Compromise 6. What were the other compromises involving the president and the Supreme Court decided at the Convention? 7. What is the difference between a democracy and a republic and how did the Constitution strike a balance between these two forms of government? 8. What is judicial review? 9. List and define the two major principles of American representative democracy? 10. Start memorizing the list of checks and balances on p. 29 in the green box. We will be referring to this list for the rest of the year. You also need to start learning which powers are given only to the Senate. 11. What was the founders’ solution to the problem that people will pursue their own self-interest? How is that different from what ancient philosophers believed? What did Madison argue and propose in this context? 12. Make a chart showing the Federalist and Antifederalist arguments about the Constitution. Leave room to add to it. 13. The book lists liberties that are guaranteed in the body of the Constitution. Learn that list. Define writ of habeas corpus, bill of attainder, and an ex post facto law. 14. What arguments did the Federalists use against having a bill of rights? 15. Summarize the three provisions in the Constitution regarding slavery. Why didn’t the Founders abolish slavery? 16. Study the box on p. 41 outlining how to propose and ratify an amendment. Read over the language in Article V of the Constitution. Memorize these methods. 17. What was Charles Beard’s interpretation of the Framers of the Constitution? What is now known to counter his interpretation? 18. In the ratifying conventions, what were the economic divisions of who favored the Constitution? 19. What are the arguments that women were or weren’t left out of the Constitution? 20. Outline the criticisms presented of the separation of powers and the counter arguments. 21. What are the proposals of those who the government is too large and who would seek changes in the Constitution to limit the government? What are the counter arguments? By the end of chapter Two, you will be responsible for being able to define and explain all these items. John Locke social contract Natural Rights State of Nature unalienable rights Thomas Hobbes Democracy Oligarchy Monarchy Mixed Government Articles of Confederation Constitutional Convention Shays’s Rebellion Northwest Ordinance factions Federalist Papers Virginia Plan New Jersey Plan The Great (Connecticut) Compromise Republic judicial review separation of powers federalism Popular sovereignty Federalists and Antifederalists James Madison Alexander Hamilton Ex post facto law Bill of Rights Proportional Representation Enumerated Powers Separated Powers Necessary and Proper Clause Apportionment Supremacy Clause Treason Fugitive Slave Clause Veto Electoral College Federalist Nos. 10 and 51 Coalition Bill of Attainder Original Jurisdiction Appellate Jurisdiction Line-item veto AntiFederalist No. 84 On the lack of a bill of rights By "BRUTUS" When a building is to be erected which is intended to stand for ages, the foundation should be firmly laid. The Constitution proposed to your acceptance is designed, not for yourselves alone, but for generations yet unborn. The principles, therefore, upon which the social compact is founded, ought to have been clearly and precisely stated, and the most express and full declaration of rights to have been made. But on this subject there is almost an entire silence. If we may collect the sentiments of the people of America, from their own most solemn declarations, they hold this truth as self-evident, that all men are by nature free. No one man, therefore, or any class of men, have a right, by the law of nature, or of God, to assume or exercise authority over their fellows. The origin of society, then, is to be sought, not in any natural right which one man has to exercise authority over another, but in the united consent of those who associate. The mutual wants of men at first dictated the propriety of forming societies: and when they were established, protection and defense pointed out the necessity of instituting government. In a state of nature every individual pursues his own interest; in this pursuit it frequently happened, that the possessions or enjoyments of one were sacrificed to the views and designs of another; thus the weak were a prey to the strong, the simple and unwary were subject to impositions from those who were more crafty and designing. In this state of things, every individual was insecure; common interest, therefore, directed that government should be established, in which the force of the whole community should be collected, and under such directions, as to protect and defend every one who composed it. The common good, therefore, is the end of civil government, and common consent, the foundation on which it is established. To effect this end, it was necessary that a certain portion of natural liberty should be surrendered, in order that what remained should be preserved. How great a proportion of natural freedom is necessary to be yielded by individuals, when they submit to government, I shall not inquire. So much, however, must be given, as will be sufficient to enable those to whom the administration of the government is committed, to establish laws for the promoting the happiness of the community, and to carry those laws into effect. But it is not necessary, for this purpose, that individuals should relinquish all their natural rights. Some are of such a nature that they cannot be surrendered. Of this kind are the rights of conscience, the right of enjoying and defending life, etc. Others are not necessary to be resigned in order to attain the end for which government is instituted; these therefore ought not to be given up. To surrender them, would counteract the very end of government, to wit, the common good. From these observations it appears, that in forming a government on its true principles, the foundation should be laid in the manner I before stated, by expressly reserving to the people such of their essential rights as are not necessary to be parted with. The same reasons which at first induced mankind to associate and institute government, will operate to influence them to observe this precaution. If they had been disposed to conform themselves to the rule of immutable righteousness, government would not have been requisite. It was because one part exercised fraud, oppression and violence, on the other, that men came together, and agreed that certain rules should be formed to regulate the conduct of all, and the power of the whole community lodged in the hands of rulers to enforce an obedience to them. But rulers have the same propensities as other men; they are as likely to use the power with which they are vested, for private purposes, and to the injury and oppression of those over whom they are placed, as individuals in a state of nature are to injure and oppress one another. It is therefore as proper that bounds should be set to their authority, as that government should have at first been instituted to restrain private injuries. This principle, which seems so evidently founded in the reason and nature of things, is confirmed by universal experience. Those who have governed, have been found in all ages ever active to enlarge their powers and abridge the public liberty. This has induced the people in all countries, where any sense of freedom remained, to fix barriers against the encroachments of their rulers. The country from which we have derived our origin, is an eminent example of this. Their magna charta and bill of rights have long been the boast, as well as the security of that nation. I need say no more, I presume, to an American, than that this principle is a fundamental one, in all the Constitutions of our own States; there is not one of them but what is either founded on a declaration or bill of rights, or has certain express reservation of rights interwoven in the body of them. From this it appears, that at a time when the pulse of liberty beat high, and when an appeal was made to the people to form Constitutions for the government of themselves, it was their universal sense, that such declarations should make a part of their frames of government. It is, therefore, the more astonishing, that this grand security to the rights of the people is not to be found in this Constitution. It has been said, in answer to this objection, that such declarations of rights, however requisite they might be in the Constitutions of the States, are not necessary in the general Constitution, because, "in the former case, every thing which is not reserved is given; but in the latter, the reverse of the proposition prevails, and every thing which is not given is reserved." It requires but little attention to discover, that this mode of reasoning is rather specious than solid. The powers, rights and authority, granted to the general government by this Constitution, are as complete, with respect to every object to which they extend, as that of any State government-it reaches to every thing which concerns human happiness-life, liberty, and property are under its control. There is the same reason, therefore, that the exercise of power, in this case, should be restrained within proper limits, as in that of the State governments. To set this matter in a clear light, permit me to instance some of the articles of the bills of rights of the individual States, and apply them to the case in question. For the security of life, in criminal prosecutions, the bills of rights of most of the States have declared, that no man shall be held to answer for a crime until he is made fully acquainted with the charge brought against him; he shall not be compelled to accuse, or furnish evidence against himself-the witnesses against him shall be brought face to face, and he shall be fully heard by himself or counsel. That it is essential to the security of life and liberty, that trial of facts be in the vicinity where they happen. Are not provisions of this kind as necessary in the general government, as in that of a particular State? The powers vested in the new Congress extend in many cases to life; they are authorized to provide for the punishment of a variety of capital crimes, and no restraint is laid upon them in its exercise, save only, that "the trial of all crimes, except in cases of impeachment, shall be by jury; and such trial shall be in the State where the said crimes shall have been committed." No man is secure of a trial in the county where he is charged to have committed a crime; he may be brought from Niagara to New York, or carried from Kentucky to Richmond for trial for an offense supposed to be committed. What security is there, that a man shall be furnished with a full and plain description of the charges against him? That he shall be allowed to produce all proof he can in his favor? That he shall see the witnesses against him face to face, or that he shall be fully heard in his own defense by himself or counsel? For the security of liberty it has been declared, "that excessive bail should not be required, nor excessive fines imposed, nor cruel or unusual punishments inflicted. That all warrants, without oath or affirmation, to search suspected places, or seize any person, his papers or property, are grievous and oppressive." These provisions are as necessary under the general government as under that of the individual States; for the power of the former is as complete to the purpose of requiring bail, imposing fines, inflicting punishments, granting search warrants, and seizing persons, papers, or property, in certain cases, as the other. For the purpose of securing the property of the citizens, it is declared by all the States, "that in all controversies at law, respecting property, the ancient mode of trial by jury is one of the best securities of the rights of the people, and ought to remain sacred and inviolable." Does not the same necessity exist of reserving this right under their national compact, as in that of the States? Yet nothing is said respecting it. In the bills of rights of the States it is declared, that a well regulated militia is the proper and natural defense of a free government; that as standing armies in time of peace are dangerous, they are not to be kept up, and that the military should be kept under strict subordination to, and controlled by, the civil power. The same security is as necessary in this Constitution, and much more so; for the general government will have the sole power to raise and to pay armies, and are under no control in the exercise of it; yet nothing of this is to be found in this new system. I might proceed to instance a number of other rights, which were as necessary to be reserved, such as, that elections should be free, that the liberty of the press should be held sacred; but the instances adduced are sufficient to prove that this argument is without foundation. Besides, it is evident that the reason here assigned was not the true one, why the framers of this Constitution omitted a bill of rights; if it had been, they would not have made certain reservations, while they totally omitted others of more importance. We find they have, in the ninth section of the first article declared, that the writ of habeas corpus shall not be suspended, unless in cases of rebellion,-that no bill of attainder, or ex post facto law, shall be passed,-that no title of nobility shall be granted by the United States, etc. If every thing which is not given is reserved, what propriety is there in these exceptions? Does this Constitution any where grant the power of suspending the habeas corpus, to make ex post facto laws, pass bills of attainder, or grant titles of nobility? It certainly does not in express terms. The only answer that can be given is, that these are implied in the general powers granted. With equal truth it may be said, that all the powers which the bills of rights guard against the abuse of, are contained or implied in the general ones granted by this Constitution. So far is it from being true, that a bill of rights is less necessary in the general Constitution than in those of the States, the contrary is evidently the fact. This system, if it is possible for the people of America to accede to it, will be an original compact; and being the last wilt, in the nature of things, vacate every former agreement inconsistent with it. For it being a plan of government received and ratified by the whole people, all other forms which are in existence at the time of its adoption, must yield to it. This is expressed in positive and unequivocal terms in the sixth article: "That this Constitution, and the laws of the United States which shall be made in pursuance thereof, and all treaties made, or which shall be made, under the authority of the United States, shall be the supreme law of the land; and the judges in every State shall be bound thereby, any thing in the Constitution, or laws of any State, to the contrary notwithstanding." "The senators and representatives before-mentioned, and the members of the several State legislatures, and all executive and judicial officers, both of the United States, and of the several States, shall be bound, by oath or affirmation, to support this Constitution." It is therefore not only necessarily implied thereby, but positively expressed, that the different State Constitutions are repealed and entirely done away, so far as they are inconsistent with this, with the laws which shall be made in pursuance thereof, or with treaties made, or which shall be made, under the authority of the United States. Of what avail will the Constitutions of the respective States be to preserve the rights of its citizens? Should they be pled, the answer would be, the Constitution of the United States, and the laws made in pursuance thereof, is the supreme law, and all legislatures and judicial officers, whether of the General or State governments, are bound by oath to support it. No privilege, reserved by the bills of rights, or secured by the State governments, can limit the power granted by this, or restrain any laws made in pursuance of it. It stands, therefore, on its own bottom, and must receive a construction by itself, without any reference to any other. And hence it was of the highest importance, that the most precise and express declarations and reservations of rights should have been made. This will appear the more necessary, when it is considered, that not only the Constitution and laws made in pursuance thereof, but alt treaties made, under the authority of the United States, are the supreme law of the land, and supersede the Constitutions of all the States. The power to make treaties, is vested in the president, by and with the advice and consent of two-thirds of the senate. I do not find any limitation or restriction to the exercise of this power. The most important article in any Constitution may therefore be repealed, even without a legislative act. Ought not a government, vested with such extensive and indefinite authority, to have been restricted by a declaration of rights? It certainly ought. So clear a point is this, that I cannot help suspecting that persons who attempt to persuade people that such reservations were less necessary under this Constitution than under those of the States, are wilfully endeavoring to deceive, and to lead you into an absolute state of vassalage. BRUTUS AntiFederalist No. 84 On the lack of a bill of rights According to the author “Brutus” why is there a reason to debate the inclusion of a bill of rights? According to “Brutus” what is the purpose of government when dealing with natural rights? What evidence is given that a government without a bill of rights will exploit its citizens? According to Brutus what important protections were omitted from the Constitution? What are the problems with State Constitutions in regards to the Federal Government? Federalist No. 51 – James Madison (Reading in Wilson Text) 1. What is the general theme of this paper? Why is this theme important, according to the author? 2. What are the four elements of the separation of powers? a) “each department should have a will of its own b) the members of each should have as little agency as possible in the appointment of the members of the others c) each department should be as little dependent as possible on those of the others for the emoluments annexed to their offices d) each department [should have] the necessary constitutional means and personal motives to resist encroachments of the others 3. What does Madison mean by the statement, “Ambition must be made to counteract ambition”? 4. Is government (and its form) merely “the greatest of all reflections on human nature”? How so or why not? 5. What is the “great difficulty” with government? Why? 6. What does the author mean when he asserts that “the defect of better motives, might be traced through the whole system of human affairs, private as well as public”? 7. What checks are placed by the Constitution on the legislative branch? 8. According to the author’s first of two “considerations,” how is the federal government divided into “two distinct governments” and into “distinct and separate departments”? 9. According to the author’s second of two “considerations,” how do you protect the people from another? (cf. Federalist No. 10; faction) 10. Is it true that “Justice is the end (i.e., goal or purpose) of government? It is the end of civil society”? 11. Do you agree with the author that “In the extended republic of the United States, and among the great variety of interests, parties, and sects which it embraces, a coalition of a majority of the whole society could seldom take place on any other principles than those of justice and the general good”? 12. How does a federal principle enable the people inhabiting a republic to engage in self-government? Federalist Number 10 By James Madison (In Wilson Text) 1. What is a faction? Why are factions a problem in government? 2. What are the two methods for curing the mischiefs of faction? What are the two methods for removing the causes of faction? 3. What does Madison argue that the causes of faction cannot be removed? 4. Why does pure democracy have no cure for the mischiefs of faction? Is Madison arguing against a system of majority rule? Why or why not? 5. To what extent will enlightened leadership solve the problems of factions? Why does Madison more trust in the leaders than the people? 6. Why does a republic do a better job of controlling the effects of faction than a pure democracy? Why does a large republic do a better job of controlling the effects of faction than a small republic? Charles A. Beard Excerpted from Charles Beard's "Framing the Constitution," in Peter Woll, ed., American Government: Readings and Cases, 11th ed. (New York: Harper Collins, 1993) In the following essay, which is adapted from The Supreme Court and the Constitution (1912), Charles Beard presents evidence that the framers of the Constitution were less interested in furthering democratic principles than in protecting private property and the interests of the wealthy class. Since this work was written over eighty years ago, there are a few anachronisms you may want to keep in mind. First, when Beard speaks of the "Confederacy," he is referring to the government that existed under the Articles of Confederation -- not to the Confederate states that seceded from the Union during the Civil War. Also, it is important to remember that the Senate was still not elected by popular vote when Beard was writing -- although that was changed in 1913 by the Seventeenth Amendment. Finally, when Beard speaks of "republican" or "democratic" tendencies, he is not referring to the Republican or Democratic parties, but is instead using the words in their more generic sense. ...The reason and spirit of a law are to be understood only by an inquiry into the circumstances of its enactment. The underlying purposes of the Constitution, therefore, are to be revealed only by a study of the conditions and events which led to formation and adoption. At the outset it must be remembered that there were two great parties at the time of the adoption of the Constitution -one laying emphasis on strength and efficiency in government and the other on its popular aspects. Quite naturally the men who led in stirring up the revolt against Great Britain and in keeping the fighting temper of the Revolutionaries at the proper heat were the boldest and most radical thinkers -- men like Samuel Adams, Thomas Paine, Patrick Henry, and Thomas Jefferson. They were not, generally speaking, men of large property interests or of much practical business experience. In a time of disorder, they could consistently lay more stress upon personal liberty than upon social control; and they pushed to the extreme limits those doctrines of individual rights which had been evolved in England during the struggles of the small landed proprietors and commercial classes against royal prerogative, and which corresponded to the economic conditions prevailing in America at the close of the eighteenth century. They associated strong government with monarchy, and came to believe that the best political system was one which governed least. A majority of the radicals viewed all government, especially if highly centralized, as a species of evil, tolerable only because necessary and always to be kept down to an irreducible minimum by a jealous vigilance. Jefferson put the doctrine in concrete form when he declared that he preferred newspapers without government to government without newspapers. The Declaration of Independence, the first state Constitutions, and the Articles of Confederation bore the impress of this philosophy. In their anxiety to defend the individual against all federal interference and to preserve to the states a large sphere of local autonomy, these Revolutionists had set up a system too weak to accomplish the accepted objects of government; namely, national defense, the protection of property, and the advancement of commerce. They were not unaware of the character of their handiwork, but they believed with Jefferson that "man was a rational animal endowed by nature with rights and with an innate sense of justice and that he could be restrained from wrong and protected in right by moderate powers confided to persons of his own choice." Occasional riots and disorders, they held, were preferable to too much government. The new American political system based on these doctrines had scarcely gone into effect before it began to incur opposition from many sources. The close of the Revolutionary struggle removed the prime cause for radical agitation and brought a new group of thinkers into prominence. When independence had been gained, the practical work to be done was the maintenance of social order, the payment of the public debt, the provision of a sound financial system, and the establishment of conditions favorable to the development of the economic resources of the new country. The men who were principally concerned in this work of peaceful enterprise were not the philosophers, but men of business and property and the holders of public securities. For the most part, they had had no quarrel with the system of class rule and the strong centralization of government which had existed in England. It was on the question of policy, not of governmental structure, that they had broken with the British authorities. By no means all of them, in fact, had even resisted the policy of the mother country, for within the ranks of the conservatives were large numbers of Loyalists who had remained in America, and, as was to have been expected, cherished a bitter feeling against the Revolutionists, especially the radical section which had been boldest in denouncing the English system root and branch. In other words, after the heat and excitement of the War of Independence were over and the new government, state and national, was tested by the ordinary experiences of traders, financiers, and manufacturers, it was found inadequate, and these groups accordingly grew more and more determined to reconstruct the political system in such a fashion as to make it subserve their permanent interests. Under the state constitutions and the Articles of Confederation established during the Revolution, every powerful economic class in the nation suffered either immediate losses or from impediments placed in the way of the development of their enterprises. The holders of the securities of the [government established by the Articles of Confederation] did not receive the interest on their loans. Those who owned Western lands or looked with longing eyes upon the rich opportunities for speculation there chaffed at the weakness of the government and its delays in establishing order on the frontiers. Traders and commercial men found their plans for commerce on a national scale impeded by local interference with interstate commerce. The currency of the states and the nation was hopelessly muddled. Creditors everywhere were angry about the depreciated paper money which the agrarians had made and were attempting to force upon those from whom they had borrowed specie. In short, it was a war between business and populism. Under the Articles of Confederation, populism had a free hand, for majorities in the state legislatures were omnipotent. Anyone who reads the economic history of the time will see why the solid conservative interests of the country were weary of talk about the "rights of the people" and bent upon establishing firm guarantees for the rights of property. The Congress of the Confederation was not long in discovering the true character of the futile authority which the Articles had conferred upon it. The necessity for new sources of revenue became apparent even while the struggle for independence was yet undecided, and, in 1871, Congress carried a resolution to the effect that it should be authorized to lay a duty of five percent on certain goods. This moderate proposition was defeated because Rhode Island rejected it on the grounds that "she regarded it the most precious jewel of sovereignty that no state shall be called upon to open its purse but by the authority of the state and by her own officers." Two years later, Congress prepared another amendment to the Articles providing for certain import duties, the receipts from which, collected by state officers, were to be applied to the payment of the public debt; but three years after the introduction of the measure, four states, including New York, still held out against its ratification, and the project was allowed to drop. At last, in 1786, Congress in a resolution declared that the requisitions for the last eight years had been so irregular in their operation, so uncertain in their collection, and so evidently unproductive that a reliance on them in the future would be no less dishonorable to the understandings of those who entertained it than it would be dangerous to the welfare and peace of the Union. Congress, thereupon, solemnly added that it had become its duty "to declare most explicitly that the crisis had arrived when the people of the United States, by whose will and for whose benefit the federal government was instituted, must decide whether they will support their rank as a nation by maintaining the public faith at home and abroad, or rather for the want of a timely exertion in establishing a general review and thereby giving strength to the Confederacy, they will hazard not only the existence of the Union but those great and invaluable privileges for which they have so arduously and so honorably contended." In fact, the Articles of Confederation had hardly gone into effect before the leading citizens also began to feel that the powers of Congress were wholly inadequate. In 1780, even before their adoption, Alexander Hamilton proposed a general convention to frame a new constitution, and from that time forward he labored with remarkable zeal and wisdom to extend and popularize the idea of a strong national government. Two years later, the Assembly of the State of New York recommended a convention to revise the Articles and increase the power of the Congress. In 1783, Washington, in a circular letter to the governors, urged that it was indispensable to the happiness of the individual states that there should be lodged somewhere a supreme power to regulate and govern the general concerns of the confederation. Shortly afterward (1785), Governor Bowdoin, of Massachusetts, suggested to his state legislature the advisability of calling a national assembly to settle upon and define the powers of Congress; and the legislature resolved that the government under the Articles of Confederation was inadequate and should be reformed; but the resolution was never laid before Congress. In January, 1786, Virginia invited all the other states to send delegates to a convention at Annapolis to consider the question of duties on imports and the commerce in general. When this convention assembled in 1786, delegates from only five states were present, and they were disheartened at the limitations on their powers and the lack of interest the other states had shown in the project. With characteristic foresight, however, Alexander Hamilton seized the occasion to secure the adoption of a recommendation advising the states to choose representatives for another convention to meet in Philadelphia the following year "to consider the Articles of Confederation and to propose such changes therein as might render them adequate to the exigencies of the union." This recommendation was cautiously worded, for Hamilton did not want to raise any unnecessary alarm. He doubtless believed that a complete revolution in the old system was desirable, but he knew that, in the existing state of popular temper, it was not expedient to announce his complete program. Accordingly, no general reconstruction of the political system was suggested; the Articles of Confederation were merely to be "revised"; and the amendments were to be approved by the state legislatures as provided by that instrument. The proposal of the Annapolis convention was transmitted to the state legislatures and laid before Congress. Congress thereupon resolved in February, 1787, that a convention should be held for the sole and express purpose of revising the Articles of Confederation and reporting to itself and the legislatures of the several states such alterations and provisions as would when agreed to by Congress and confirmed by the states render the federal constitution adequate to the exigencies of government and the preservation of the union. In pursuance of this call, delegates to the new convention were chosen by the legislatures of the states or by the governors in conformity to authority conferred by the legislative assemblies. The delegates were given instructions of a general nature by their respective states, none of which, apparently, contemplated any very far-reaching changes. In fact, almost all of them expressly limited their representative to a mere revision of the Articles of Confederation. For example, Connecticut authorized her delegates to represent and confer for the purpose mentioned in the resolution of Congress and to discuss such measures "agreeable to the general principles of Republican government" as they should think proper to render the Union adequate. Delaware, however, went so far as to provide that none of the proposed alterations should extend to the fifth part of the Articles of Confederation guaranteeing that each state should be entitled to one vote. It was a truly remarkable assembly of men that gathered in Philadelphia on May 17, 1787, to undertake the work of reconstructing the American system of government. It is not merely patriotic pride that compels one to assert that never in the history of assemblies has there been a convention of men richer in political experience and practical knowledge, or endowed with a profounder insight into the springs of human action and the intimate essence of government. It is indeed an astounding fact that at one time so many men skilled in statecraft could be found on the very frontiers of civilization among a population numbering about four million whites. It is no less a cause for admiration that their instrument of government should have survived the trials and crises of a century that saw the wreck of more than a score of paper constitutions.[] All the members had had a practical training in politics. Washington, as commander-in-chief of the Revolutionary forces, had learned well the lessons and problems of war, and mastered successfully the no less difficult problems of administration. The two Morrises had distinguished themselves in grappling with financial questions as trying and perplexing as any which statesmen had ever been compelled to face. Seven of the delegates had gained political wisdom as governors of their native states; and no less than twenty-eight had served in Congress, either during the Revolution or under the Articles of Confederation. These were men trained in the law, versed in finance, skilled in administration, and learned in the political philosophy of their own and earlier times. Moreover, they were men destined to continue public service under the government which they had met to construct -- Presidents, VicePresidents, heads of departments, Justices of the Supreme Court were in that imposing body. ... The makers of the Constitution represented the solid, conservative, commercial and financial interests of the country -not the interests which denounced and proscribed judges in Rhode Island, New Jersey, and North Carolina, and stoned their houses in New York. The conservative interests, made desperate by the imbecilities of the Confederation and harried by state legislatures, roused themselves from the lethargy, drew together in a mighty effort to establish a government that would be strong enough to pay the national debt, regulate interstate and foreign commerce, provide for national defense, prevent fluctuations in the currency created by paper emissions, and control the propensities of legislative majorities to attack private rights...The radicals, however, like Patrick Henry, Jefferson, and Samuel Adams, were conspicuous by their absence from the Convention. The Convention was convened to frame a government that would meet the practical issues that had arisen under the Articles of Confederation. The objections they entertained to direct popular government, and they were undoubtedly many, were based upon their experience with popular assemblies during the immediately preceding years. With many of the plain lessons of history before them, they naturally feared that the rights and privileges of the minority would be insecure if the principle of majority rule was definitely adopted and provisions made for its exercise. Furthermore, it will be remembered that up to that time the right of all men, as men, to share in the government had never been recognized in practice. Everywhere in Europe the government was in the hands of a ruling monarch or at best a ruling class; everywhere the mass of the people had been regarded principally as an arms-bearing and tax-paying multitude, uneducated, and with little hope or capacity for advancement. Two years were to elapse after the meeting of the grave assembly at Philadelphia before the transformation of the Estates General into the National Convention in France opened the floodgates of revolutionary ideas on human rights before whose rising tide old landmarks of government are still being submerged. It is small wonder, therefore, that, under the circumstances, many members of that august body held popular government in slight esteem and took the people into consideration only as far as it was imperative "to inspire them with the necessary confidence," as Mr. Gerry [one of the framers of the Constitution] frankly put it. Indeed, every page of the laconic record of the proceedings of the convention, preserved to posterity by Mr. Madison, shows conclusively that the members of that assembly were not seeking to realize any fine notions about democracy and equality, but were striving with all the resources of political wisdom at their command to set up a system of government that would be stable and efficient, safeguarded on the one hand against the possibilities of despotism and on the other against the onslaught of majorities. In the mind of Mr. Gerry, the evils they had experienced flowed "from the excess of democracy," and he confessed that while he was still republican, he "had been taught by experience the danger of the levelling spirit." Mr. Randolph, in offering to the consideration of the convention his plan of government, observed "that the general object was to provide a cure for the evils under which the United States labored; that, in tracing these evils to their origin, every man had found it in the turbulence and follies of democracy; that some check therefore was to be sought for against this tendency of our governments; and that a good Senate seemed most likely to answer the purpose." Mr. Hamilton, in advocating a life term for Senators, urged that "all communities divide themselves into the few and the many. The first are the rich and well born and the other the mass of the people who seldom judge or determine right." Governor Morris wanted to check the "precipitancy, changeableness, and excess" of the representatives of the people by the ability and virtue of men" of great and established property -- aristocracy; men who from pride will support consistency and permanency...Such an aristocratic body will keep down the turbulence of democracy." While these extreme doctrines were somewhat counterbalanced by the democratic principles of Mr. Wilson, who urged that "the government ought to possess, not only first, the force, but second, the mind or sense of the people at large," Madison doubtless summed up in a brief sentence the general opinion of the convention when he said that to secure private rights against minority factions, and at the same time to preserve the spirit and form of popular government, was the great object to which their inquiries had been directed. They were anxious above everything else to safeguard the rights of private property against any leveling tendencies on the part of the propertyless masses. Governor Morris, in speaking on the problem of apportioning representatives, correctly stated the sound historical fact when he declared: "Life and liberty were generally said to be of more value than property. An accurate view of the matter, nevertheless, would prove that property was the main object of society...If property, then was the main object of government, certainly it ought to be one measure of the influence due to those who were to be affected by the government." Mr. King also agreed that "property was the primary object of society," and Mr. Madison warned the convention that in framing a system which they wished to last for ages they must not lose sight of the changes which the ages would produce in the forms and distribution of property. In advocating a long term in order to give independence and firmness to the Senate, he described these impending changes: "An increase in the population will of necessity increase the proportion of those who will labor under all the hardships of life and secretly sigh for a more equitable distribution of its blessings. These may in time outnumber those who are placed above the feelings of indigence. According to the equal laws of suffrage, the power will slide into the hands of the former. No agrarian attempts have yet been made in this country, but symptoms of a levelling spirit, as we have understood have sufficiently appeared, in a certain quarter, to give notice of the future danger." And again, in support of the argument for a property qualification on voters, Madison urged: "In future times, a great majority of the people will not only be without land, but without any other sort of property. These will either combine, under the influence of their common situation, -- in which case the rights of property and the public liberty will not be secure in their hands, -- or, what is more probable, they will become the tools of opulence and ambition; in which case there will be equal danger on another side." Various projects for setting up class rule by the establishment of property qualifications for voters and officers were advanced in the convention, but they were defeated.... The absence of such property qualifications is certainly not due to any belief in Jefferson's free and equal doctrine. It is due rather to the fact that the members of the convention could not agree on the nature and amount of the qualifications. Naturally, a landed qualification was suggested, but for obvious reasons it was rejected. Although it was satisfactory to the landed gentry of the South, it did not suit the financial, commercial, and manufacturing gentry of the North. If it was high, the latter would be excluded; if it was low, it would let in the populistic farmers who had already made so much trouble in the state legislatures with paper-money schemes and other devices for "relieving agriculture." One of the chief reasons for calling the convention and framing the Constitution was to promote commerce and industry and to protect personal property against the depredations of Jefferson's noble freeholders. On the other hand, a personal property qualification, high enough to please merchant princes like Robert Morris or Nathaniel Gorham would shut out Southern planters. Again, an alternative of land or personal property, high enough to afford safeguards to large interests, would doubtless bring about the rejection of the whole Constitution by the troublemaking farmers who had to pass upon the question of ratification. Nevertheless, by the system of checks and balances placed in the government, the convention safeguarded the interests of property against attacks by majorities. The House of Representatives, Mr. Hamilton pointed out, "was so formed as to render it particularly the guardian of the poorer orders of citizens," while the Senate was to preserve the rights of property and the interests of the minority against the demands of the majority. In the tenth number of The Federalist, Mr. Madison argued in a philosophic vein in support of the proposition that it was necessary to base the political system on the actual conditions of "natural inequality." Uniformity of interests throughout the state, he contended, was impossible on account of the diversity in the faculties of men, from which the rights of property originated; the protection of these faculties was the first object of government; from the protection of different and unequal faculties of acquiring property the possession of different degrees and kinds of property immediately resulted; from the influence of these on the sentiments and views of the respective proprietors ensued a division of society into different interests and parties; the unequal distribution of wealth inevitably led to a clash of interests in which the majority was liable to carry out its policies at the expense of the minority; hence, he added, in concluding this splendid piece of logic, "the majority, having such coexistent passion or interest, must be rendered by their number and local situation unable to concert and carry into effect schemes of oppression"; and in his opinion, it was the great merit of the newly framed Constitution that it secured the rights of the minority against "the superior force of an interested and overbearing majority." This very system of checks and balances, which is undeniably the essential element of the Constitution, is built upon the doctrine that the popular branch of the government cannot be allowed full sway, and least of all in the enactment of laws touching the rights of property. The exclusion of the direct popular vote in the election of the President; the creation, again by indirect election, of a Senate which the framers hoped would represent the wealth and conservative interests of the country, and the establishment of an independent judiciary appointed by the President with the concurrence of the Senate -- all these devices bear witness to the fact that the underlying purpose of the Constitution was not the establishment of popular government by means of parliamentary majorities. Page after page of The Federalist is directed to that portion of the electorate which was disgusted with the "mutability of public councils." Writing on the presidential veto, Hamilton says: "The propensity of the legislative department to intrude upon the rights and absorb the powers of other departments has already been suggested and repeated....It may perhaps be said that the power of preventing bad laws included the power of preventing good ones; and may be used to the one purpose as well as the other. But this objection will have little weight with those who can properly estimate the mischiefs of that inconstancy and mutability in the laws which form the greater blemish in the character and genius of our governments. They will consider every institution calculated to restrain the excess of law-making and to keep things in the same state in which they happen to be at any given period, as more likely to do good than harm; because it is favorable to greater stability in the system of legislation. The injury which may possibly be done by defeating a few good laws will be amply compensated by the advantage of preventing a number of bad ones." When the framers of the Constitution had completed the remarkable instrument which was to establish a national government capable of discharging effectively certain great functions and checking the propensities of popular legislatures to attack the rights of private property, a formidable task remained before them -- the task of securing the adoption of the new frame of government by states torn with popular dissentions. They knew very well that the state legislatures which had been so negligent in paying their quotas [of money] under the Articles of Confederation and which had been so jealous of their rights, would probably stick at ratifying such a national instrument of government. Accordingly, they cast aside that clause in the Articles requiring amendments to be ratified by the legislatures of all of the states; and advised that the new Constitution should be ratified by conventions in the several states composed of delegates chosen by the voters. It was largely because the framers of the Constitution knew the temper and class bias of the state legislatures that they arranged that the new Constitution should be ratified by conventions. They furthermore declared -- and this is an fundamental matter -- that when the conventions of nine states had ratified the Constitution the new government should go into effect so far as those states were concerned. The chief reason for resorting to ratifications by conventions is laid down by Hamilton in Federalist 22: "It has not a little contributed to the infirmities of the existing federal system that it never had a ratification by the people. Resting on no better foundation that the consent of the several legislatures, it has been exposed to frequent and intricate questions concerning the validity of its powers; and has in some instances given birth to the enormous doctrine of a right of legislative repeal. Owing its ratification to the law of a state, it has been contended that the same authority might repeal the law by which it was ratified. However gross a heresy it may be to maintain that a party to a compact has a right to revoke that compact, the doctrine itself has respectable advocates. The possibility of a question of this nature proves the necessity of laying the foundations of our national government deeper than in the mere sanction of delegated authority. The fabric of American empire ought to rest on the solid basis of the consent of the people. The streams of national power ought to flow immediately from that pure original foundation of all legitimate authority." Of course, the convention did not resort to the revolutionary policy of transmitting the Constitution directly to the conventions of the several states. It merely laid the finished instrument before the Confederate Congress with the suggestion that it should be submitted to "a convention of delegates chosen in each state by the people thereof, under the recommendation of its legislature, for them assent and ratification; and each convention assenting thereto and ratifying the same should give notice thereof to the United States in Congress assembled." The convention went on to suggest that when nine states had ratified the Constitution, the Confederate Congress should extinguish itself by making provisions for the elections necessary to put the new government into effect.... After the new Constitution was published and transmitted to the states, there began a long and bitter fight over ratification. A veritable flood of pamphlet literature descended upon the country, and a collection of these pamphlets by Hamilton, Madison, and Jay, brought together under the title of The Federalist -- though clearly a piece of campaign literature -- has remained a permanent part of the contemporary sources on the Constitution and has been regarded by many lawyers as a commentary second in value only to the decisions of the Supreme Court. Within a year the champions of the new government found themselves victorious, for on June 21, 1788, the ninth state, New Hampshire, ratified the Constitution, and accordingly the new government might go into effect as between the agreeing states. Within a few weeks, the nationalist party in Virginia and New York succeeded in winning these two states, and in spite of the fact that North Carolina and Rhode Island had not yet ratified the Constitution, Congress determined to put the instrument into effect in accordance with the recommendations of the convention. Charles A. Beard Framing the Constitution 1. Contrast the philosophy and forces behind the Articles of Confederation with those supporting the new Constitution in 1787. 2. What was the effect of the state constitutions and the Articles of Confederation upon the dominant economic classes? 3. How does Beard characterize the delegates to the Constitutional Convention of 1787? 4. What were the views of the delegates to the Convention on democracy and equality, according to Beard? 5. Aside from describing the delegates as representatives of the propertied classes desiring to protect their interests, what other evidence does Beard present to support his thesis that the principal purpose of the Constitution was to protect most forms of private property? 6. Beard relies on The Federalist to support his argument that the Constitution was designed to protect the economic interest of property holders. What arguments does Beard make based on The Federalist to support his conclusion? Chapter 3 Study Questions Federalism 1. Define federalism and explain how such a system differs from a unitary or a confederal system. 2. Make a chart listing the positive and negative aspects of federalism. Leave room for additions 3. Using the chart on p. 53 and the rest of the material in the book to list the elements of the Constitution that 1) restrict the powers of the states 2) protect the powers of the states 3) describe how the states should deal with each other and 4) have been used to expand the power of the federal government 4. What was the principle of nullification? 5. Define initiative, referendum, and recall 6. Define mandates. Give examples. Explain the disadvantages to states of federal mandates. 7. Explain what was in the Unfunded Mandates Reform Act, the 1995 law that the Republicans passed. 8. What are other ways that the federal government imposes costs on state and local governments? 9. Why did the GOP in Congress embrace the idea of devolution and what was the effect of the reform of AFDC? 10. Why was it possible to enact devolution for AFDC but not for Medicaid? 11. What are the explanations that the book gives for why members of Congress pass laws that cause governors and mayors to complain about the role of the federal government? Supreme Court Cases I strongly recommend that you start flash cards on 3 x 5 cards for the Supreme Court cases. Include information on the background of the case, ruling of the court, and significance of that particular case. You will have dozens of cases by the end of the year and this will be very helpful for your study. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12 Fletcher v. Peck (1810) McCulloch v. Maryland (1819) Gibbons v. Ogden (1824) National Labor Relations Board v. Jones & Laughlin Steel (1937) Wickard v. Filburn (1942) Heart of Atlanta Motel v. United States (1964) South Dakota v. Dole (1987) United States v. Lopez (1995) Printz v. United States (1997) United States v. Morrison (2000) Gonzales v. Raich (2005) Gonzales v. Oregon (2006) Terms to Know Federalism Kentucky and Virginia Resolutions Devolution John C. Calhoun Sovereignty Dual Federalism Unitary System Layer Cake Federalism Confederation Marble Cake Federalism Tenth Amendment Creative Federalism and The Great Society (LBJ) Supremacy Clause (Article VI) New Federalism (Competitive Federalism) Elastic or “Necessary and Proper” Clause (Art. I, Section 8, initiative Clause 18) referendum Commerce Clause (Art. I, section 8, clause 3) recall “Full Faith and Credit” Clause (Art. IV, Sec. 1) grants-in-aid “Privileges and Immunities Clause (Art. IV, sec. 2) categorical grants Enumerated Powers (national) {also called Expressed or block grants Delegated Powers} revenue sharing grants Reserved Powers (state)Concurrent Powers Mandates Implied Powers 104th Congress Denied Powers Unfunded Mandates John Marshall Conditions of Aid Nullification Devolution Second-order devolution Third-order devolution Significant Laws I recommend that you start flash cards for these laws. Include a short summary of what the law did and its significance. Some of these laws will appear several times in the course. Civil Rights Act (1964) Clean Air Act (1970) Americans with Disabilities Act (1990) National Voter Registration Act or Motor Voter Registration Act (1993) Unfunded Mandates Reform Act (1995) Personal Responsibility and Work Opportunity Reconciliation Act of 1996 or Welfare Reform Act No Child Left Behind (2002) How Not To Read the Constitution Laurence H. Tribe and Michael C. Dorf From its very creation, the Constitution was perceived as a document that sought to strike a delicate balance between, on the one hand, governmental power to accomplish the great ends of civil society and, on the other, individual liberty. As James Madison put it in The Federalist Papers, "[i]f men were angels, no government would be necessary. If angels were to govern men, neither external nor internal controls on government would be necessary. In framing a government which is to be administered by men over men, the great difficulty lies in this: you must first enable the government to control the governed; and in the next place oblige it to control itself. A dependence on the people is, no doubt, the primary control on the government; but experience has taught mankind the necessity of auxiliary precautions." Although Madison initially opposed the inclusion of a Bill of Rights in the Constitution, as his correspondence with Thomas Jefferson shows, he became convinced that judicially enforceable rights are among the necessary "auxiliary precautions" against tyranny. In the Constitution of the United States, men like Madison bequeathed to subsequent generations a framework for balancing liberty against power. However, it is only a framework; it is not a blueprint. Its Eighth Amendment prohibits the infliction of "cruel and unusual punishment," but gives no examples of permissible or impermissible punishments. Article IV requires that "[t]he United States shall guarantee to every State in this Union a Republican Form of Government," but attempts no definition of republican government. The Fourteenth Amendment proscribes state abridgments of the "privileges or immunities of citizens of the United States," but contains no catalogue of privileges or immunities. How then ought we to go about the task of finding concrete commandments in the Constitution's majestically vague admonitions? If there is genuine controversy over how the Constitution should be read, certainly it cannot be because the disputants have access to different bodies of information. After all, they all have exactly the same text in front of them, and that text has exactly one history, however complex, however multifaceted. But of course different people believe different things about how that history bears on the enterprise of constitutional interpretation. . . . Perhaps the disputants agree on what counts as "the Constitution," but simply approach the same body of textual and historical materials with different visions, different premises, and different convictions. But that assumption raises an obvious question: How are those visions, premises, and convictions relevant to how this brief text ought to be read? Is reading the text just a pretext for expressing the reader's vision in the august, almost holy terms of constitutional law? Is the Constitution simply a mirror in which one sees what one wants to see? . . . Reading the Constitution or Writing One? The belief that we must look beyond the specific views of the Framers to apply the Constitution to contemporary problems is not necessarily a "liberal" position. Indeed, not even the most "conservative" justices today believe in a jurisprudence of original intent that looks only to the Framers' unenacted views about particular institutions or practices. Consider the following statement made by a Supreme Court justice in 1976: The framers of the Constitution wisely spoke in general language and left to succeeding generations the task of applying that language to the unceasingly changing environment in which they would live. . . . Where the framers . . . used general language, they [gave] latitude to those who would later interpret the instrument to make that language applicable to cases that the framers might not have foreseen. The author was not Justice William Brennan or Justice Thurgood Marshall, but then-Justice William Rehnquist. Or consider the statement by Justice White, joined by Justice Rehnquist in a 1986 opinion for the Court: "As [our] prior cases clearly show, . . . this Court does not subscribe to the simplistic view that constitutional interpretation can possibly be limited to the 'plain meaning' of the Constitution's text or to the subjective intention of the Framers. The Constitution," wrote Justice White, "is not a deed setting forth the precise metes and bounds of its subject matter; rather, it is a document announcing fundamental principles in value-laden terms that leave ample scope for the exercise of normative judgment by those charged with interpreting and applying it." So the "conservatives" on the Court, no less than the "liberals," talk as though reading the Constitution requires much more than passively discovering a fixed meaning planted there generations ago. Those who wrote the document, and those who voted to ratify it, were undoubtedly projecting their wishes into an indefinite future. If writing is wishprojection, is reading merely an exercise in wish-fulfillment-not fulfillment of the wishes of the authors, who couldn't have begun to foresee the way things would unfold, but fulfillment of the wishes of readers, who perhaps use the language of the Constitution simply as a mirror to dress up their own political or moral preferences in the hallowed language of our most fundamental document? Justice Joseph Story feared that that might happen when he wrote in 1845: "How easily men satisfy themselves that the Constitution is exactly what they wish it to be." To the extent that this is so, it is indefensible. The authority of the Constitution, its claim to obedience and the force that we permit it to exercise in our law and over our lives, would lose all legitimacy if it really were only a mirror for the readers' ideals and ideas. Just as the original intent of the Framers-even if it could be captured in the laboratory, bottled, and carefully inspected under a microscope-will not yield a satisfactory determinate interpretation of the Constitution, so too at the other end of the spectrum we must also reject as completely unsatisfactory the idea of an empty, or an infinitely malleable, Constitution. We must find principles of interpretation that can anchor the Constitution in some more secure, determinate, and external reality. But that is no small task. One basic problem is that the text itself leaves so much room for the imagination. Simply consider the preamble, which speaks of furthering such concepts as "Justice" and the "Blessings of Liberty." It is not hard, in terms of concepts that fluid and that plastic, to make a linguistically plausible argument in support of more than a few surely incorrect conclusions. Perhaps a rule could be imposed that it is improper to refer to the preamble in constitutional argument on the theory that it is only an introduction, a preface, and not part of the Constitution as enacted. But even if one were to invent such a rule, which has no apparent grounding in the Constitution itself, it is hardly news that the remainder of the document is filled with lively language about "liberty," "due process of law," "unreasonable searches and seizures," and so forth-words that, although not infinitely malleable, are capable of supporting meanings at opposite ends of virtually any legal, political, or ideological spectrum. It is therefore not surprising that readers on both the right and left of the American political center have invoked the Constitution as authority for strikingly divergent conclusions about the legitimacy of existing institutions and practices, and that neither wing has found it difficult to cite chapter and verse in support of its "reading" of our fundamental law. As is true of other areas of law, the materials of constitutional law require construction, leave room for argument over meaning, and tempt the reader to import his or her vision of the just society into the meaning of the materials being considered. . . . When all of the Constitution's supposed unities are exposed to scrutiny, criticisms of its inconsistency with various readers' sweeping visions of what it ought to be become considerably less impressive. Not all need be reducible to a single theme. Inconsistency-even inconsistency with democracy-is hardly earth-shattering. Listen to Walt Whitman: "Do 1 contradict myself? Very well then, I contradict myself." "I am large, I contain multitudes," the Constitution replies. Woll, Peter, ed. American Government Readings and Cases. New York: Pearson Longman, 2004. 47-49. How Not to Read the Constitution- Laurence H. Tribe and Michael C. Dorf 1. In your view, what is purpose of this document (the Constitution) Explain with a couple of examples from the reading. 2. Explain a key point made by the authors that what Madison and the other Framers of the Constitution established was “only a framework; it is not a blueprint.” 3. Because of how one “reads” the Constitution, interpretation of it is not an exact science. Explain how the authors make the point that finding “original intent of the Framers” is often far from clear, but neither should the Constitution be considered “infinitely malleable.” 4. Although “readers on both the right and left” claim to know what the Constitution really says, explain the point the authors make in the final few sentences of the document. McCulloch v. Maryland (1819) U.S. Supreme Court M'CULLOCH v. STATE, 17 U.S. 316 (1819) 17 U.S. 316 (Wheat.) M'CULLOCH v. STATE OF MARYLAND et al. February Term, 1819 - March 7th, 1819. Points to Consider: 1. Argument used by Chief Justice Marshall to justify: o the right of Congress to create a national bank o reason why Maryland could not tax the national bank Mr. Chief Justice Marshall delivered the opinion of the court. In the case now to be determined, the defendant, a sovereign state, denies the obligation of a law enacted by the legislature of the Union, and the plaintiff, on his part, contests the validity of an act which has been passed by the legislature of that state. The constitution of our country, in its most interesting and vital parts, is to be considered; the conflicting powers of the government of the Union and of its members, as marked in that constitution, are to be discussed; and an opinion given, which may essentially influence the great operations of the government…. If any one proposition could command the universal assent of mankind, we might expect it would be this-that the government of the Union, though limited in its powers, is supreme within its sphere of action. This would seem to result, necessarily, from its nature. It is the government of all; its powers are delegated by all; it represents all, and acts for all. Though any one state may be willing to control its operations, no state is willing to allow others to control them. The nation, on those subjects on which it can act, must necessarily bind its component parts. But this question is not left to mere reason: the people have, in express terms, decided it, by saying, [17 U.S. 316, 406] 'this constitution, and the laws of the United States, which shall be made in pursuance thereof,' 'shall be the supreme law of the land,' and by requiring that the members of the state legislatures, and the officers of the executive and judicial departments of the states, shall take the oath of fidelity to it…. A constitution, to contain an accurate detail of all the subdivisions of which its great powers will admit, and of all the means by which they may be carried into execution, would partake of the prolixity of a legal code, and could scarcely be embraced by the human mind. It would, probably, never be understood by the public. Its nature, therefore, requires, that only its great outlines should be marked, its important objects designated, and the minor ingredients which compose those objects, be deduced from the nature of the objects themselves. That this idea was entertained by the framers of the American constitution, is not only to be inferred from the nature of the instrument, but from the language…. Although, among the enumerated powers of government, we do not find the word 'bank' or 'incorporation,' we find the great powers, to lay and collect taxes; to borrow money; to regulate commerce; to declare and conduct a war; and to raise and support armies and navies. The sword and the purse, all the external relations, and no inconsiderable portion of the industry of the nation, are entrusted to its government. It can never be pretended, [17 U.S. 316, 408] that these vast powers draw after them others of inferior importance, merely because they are inferior. Such an idea can never be advanced. But it may with great reason be contended, that a government, entrusted with such ample powers, on the due execution of which the happiness and prosperity of the nation so vitally depends, must also be entrusted with ample means for their execution. The power being given, it is the interest of the nation to facilitate its execution. It can never be their interest, and cannot be presumed to have been their intention, to clog and embarrass its execution, by withholding the most appropriate means. Throughout this vast republic, from the St. Croix to the Gulf of Mexico, from the Atlantic to the Pacific, revenue is to be collected and expended, armies are to be marched and supported. The exigencies of the nation may require, that the treasure raised in the north should be transported to the south, that raised in the east, conveyed to the west, or that this order should be reversed. Is that construction of the constitution to be preferred, which would render these operations difficult, hazardous and expensive? Can we adopt that construction (unless the words imperiously require it), which would impute to the framers of that instrument, when granting these powers for the public good, the intention of impeding their exercise, by withholding a choice of means? If, indeed, such be the mandate of the constitution, we have only to obey; but that instrument does not profess to enumerate the means by which the powers it confers may be executed; nor does it prohibit the creation of a corporation, [17 U.S. 316, 409] if the existence of such a being be essential, to the beneficial exercise of those powers. It is, then, the subject of fair inquiry, how far such means may be employed…. We admit, as all must admit, that the powers of the government are limited, and that its limits are not to be transcended. But we think the sound construction of the constitution must allow to the national legislature that discretion, with respect to the means by which the powers it confers are to be carried into execution, which will enable that body to perform the high duties assigned to it, in the manner most beneficial to the people. Let the end be legitimate, let it be within the scope of the constitution, and all means which are appropriate, which are plainly adapted to that end, which are not prohibited, but consist with the letter and spirit of the constitution, are constitutional…. It being the opinion of the court, that the act incorporating the bank is constitutional; and that the power of establishing a branch in the state of Maryland might be properly exercised by the bank itself, we proceed to inquire-Whether the state of Maryland may, without violating the constitution, tax that branch? That the power of taxation is one of vital importance; that it is retained by the states; that it is not abridged by the grant of a similar power to the government of the Union; that it is to be concurrently exercised by the two governments-are truths which have never been denied. But such is the paramount character of the constitution, that its capacity to withdraw any subject from the action of even this power, is admitted. The states are expressly forbidden to lay any duties on imports or exports, except what may be absolutely necessary for executing their inspection laws. If the obligation of this prohibition must be conceded-if it may restrain a state from the exercise of its taxing power on imports and exports-the same paramount character would seem to restrain, as it certainly may restrain, a state from such other exercise of this power, as is in its nature incompatible with, and repugnant to, the constitutional laws of the Union. A law, absolutely repugnant to another, as entirely [17 U.S. 316, 426] repeals that other as if express terms of repeal were used. On this ground, the counsel for the bank place its claim to be exempted from the power of a state to tax its operations. There is no express provision for the case, but the claim has been sustained on a principle which so entirely pervades the constitution, is so intermixed with the materials which compose it, so interwoven with its web, so blended with its texture, as to be incapable of being separated from it, without rending it into shreds. This great principle is, that the constitution and the laws made in pursuance thereof are supreme; that they control the constitution and laws of the respective states, and cannot be controlled by them. From this, which may be almost termed an axiom, other propositions are deduced as corollaries, on the truth or error of which, and on their application to this case, the cause has been supposed to depend. These are, 1st. That a power to create implies a power to preserve: 2d. That a power to destroy, if wielded by a different hand, is hostile to, and incompatible with these powers to create and to preserve: 3d. That where this repugnancy exists, that authority which is supreme must control, not yield to that over which it is supreme…. If we apply the principle for which the state of Maryland contends, to the constitution, generally, we shall find it capable of changing totally the character of that instrument. We shall find it capable of arresting all the measures of the government, and of prostrating it at the foot of the states. The American people have declared their constitution and the laws made in pursuance thereof, to be supreme; but this principle would transfer the supremacy, in fact, to the states…. The court has bestowed on this subject its most deliberate consideration. The result is a conviction that the states have no power, by taxation or otherwise, to retard, impede, burden, or in any manner control, the operations of the constitutional laws enacted by congress to carry into execution the powers vested in the general government. This is, we think, the unavoidable consequence of that supremacy which the constitution has declared…. McCulloch v Maryland Questions to Consider: 1. What are the advantages for the federal government of establishing a national bank? Read through Article I, Section 8, Clause 18 of the U.S. Constitution to determine which functions of Congress might be helped by such a bank. 2. Why would states feel threatened by a national bank? 3. In your opinion, does the United States government have the authority to establish a national bank? Provide justification for your answer. You may want to review Article I, Section 8, Clause 18 of the Constitution to see what powers it specifically gives Congress. 4. If the United States does have authority to establish a bank, does Maryland have the authority to tax that bank? Why or why not? 5. Why do you think the Supreme Court of the United States agreed to hear this case? What larger principles were at stake? SUPREME COURT OF THE UNITED STATES 514 U.S. 549 United States v. Lopez CERTIORARI TO THE UNITED STATES COURT OF APPEALS FOR THE FIFTH CIRCUIT No. 93-1260 Argued: November 8, 1994 --- Decided: After respondent, then a 12th-grade student, carried a concealed handgun into his high school, he was charged with violating the Gun-Free School Zones Act of 1990, which forbids "any individual knowingly to possess a firearm at a place that [he] knows . . . is a school zone," 18 U.S.C. § 922(q)(1)(A). The District Court denied his motion to dismiss the indictment, concluding that § 922(q) is a constitutional exercise of Congress' power to regulate activities in and affecting commerce. In reversing, the Court of Appeals held that, in light of what it characterized as insufficient congressional findings and legislative history, § 922(q) is invalid as beyond Congress' power under the Commerce Clause. Held: The Act exceeds Congress' Commerce Clause authority. First, although this Court has upheld a wide variety of congressional Acts regulating intrastate economic activity that substantially affected interstate commerce, the possession of a gun in a local school zone is in no sense an economic activity that might, through repetition elsewhere, have such a substantial effect on interstate commerce. Section 922(q) is a criminal statute that, by its terms, has nothing to do with "commerce" or any sort of economic enterprise, however broadly those terms are defined. Nor is it an essential part of a larger regulation of economic activity, in which the regulatory scheme could be undercut unless the intrastate activity were regulated. It cannot, therefore, be sustained under the Court's cases upholding regulations of activities that arise out of or are connected with a commercial transaction, which viewed in the aggregate, substantially affects interstate commerce. Second, § 922(q) contains no jurisdictional element which would ensure, through case-bycase inquiry, that the firearms possession in question has the requisite nexus with interstate commerce. Respondent was a local student at a local school; there is no indication that he had recently moved in interstate commerce, and there is no requirement that his possession of the firearm have any concrete tie to interstate commerce. To uphold the Government's contention that § 922(q) is justified because firearms possession in a local school zone does indeed substantially affect interstate commerce would require this Court to pile inference upon inference in a manner that would bid fair to convert congressional Commerce Clause authority to a general police power of the sort held only by the States. Pp. ___. REHNQUIST, C.J., delivered the opinion of the Court, in which O'CONNOR, SCALIA, KENNEDY, and THOMAS, JJ., joined. KENNEDY, J., filed a concurring opinion, in which O'CONNOR, J., joined. THOMAS, J., filed a concurring opinion. STEVENS, J., and SOUTER, J., filed dissenting opinions. BREYER, J., filed a dissenting opinion, in which STEVENS, SOUTER, and GINSBURG, JJ., joined 1. What are the 3 categories of activities that can be regulated under the Commerce Clause? 2. What were the arguments made on behalf of the US Government in Lopez? 3. What reasoning was used by the Court in rejecting the government’s arguments? 4. What is the standard used to determine whether the Commerce Clause applies to a particular activity? 5. What is the standard used by the dissenters to determine whether the Commerce Clause applies to a particular activity? 6. Do you agree with the Court’s decision in US v. Lopez? Why or Why not? 7. What impact does the Lopez case have on federalism? Unit II - Political Beliefs and Behaviors The Democrats seem to be basically nicer people, but they have demonstrated time and again that they have the management skills of celery. They're the kind of people who'd stop to help you change a flat, but would somehow manage to set your car on fire. I would be reluctant to entrust them with a Cuisinart, let alone the economy. The Republicans, on the other hand, would know how to fix your tire, but they wouldn't bother to stop because they'd want to be on time for Ugly Pants Night at the country club. Dave Barry Assignments Chapter 4,5,6 Study Guides Stock Project (Only for 1st Term Class)- See Econ section AP Government Debate #2 Opinion Poll Project Liberals vs. Conservatives Chart (ws) Assessments Chapter Exam 4 – 25 Multiple Choice Questions Unit Exam Chapter 4,5,6 – 2 FRQ Questions Secondary Readings Tocqueville Democracy in America Chapter 4 Study Questions 1. What do scholars mean by political culture? 2. What is the difference between equality of opportunity and equality of results? 3. List the dominant aspects of political culture. 4. What difference does our American political culture have with other countries’ political cultures? (Use bullet points) 5. Summarize (you can use bullet points) what the book says about the “culture war” in America. 6. What is the difference between internal and external efficacy? Look at Figure 4.2 on p. 93 and decide if you agree or disagree with these statements. 7. As you read through the rest of the chapter, think about how you’d answer the questions asked in Figures 4.3 to 4.5. Civic competence Civic duty Class consciousness External efficacy Internal efficacy Orthodox Terms Political culture Political efficacy Political ideology Political subculture Progressive Work ethic Alexis de Tocqueville: Democracy in America Characteristics of the Federal Constitution of the United States of America as Compared with All Other Federal Constitutions The United States of America does not afford the first or the only instance of a confederation, several of which have existed in modern Europe…. Switzerland, the Germanic Empire, and the Republic of the Low Countries either have been or still are confederations. In studying the constitution of these different countries one is surprised to see that the powers with which they invested the federal government are nearly the same as those awarded by the American Constitution to the government of the United States. They confer upon the central power the same rights of making peace and war, of raising money and troops, and of providing for the general exigencies and the common interests of the nation. Nevertheless, the federal government of these different states has always been as remarkable for its weakness and inefficiency as that of the American Union is for its vigor and capacity. Again, the first American Confederation perished through the excessive weakness of its government…. But the present Constitution of the United States contains certain novel principles which exercise a most important influence, although they do not at once strike the observer. This Constitution … rests in truth upon a wholly novel theory, which may be considered as a great discovery in modern political science. In all the confederations that preceded the American Constitution of 1789, the states allied for a common object agreed to obey the injunctions of a federal government; but they reserved to themselves the right of ordaining and enforcing the execution of the laws of the union. The American states which combined in 1789 agreed that the Federal government should not only dictate the laws, but execute its own enactments. In both cases the right is the same, but the exercise of the right is different; and this difference produced the most momentous consequences. In all the confederations that preceded the American Union the federal government, in order to provide for its wants, had to apply to the separate governments; and if what it prescribed was disagreeable to any one of them, means were found to evade its claims…. Under these circumstances one of two results invariably followed: either the strongest of the allied states assumed the privileges of the federal authority and ruled all the others in its name1; or the federal government was abandoned by its natural supporters, anarchy arose between the confederates, and the union lost all power of action. In America the subjects of the Union are not states, but private citizens: the national government levies a tax, not upon the state of Massachusetts, but upon each inhabitant of Massachusetts. The old confederate governments presided over communities, but that of the Union presides over individuals. Its force is not borrowed but self-derived; and it is served by its own civil and military officers, its own army, and its own courts of justice. It cannot be doubted that the national spirit, the passions of the multitude, and the provincial prejudices of each state tend singularly to diminish the extent of the Federal authority thus constituted and to facilitate resistance to its mandates; but the comparative weakness of a restricted sovereignty is an evil inherent in the federal system…. In all former confederations the privileges of the union furnished more elements of discord than of power, since they multiplied the claims of the nation without augmenting the means of enforcing them; and hence the real weakness of federal governments has almost always been in the exact ratio of their nominal power. Such is not the case in the American Union, in which, as in ordinary governments, the Federal power has the means of enforcing all it is empowered to demand…. Advantages of the Federal System in General, and Its Special Utility in America ... In small states, the watchfulness of society penetrates everywhere, and a desire for improvement pervades the smallest details; the ambition of the people being necessarily checked by its weaknesses, all the efforts and resources of the citizens are turned to the internal well-being of the community and are not likely to be wasted upon an empty pursuit of glory. The powers of every individual being generally limited, his desires are proportionally small. Mediocrity of fortune makes the various conditions of life nearly equal, and the manners of the inhabitants are orderly and simple. Thus, all things considered, and allowance being made for various degrees of morality and enlightenment, we shall generally find more persons in easy circumstances, more contentment and tranquility, in small nations than in large ones. When tyranny is established in the bosom of a small state, it is more galling than elsewhere, because, acting narrower circle, everything in that circle is affected by it. It supplies the place of those- great designs which it cannot entertain, by a violent or exasperating interference in a multitude of minute details; and it leaves the political world, to which it properly belongs, to meddle with the arrangements of private life. Tastes as well as actions are to be regulated; and the families of the citizens, as well as the state, are to be governed. This invasion of rights occurs but seldom, however, freedom being in truth the natural state of small communities. The temptations that the government offers to ambition are too weak and the resources of private individuals are too slender or the sovereign power easily to fall into the grasp of a single man; and should such an event occur, the subjects of the state can easily unite and overthrow the tyrant and the tyranny at once by a common effort. Small nations have therefore always been the cradle of political liberty; and the fact that many of them have lost their liberty by becoming larger shows that their freedom was more a consequence of their small size than of the character of the people. The history of the world affords no instance of a great nation retaining the form of republican government for a long series of years….3 But it may be said with confidence, that a great republic will always be exposed to more perils than a small one. All the passions that are most fatal to republican institutions increase with an increasing territory…. The ambition of private citizens increases with the power of the state; the strength of parties with the importance of the ends they have in view; but the love of country, which ought to check these destructive agencies, is not stronger in a large than in a small republic. It might, indeed, be easily proved that it is less powerful and less developed. Great wealth and extreme poverty, capital cities of large size, a lax morality, selfishness, and antagonism of interests are the dangers which almost invariably arise from the magnitude of states. Several of these evils scarcely injure a monarchy, and some of them even contribute to its strength and duration. In monarchical states the government has its peculiar strength; it may use, but it does not depend on, the community; and the more numerous the people, the stronger is the prince. But the only security that a republican government possesses against these evils lies in the support of the majority. This support is not, however, proportionably greater in a large republic than in a small one; and thus, while the means 'of attack perpetually increase, in both number and influence, the power of resistance remains the same; or it may rather be said to diminish, since the inclinations and interests of the people are more diversified by the increase of the population, and the difficulty of forming a compact majority is constantly augmented. It has been observed, moreover, that the intensity of human passions is heightened not only by the importance of the end which they propose to attain, but by the multitude of individuals who are animated by them at the same time…. In great republics, political passions become irresistible, not only because they aim at gigantic objects, but because they are felt and shared by millions of men at the same time. … Nevertheless, it is important to acknowledge the peculiar advantages of great states. For the very reason that the desire for power is more intense in these communities than among ordinary men, the love of glory is also more developed in the hearts of certain citizens, who regard the applause of a great people as a reward worthy of their exertions and an elevating encouragement to man…. To this it may be added that most important discoveries demand a use of national power which the government of a small state is unable to make: in great nations the government has more enlarged ideas, and is more completely disengaged from the routine of precedent and the selfishness of local feeling; its designs are conceived with more talent and executed with more boldness. In time of peace the well-being of small nations is undoubtedly more general and complete; but they are apt to suffer more acutely from the calamities of war than those great empires whose distant frontiers may long avert the presence of the danger from the mass of the people, who axe therefore more frequently afflicted than ruined by the contest. But in this matter, as in many others, the decisive argument is the necessity of the case. If none but small nations existed, I do not doubt that mankind would be more happy and more free; but the existence of great nations is unavoidable. Political strength thus becomes a condition of national prosperity…. Small nations are often miserable, not because they are small, but because they are weak; and great empires prosper less because they are great than because they are strong. Physical strength is therefore one of the first conditions of the happiness and even of the existence of nations. Hence it occurs that, unless very peculiar circumstances intervene, small nations are always united to large empires in the end, either by force or by their own consent. I do not know a more deplorable condition than that of a people unable to defend itself or to provide for its own wants. The federal system was created with the intention of combining the different advantages which result from the magnitude and the littleness of nations; and a glance at the United States of America discovers the advantages which they have derived from its adoption. In great centralized nations the legislator is obliged to give a character of uniformity to the laws, which does not always suit the diversity of customs and of districts; as he takes no cognizance of special cases, he can only proceed upon the general principles; and the population are obliged to conform to the requirements of the laws, since legislation cannot adapt itself to the exigencies and the customs of the population, which is a great cause of trouble and misery. This disadvantage does not exist in confederations; Congress regulates the principle measures of the national government, and all the details of the administration are reserved to the provincial legislatures. One can hardly imagine how much this division of sovereignty contributes to the wellbeing of each of the states that compose the Union. In these small communities, which are never agitated by the desire of aggrandizement or the care of self-defense, all public authority and private energy are turned towards internal improvements. The central government of each state, which is in immediate relationship with the citizens, is daily apprised of the wants that arise in society; and new projects are proposed every year, which are discussed at town meetings or by the legislature, and which are transmitted by the press to stimulate the zeal and to excite the interest of the citizens. This spirit of improvement is constantly alive in the American republics,… the ambition of power yields to the less refined and less dangerous desire for wellbeing. It is generally believed in America that the existence and the permanence of the republican form of government in the New World depend upon the existence and the duration of the federal system; and it is not unusual to attribute a large share of the misfortunes that have befallen the new states of South America to the injudicious erection of great republics instead of a divided and confederate sovereignty. It is incontestably true that the tastes and the habits of republican government in the United States were first created in the townships and the provincial assemblies. In a small state, like that of Connecticut, for instance, where cutting a canal or laying down a road is a great political question, where the state has no army to pay and no wars to carry on, and where much wealth or much honor cannot be given to the rulers, no form of government can be more natural or more appropriate than a republic. But it is this same republican spirit, it is these manners and customs of a free people, which have been created and nurtured in the different states, that must be afterwards applied to the country at large. The public spirit of the Union is … nothing more than an aggregate or summary of the patriotic zeal of the separate provinces. Every citizen of the United States transfers … his attachment to his little republic into the common store of American patriotism. In defending the Union he defends the increasing prosperity of his own state or county, the-right of conducting its affairs, and the hope of causing measures of improvement to be adopted in it which may be favorable to his own interests; and these are motives that … stir men more than the general interests of the country amid the glory of the nation. On the other hand, if the temper and the manners of the inhabitants especially fitted them to promote the welfare of a great republic, the federal system renders their task less difficult. The confederation of all the American states presents none of the ordinary inconveniences resulting from large associations of men. The Union is a great republic in extent, but the paucity of objects for which its government acts assimilates it to a small state. Its acts are important, but they are rare. As the sovereignty of the Union is limited and incomplete, its exercise is not dangerous to liberty; for it does not excite those insatiable desires for fame and power which have proved so fatal to great repub1ic. As there is no common center to the country, great capital cities, colossal wealth, abject poverty, and sudden revolutions are alike unknown; and political passion; … spends it strength against the interests and the individual passions of every state. Nevertheless, tangible objects and ideas circulate throughout the Union as freely as in a country inhibited by one people. Nothing checks the spirit of enterprise. The government invites the aid of all who have talents or knowledge to serve it. Inside of the frontiers of the Union profound peace prevails, as within the heart of some great empire; abroad it ranks with the most powerful nations of the earth: two thousand miles of coast are open to the commerce of the world; and as it holds the keys of a new world, its flag is respected in the most remote seas. The Union is happy and free as a small people, and glorious and strong as a great nation. Why the Federal System is Not Practicable for All Nations, and How the Anglo-Americans Were Enabled to Adopt It … I have shown the advantages that the Americans derive from their federal system; it remains for me to point out the circumstances that enabled them to adopt it, as its benefits cannot be enjoyed by all nations. The accidental defects of the federal system which originate in the laws may be corrected by the skill of the legislature, but there are evils inherent in the system which cannot be remedied by any effort. The people must therefore find in themselves the strength necessary to bear the natural imperfections of their government. The most prominent evil of all federal systems is the complicated nature of the means they employ. Two sovereignties are necessarily in presence of each other. The legislator may simplify and equalize as far as possible the action of these two sovereignties, by limiting each of them to a sphere of authority accurately defined; but he cannot combine them into one or prevent them from coming into collision at certain points. The federal system … rests upon a theory … which demands the daily exercise of a considerable share of discretion on the part of those it governs In examining the Constitution of the United States, which is the most perfect federal constitution that ever existed, one is startled at the variety of information and the amount of discernment that it presupposes in the people whom it is meant to govern…. After the general theory is comprehended, many difficulties remain to be solved in its application; for, the sovereignty of the Union is so involved in that of the states that it is impossible to distinguish its boundaries, at the first glance. The whole structure of the government is artificial and conventional, and it would be ill adapted to a people which have not been long accustomed to conduct its own affairs, or to one in which the science of politics has not descended to the humblest classes of society. I have never been more struck by the good sense and the practical judgment of the Americans than in the manner in which they elude the numberless difficulties resulting from their Federal Constitution. I scarcely ever met with a plain American citizen who could not distinguish with surprising facility the obligations created by the laws of Congress from those created by the laws of his own state, and who … could not point out the exact limit of the separate jurisdictions of the Federal courts and the tribunals of the state. The Constitution of the United States resembles those fine creations of human industry which ensure wealth and renown to their inventors, but which are profitless in other hands.... The second and most fatal of all defects … inherent in the federal system, is the relative weakness of the government of the Union. The principle upon which all confederations rest is that of a divided sovereignty. Legislators may render this partition less perceptible, they may even conceal it for a time from the public eye, but they cannot prevent it from existing; and a divided sovereignty must always be weaker than an entire one. The remarks made on the Constitution of the United States have shown with what skill the Americans, while restraining the power of the Union within the narrow limits of a federal government, have given it the semblance, and to a certain extent the force, of a national government. By this means the legislators of the Union have diminished the natural danger of confederations, but have not entirely obviated it. The American government … does not address itself to the states, but transmits its injunctions directly to the citizens and compels them individually to comply with its demands. But if the Federal law were to clash with the interests and the prejudices of a state, it might be feared that all the citizens of that state would conceive themselves to be interested in the cause of a single individual who refused to obey. If all the citizens of the state were aggrieved at the same time and in the same manner by the authority of the Union, the Federal government would vainly attempt to subdue them individually; they would instinctively unite in a common defense and would find an organization already prepared for them in the sovereignty that their state is allowed to enjoy. Fiction would give way to reality, and an organized portion of the nation might then contest the central authority. The same observation holds good with regard to the Federal jurisdiction. If the courts of the Union violated an important law of a state in a private case, the real though not the apparent contest would be between the aggrieved state represented by a citizen and the Union represented by its courts of justice. He would have but a partial knowledge of the world who should imagine that it is possible by the aid of legal fictions to prevent men from finding out and employing those means of gratifying their passions which have been left open to them. The American legislators, though they have rendered a collision between the two sovereignties less probable, have not destroyed the causes of such a misfortune…. The Union is possessed of money and troops, but the states have kept the affections and the prejudices of the people. The sovereignty of the Union is an abstract being, which is connected with but few external objects; the sovereignty of the states is perceptible by the senses, easily understood, and constantly active. The former is of recent creation, the latter is coeval with the people itself. The sovereignty of the Union is factitious, that of the states is natural and self-existent, without effort, like the authority of a parent. The sovereignty of the nation affects a few of the chief interests of society; it represents an immense but remote country, a vague and ill-defined sentiment. The authority of the states controls every individual citizen at every hour and in all circumstances; it protects his property, his freedom, and his life; it affects at every moment his well-being or his misery. When we recollect the traditions, the customs, the prejudices of local and familiar attachment with which it is connected, we cannot doubt the superiority of a power that rests on the instinct of patriotism, so natural to the human heart. Since legislators cannot prevent such dangerous collisions as occur between the two sovereignties which coexist in the Federal system, their first object must be, not only to dissuade the confederate states from warfare, but to encourage such dispositions as lead to peace. Hence it is that the Federal compact cannot be lasting unless there exists in the communities which are leagued together a certain number of inducements to union which render their common dependence agreeable and the task of the government light. The Federal system cannot succeed without the presence of favorable circumstances added to the influence of good laws. All the nations that have ever formed a confederation have been held together by some common interests, which served as the intellectual ties of association…. The circumstance which makes it easy to maintain a Federal government in America is not only that the states have similar interests, a common origin, and a common language, but they have also arrived at the same stage of civilization, which almost always renders a union feasible. I do not know of any European nation, however small, that does not present less uniformity in its different provinces than the American people, which occupy a territory as extensive as one half of Europe. The distance from Maine to Georgia is about one thousand miles; but the difference between the civilization of Maine and that of Georgia is slighter than the difference between the habits of Normandy and those of Brittany. Maine and Georgia, which are placed at the opposite extremities of a great empire, have therefore more real inducements to form a confederation than Normandy and Brittany, which are separated only by a brook. The geographical position of the country increased the facilities that the American legislators derived from the usages and customs of the inhabitants; and it is to this circumstance that the adoption and the maintenance of the Federal system are mainly attributable. The most important occurrence in the life of a nation is the breaking out of a war.... A long war almost always reduces nations to the wretched alternative of being abandoned to ruin by defeat or to despotism by success. War therefore renders the weakness of a government most apparent and most alarming; and I have shown that the inherent defect of federal governments is that of being weak. The federal system not only has no centralized administration, and nothing that resembles one, but the central government itself is imperfectly organized, which is always a great cause of weakness when the nation is opposed to other countries which are themselves governed by a single authority. In the Federal Constitution of the United States, where the central government has more real force than in any other confederation, this evil is extremely evident. How does it happen, then, that the American Union … is not dissolved by the occurrence of a great war? It is because it has no great wars to fear. Placed in the center of an immense continent, which offers a boundless field for human industry, the Union is almost as much insulated from the world as if all its frontiers were girt by the ocean.... The great advantage of the United States does not, then, consist in a Federal Constitution which allows it to carry on great wars, but In a geographical position which renders such wars extremely improbable. No one can be more inclined than I am to appreciate the advantages of the federal system, which I hold to be one of the combinations most favorable to the prosperity and freedom of men. I envy the lot of those nations which have been able to adopt it; but I cannot believe that any confederate people could maintain a long or an equal contest with a nation of similar strength in which the government is centralized. A people which, in the presence of the great military monarchies of Europe, should divide its sovereignty into fractional parts would, in my opinion, by that very act abdicate its power, and perhaps its existence and its name. But such is the admirable position of the New World that man has no other enemy than himself, and that, in order to be happy and to be free, he has only to determine that he will be so. ___________________________________ 1. The case in Greece when Philip undertook to execute the decrees of the Amphictyons; in the Low Countries, where the province of Holland always gave the law; and in our own time in the Germanic Confederation, In which Austria and Prussia make themselves the agents of the Diet and rule the whole confederation in its name. 2. Such has always been the situation of the Swiss Confederation, which would have perished ages ago but for the mutual jealousies of its neighbors. 3. I do not speak of a confederation of small republics, but of a great consolidated republic. Democracy in America Questions 1. Which is worse, according to Tocqueville, the tyranny of the majority or the unrestrained liberty of association? Why? 2. What differences does Tocqueville find between the use of the right of association in Europe and in America? What accounts for those differences? 3. Tocqueville writes, "extreme liberty sometimes corrects the abuses of liberty, and ... extreme democracy obviates the dangers of democracy." Explain. 4. How do voluntary associations prevent tyranny from increasing as equality increases? 5. What would produce tyranny? Could democracy produce despotism, according to Tocqueville? How? 6. Does Tocqueville believe the government should intervene in or even take over business affairs? Why or why not? 7. What must aristocratic countries do in the democratic age, according to Tocqueville? US Government Public Opinion Poll Project SURVEYS: Each group is responsible for administering 100 surveys. You must have a written record of each individual’s answers to the survey questions on the official survey form. 50 surveys will be used to construct a “straw poll.” This is a very unscientific poll designed to use any sample of the population that you wish. The other 50 surveys will be used for a “quota sample.” The quota sample is based on the makeup of the American population using numbers from the 2000 US Census. This makeup is explained below. Ethnic groups: white 83.5% (41-42 people) black 12.4% (6 people) Asian and American-Indian 4.1% (2-3 people) note: a separate listing for Hispanic is not included because the US Census Bureau considers Hispanic to mean a person of Latin American descent (especially of Cuban, Mexican, or Puerto Rican origin) living in the US who may be of any race or ethnic group (white, black, Asian, etc.) Age structure: 0-19 years: 28% (13-15 people) 20-54 years: 50% (24-26 people) 55 and over: 22% (10-12 people) Gender: Female: 51% (26 people) Male: 49% (24 people) PRESENTATION OF THE DATA: The information that you gather in the surveys is to be presented in the form of charts and/or graphs on a PowerPoint presentation, poster board, in a three-ring binder, etc…just make sure that it looks professional. There are examples of bar graphs in your book on pages 95. This is just one of the many ways that you can choose to compile your data. Once the data is input into the program, you can decide what type of graph that you want to use. Each question should have a chart relating to each answer, with the data compiled from that question. In other words, if the question that you are asking has 5 possible answers, you will have a total of 15 charts. I know that there will be a lot of questions over this project. Bear with me when I try and answer your questions…and if I still don’t make it clear to you…please LET ME KNOW!!! The questions to ask are on the following pages…remember that you MUST have a written record of each survey participant. For the quota sample, you will also want to have written on the answer sheet what gender, age group, and ethnicity they fall under. Actually, on ALL of them, you should have that written on it since you will be using those classifications to create your charts. 1. Which of the following best reflects your attitude towards the job the President has done thus far? (Strongly approve/Approve/Ambivalent/ Disapprove/Strongly disapprove) 2. Which of the following best reflects your attitude towards the choice of Hillary Clinton as Secretary of State? (Strongly approve/Approve/Ambivalent/ Disapprove/Strongly disapprove) 3. How would you rate your confidence in the American economy? (High/Ambivalent/Low) 4. How much of an effect do you feel the Department of Homeland Security will have in protecting our borders? (Strong effect/Little effect/No effect at all) 5. Of the following choices, who do you feel is the most to blame for the current recession? (Congress/the previous presidents administration/the current administration/None of the above) 6. How important do you feel the role is of family in shaping American society today? (not important/somewhat important/important/very important/ extremely important) 7. How would you best classify your feelings on having a female candidate for president? (strongly support/support/oppose/strongly oppose) 8. How would you best classify your feelings on having a minority candidate for president? (strongly support/support/oppose/strongly oppose) 9. How justified do you feel America is in the quest to create an “umbrella” missile defense system to shield against Intercontinental Ballistic Missiles? (Strongly justified/justified/ambivalent/unjustified/strongly unjustified) 10. How important do you feel the role is of religion in shaping American society today? (not important/somewhat important/important/very important/ extremely important) 11. How would you rate your confidence in the world economy? (High/Ambivalent/Low) 12. Which of the following best reflects your attitude towards the American government’s handling of terrorists? (Strongly approve/Approve/Ambivalent/ Disapprove/Strongly disapprove) 13. Which of the following statements best reflects your attitude about the Electoral College? (it should be abolished/it should be reformed/it should be left alone) 14. Which of the following statements best reflects your attitude toward abortion? (I am pro-life/I am pro-life with some exceptions/I am pro-choice with some exceptions/I am pro-choice) 15. Which of the following best reflects your attitude toward affirmative action programs in the United States? (strongly support/support/ambivalent/oppose/ strongly oppose) 16. How much would you support a raise in the national income tax to strengthen our military? (strongly support/support/ambivalent/oppose/strongly oppose) 17. How much would you support a raise in the national income tax to strengthen the Social Security program? (strongly support/support/ambivalent/oppose/ strongly oppose) 18. Which of the following best reflects your views towards expanding gay and lesbian rights? (strongly agree/agree/ambivalent/disagree/strongly disagree) 19. Which of the following best reflects your views on increasing the military presence on our borders with neighboring nations? (strongly agree/agree/ ambivalent/disagree/strongly disagree) 20. Which of the following best describes your self-professed political affiliation? (Democrat/Republican/Libertarian/Green/Independent/No affiliation) 1. 2. 3. 4. Name the two senators from the state of California. In what document would you find the phrase “all men are created equal”? How many United States senators are there? If the president and the vice-president were to die at the same time, who would become president, according to the Constitution? 5. In your opinion, what is the most serious problem facing America today? Public Opinion Poll EXAMPLE QUESTION 1 Which of the following best reflects your attitude towards the job the President has done thus far? AGE Strong Approve 8% 0-19 years 20-54 years 55 and over Disapprove 15% Approve 50% Ambiv. 22% ETHNICITY White Strong Disappr ove 5% Black Asian and Amer-Indian GENDER Male Female Creating Charts 1. Open Excel 2. Type in data as shown in example: 3. Select data from worksheet that you want to include in your chart 4. Click on Chart Wizard 5. Select type of graph 6. Final Product Chapter 5 Study Questions Public Opinion 1. What was the Founders’ attitude towards public opinion? Give examples of how we see that attitude reflected in how they wrote the Constitution. 2. Identify three problems in assessing public opinion. 3. The book gives four factors that affect political attitudes. Identify those four factors and summarize the conclusions about how those factors affect people’s political attitudes. Memorize this list. 4. The book gives three factors that divide people’s political beliefs. Identify those three factors and summarize the conclusions about the correlation between these factors and people’s political opinions. Memorize this. 5. What were the meanings of the words “liberal” and “conservative” in the 19th century and how did these meanings change in the 20th century? 6. Summarize the four ideological labels the authors describe on pp. 121-22. Feel free to use a chart or bullet points for your summary. 7. What are the two reasons the book gives why activists or the political elite tend to have more ideological consistency than those who aren’t active? What effect does this ideological consistency have on the difference ideologically between politicians and voters? 8. What does the term “new class” mean? What political ideology to those in the “new class” ascribe to? Why? 9. How do elites influence public opinion? What are the limits to their ability to shape public opinion? 10. If David Brooks was to represent the average voter who votes “Blue” what are his initial impressions of a typical “Red” voter? 11. According to Brooks, what causes the ideological divide between “Blue” and “Red” voters in the United States? Do you think his opinions are accurate? Explain your viewpoint. Conservative Gender gap John Q. Public Liberal Libertarians Middle America Norm Political elite Terms Political ideology Poll Populists Random sample Religious tradition Sampling error Silent majority Social status ONE NATION, SLIGHTLY DIVISIBLE The electoral map of the 2000 presidential race became famous: big blocks of red (denoting states that went for Bush) stretched across the heartland, with brackets of blue (denoting states for Gore) along the coasts. Our Blue America correspondent has ventured repeatedly into Red territory. He asks the question—after September 11, a pressing one—Do our differences effectively split us into two nations, or are they just cracks in a still-united whole? BY D AVID B ROOKS Sixty-five miles from where I am writing this sentence is a place with no Starbucks, no Pottery Barn, no Borders or Barnes & Noble. No blue New York Times delivery bags dot the driveways on Sunday mornings. In this place people don't complain that Woody Allen isn't as funny as he used to be, because they never thought he was funny. In this place you can go to a year's worth of dinner parties without hearing anyone quote an aperçu he first heard on Charlie Rose. The people here don't buy those little rear-window stickers when they go to a summer-vacation spot so that they can drive around with "MV" decals the rest of the year; for the most part they don't even go to Martha's Vineyard. The place I'm talking about goes by different names. Some call it America. Others call it Middle America. It has also come to be known as Red America, in reference to the maps that were produced on the night of the 2000 presidential election. People in Blue America, which is my part of America, tend to live around big cities on the coasts. People in Red America tend to live on farms or in small towns or small cities far away from the coasts. Things are different there. Everything that people in my neighborhood do without motors, the people in Red America do with motors. We sail; they powerboat. We cross-country ski; they snowmobile. We hike; they drive ATVs. We have vineyard tours; they have tractor pulls. When it comes to yard work, they have rider mowers; we have illegal aliens. Different sorts of institutions dominate life in these two places. In Red America churches are everywhere. In Blue America Thai restaurants are everywhere. In Red America they have QVC, the Pro Bowlers Tour, and hunting. In Blue America we have NPR, Doris Kearns Goodwin, and socially conscious investing. In Red America the Wal-Marts are massive, with parking lots the size of state parks. In Blue America the stores are small but the markups are big. You'll rarely see a Christmas store in Blue America, but in Red America, even in July, you'll come upon stores selling fake Christmas trees, wreath-decorated napkins, Rudolph the RedNosed Reindeer collectible thimbles and spoons, and little snow-covered villages. We in the coastal metro Blue areas read more books and attend more plays than the people in the Red heartland. We're more sophisticated and cosmopolitan—just ask us about our alumni trips to China or Provence, or our interest in Buddhism. But don't ask us, please, what life in Red America is like. We don't know. We don't know who Tim LaHaye and Jerry B. Jenkins are, even though the novels they have co-written have sold about 40 million copies over the past few years. We don't know what James Dobson says on his radio program, which is listened to by millions. We don't know about Reba or Travis. We don't know what happens in mega-churches on Wednesday evenings, and some of us couldn't tell you the difference between a fundamentalist and an evangelical, let alone describe what it means to be a Pentecostal. Very few of us know what goes on in Branson, Missouri, even though it has seven million visitors a year, or could name even five NASCAR drivers, although stock-car races are the best-attended sporting events in the country. We don't know how to shoot or clean a rifle. We can't tell a military officer's rank by looking at his insignia. We don't know what soy beans look like when they're growing in a field. All we know, or all we think we know, about Red America is that millions and millions of its people live quietly underneath flight patterns, many of them are racist and homophobic, and when you see them at highway rest stops, they're often really fat and their clothes are too tight. And apparently we don't want to know any more than that. One can barely find any books at Amazon.com about what it is like to live in small-town America—or, at least, any books written by normal people who grew up in small towns, liked them, and stayed there. The few books that do exist were written either by people who left the heartland because they hated it (Bill Bryson's The Lost Continent, for example) or by urbanites who moved to Red America as part of some life-simplification plan (Moving to a Small Town: A Guidebook for Moving from Urban to Rural America; National Geographic's Guide to Small Town Escapes). Apparently no publishers or members of the Blue book-buying public are curious about Red America as seen through Red America's eyes. CROSSING THE MEATLOAF LINE Over the past several months, my interest piqued by those stark blocks of color on the election-night maps, I have every now and then left my home in Montgomery County, Maryland, and driven sixty-five miles northwest to Franklin County, in south-central Pennsylvania. Montgomery County is one of the steaming-hot centers of the great espresso machine that is Blue America. It is just over the border from northwestern Washington, D.C., and it is full of upper-middle-class towns inhabited by lawyers, doctors, stockbrokers, and establishment journalists like me—towns like Chevy Chase, Potomac, and Bethesda (where I live). Its central artery is a burgeoning high-tech corridor with a multitude of sparkling new office parks housing technology companies such as United Information Systems and Sybase, and pioneering biotech firms such as Celera Genomics and Human Genome Sciences. When I drive to Franklin County, I take Route 270. After about forty-five minutes I pass a Cracker Barrel—Red America condensed into chain-restaurant form. I've crossed the Meatloaf Line; from here on there will be a lot fewer sun-dried-tomato concoctions on restaurant menus and a lot more meatloaf platters. Franklin County is Red America. It's a rural county, about twenty-five miles west of Gettysburg, and it includes the towns of Waynesboro, Chambersburg, and Mercersburg. It was originally settled by the ScotchIrish, and has plenty of Brethren and Mennonites along with a fast-growing population of evangelicals. The joke that Pennsylvanians tell about their state is that it has Philadelphia on one end, Pittsburgh on the other, and Alabama in the middle. Franklin County is in the Alabama part. It strikes me as I drive there that even though I am going north across the Mason-Dixon line, I feel as if I were going south. The local culture owes more to Nashville, Houston, and Daytona than to Washington, Philadelphia, or New York. I shuttled back and forth between Franklin and Montgomery Counties because the cultural differences between the two places are great, though the geographic distance is small. The two places are not perfect microcosms of Red and Blue America. The part of Montgomery County I am here describing is largely the Caucasian part. Moreover, Franklin County is in a Red part of a Blue state: overall, Pennsylvania went for Gore. And I went to Franklin County aware that there are tremendous differences within Red America, just as there are within Blue. Franklin County is quite different from, say, Scottsdale, Arizona, just as Bethesda is quite different from Oakland, California. Nonetheless, the contrasts between the two counties leap out, and they are broadly suggestive of the sorts of contrasts that can be seen nationwide. When Blue America talks about social changes that convulsed society, it tends to mean the 1960s rise of the counterculture and feminism. When Red America talks about changes that convulsed society, it tends to mean World War II, which shook up old town establishments and led to a great surge of industry. Red America makes social distinctions that Blue America doesn't. For example, in Franklin County there seems to be a distinction between those fiercely independent people who live in the hills and people who live in the valleys. I got a hint of the distinct and, to me, exotic hill culture when a hill dweller asked me why I thought hunting for squirrel and rabbit had gone out of fashion. I thought maybe it was just more fun to hunt something bigger. But he said, "McDonald's. It's cheaper to get a hamburger at McDonald's than to go out and get it yourself." There also seems to be an important distinction between men who work outdoors and men who work indoors. The outdoor guys wear faded black T-shirts they once picked up at a Lynyrd Skynyrd concert and wrecked jeans that appear to be washed faithfully at least once a year. They've got wraparound NASCAR sunglasses, maybe a NAPA auto parts cap, and hair cut in a short wedge up front but flowing down over their shoulders in the back—a cut that is known as a mullet, which is sort of a cross between Van Halen's style and Kenny Rogers's, and is the ugliest hairdo since every hairdo in the seventies. The outdoor guys are heavily accessorized, and their accessories are meant to show how hard they work, so they will often have a gigantic wad of keys hanging from a belt loop, a tape measure strapped to the belt, a pocket knife on a string tucked into the front pants pocket, and a pager or a cell phone affixed to the hip, presumably in case some power lines go down somewhere and need emergency repair. Outdoor guys have a thing against sleeves. They work so hard that they've got to keep their arm muscles unencumbered and their armpit hair fully ventilated, so they either buy their shirts sleeveless or rip the sleeves off their T-shirts first thing, leaving bits of fringe hanging over their BAD TO THE BONE tattoos. The guys who work indoors can't project this rugged proletarian image. It's simply not that romantic to be a bank-loan officer or a shift manager at the local distribution center. So the indoor guys adopt a look that a smart-ass, sneering Blue American might call Bible-academy casual—maybe Haggar slacks, which they bought at a dry-goods store best known for its appliance department, and a short-sleeved white Van Heusen shirt from the Bon-Ton. Their image projects not "I work hard" but "I'm a devoted family man." A lot of indoor guys have a sensitive New Age demeanor. When they talk about the days their kids were born, their eyes take on a soft Garth Brooks expression, and they tear up. They exaggerate how sinful they were before they were born again. On Saturdays they are patio masters, barbecuing on their gas grills in full Father's Dayapron regalia. At first I thought the indoor guys were the faithful, reliable ones: the ones who did well in school, whereas the outdoor guys were druggies. But after talking with several preachers in Franklin County, I learned that it's not that simple. Sometimes the guys who look like bikers are the most devoted community-service volunteers and church attendees. The kinds of distinctions we make in Blue America are different. In my world the easiest way to categorize people is by headroom needs. People who went to business school or law school like a lot of headroom. They buy humongous sport-utility vehicles that practically have cathedral ceilings over the front seats. They live in homes the size of country clubs, with soaring entry atriums so high that they could practically fly a kite when they come through the front door. These big-headroom people tend to be predators: their jobs have them negotiating and competing all day. They spend small fortunes on dry cleaning. They grow animated when talking about how much they love their blackberries. They fill their enormous wall space with huge professional family portraits—Mom and Dad with their perfect kids (dressed in light-blue oxford shirts) laughing happily in an orchard somewhere. Small-headroom people tend to have been liberal-arts majors, and they have liberal-arts jobs. They get passive-aggressive pleasure from demonstrating how modest and environmentally sensitive their living containers are. They hate people with SUVs, and feel virtuous driving around in their low-ceilinged little Hondas, which often display a RANDOM ACTS OF KINDNESS bumper sticker or one bearing an image of a fish with legs, along with the word "Darwin," just to show how intellectually superior to fundamentalist Christians they are. Some of the biggest differences between Red and Blue America show up on statistical tables. Ethnic diversity is one. In Montgomery County 60 percent of the population is white, 15 percent is black, 12 percent is Hispanic, and 11 percent is Asian. In Franklin County 95 percent of the population is white. White people work the gas-station pumps and the 7-Eleven counters. (This is something one doesn't often see in my part of the country.) Although the nation is growing more diverse, it's doing so only in certain spots. According to an analysis of the 2000 census by Bill Frey, a demographer at the Milken Institute, well over half the counties in America are still at least 85 percent white. Another big thing is that, according to 1990 census data, in Franklin County only 12 percent of the adults have college degrees and only 69 percent have high school diplomas. In Montgomery County 50 percent of the adults have college degrees and 91 percent have high school diplomas. The education gap extends to the children. At Walt Whitman High School, a public school in Bethesda, the average SAT scores are 601 verbal and 622 math, whereas the national average is 506 verbal and 514 math. In Franklin County, where people are quite proud of their schools, the average SAT scores at, for example, the Waynesboro area high school are 495 verbal and 480 math. More and more kids in Franklin County are going on to college, but it is hard to believe that their prospects will be as bright as those of the kids in Montgomery County and the rest of upscale Blue America. Because the information age rewards education with money, it's not surprising that Montgomery County is much richer than Franklin County. According to some estimates, in Montgomery County 51 percent of households have annual incomes above $75,000, and the average household income is $100,365. In Franklin County only 16 percent of households have incomes above $75,000, and the average is $51,872. A major employer in Montgomery County is the National Institutes of Health, which grows like a scientific boomtown in Bethesda. A major economic engine in Franklin County is the interstate highway Route 81. Trucking companies have gotten sick of fighting the congestion on Route 95, which runs up the Blue corridor along the northeast coast, so they move their stuff along 81, farther inland. Several new distribution centers have been built along 81 in Franklin County, and some of the workers who were laid off when their factories closed, several years ago, are now settling for $8.00 or $9.00 an hour loading boxes. The two counties vote differently, of course—the differences, on a nationwide scale, were what led to those red-and-blue maps. Like upscale areas everywhere, from Silicon Valley to Chicago's North Shore to suburban Connecticut, Montgomery County supported the Democratic ticket in last year's presidential election, by a margin of 63 percent to 34 percent. Meanwhile, like almost all of rural America, Franklin County went Republican, by 67 percent to 30 percent. However, other voting patterns sometimes obscure the Red-Blue cultural divide. For example, minority voters all over the country overwhelmingly supported the Democratic ticket last November. But—in many respects, at least—blacks and Hispanics in Red America are more traditionalist than blacks and Hispanics in Blue America, just as their white counterparts are. For example, the Pew Research Center for the People and the Press, in Washington, D.C., recently found that 45 percent of minority members in Red states agree with the statement "AIDS might be God's punishment for immoral sexual behavior," but only 31 percent of minority members in Blue states do. Similarly, 40 percent of minorities in Red states believe that school boards should have the right to fire homosexual teachers, but only 21 percent of minorities in Blue states do. FROM CRACKS TO A CHASM? These differences are so many and so stark that they lead to some pretty troubling questions: Are Americans any longer a common people? Do we have one national conversation and one national culture? Are we loyal to the same institutions and the same values? How do people on one side of the divide regard those on the other? I went to Franklin County because I wanted to get a sense of how deep the divide really is, to see how people there live, and to gauge how different their lives are from those in my part of America. I spoke with ministers, journalists, teachers, community leaders, and pretty much anyone I ran across. I consulted with pollsters, demographers, and market-research firms. Toward the end of my project the World Trade Center and the Pentagon were attacked. This put a new slant on my little investigation. In the days immediately following September 11 the evidence seemed clear that despite our differences, we are still a united people. American flags flew everywhere in Franklin County and in Montgomery County. Patriotism surged. Pollsters started to measure Americans' reactions to the events. Whatever questions they asked, the replies were near unanimous. Do you support a military response against terror? More than four fifths of Americans said yes. Do you support a military response even if it means thousands of U.S. casualties? More than three fifths said yes. There were no significant variations across geographic or demographic lines. A sweeping feeling of solidarity was noticeable in every neighborhood, school, and workplace. Headlines blared, "A NATION UNITED" and "UNITED STATE." An attack had been made on the very epicenter of Blue America—downtown Manhattan. And in a flash all the jokes about and seeming hostility toward New Yorkers vanished, to be replaced by an outpouring of respect, support, and love. The old hostility came to seem merely a sort of sibling rivalry, which means nothing when the family itself is under threat. But very soon there were hints that the solidarity was fraying. A few stray notes of dissent were sounded in the organs of Blue America. Susan Sontag wrote a sour piece in The New Yorker about how depressing it was to see what she considered to be a simplistically pro-American reaction to the attacks. At rallies on college campuses across the country speakers pointed out that America had been bombing other countries for years, and turnabout was fair play. On one NPR talk show I heard numerous callers express unease about what they saw as a crude us-versus-them mentality behind President Bush's rhetoric. Katha Pollitt wrote in The Nation that she would not permit her daughter to hang the American flag from the living-room window, because, she felt, it "stands for jingoism and vengeance and war." And there was evidence that among those with lessstrident voices, too, differences were beginning to show. Polls revealed that people without a college education were far more confident than people with a college education that the military could defeat the terrorists. People in the South were far more eager than people in the rest of the country for an American counterattack to begin. It started to seem likely that these cracks would widen once the American response got under way, when the focus would be not on firemen and rescue workers but on the Marines, the CIA, and the special-operations forces. If the war was protracted, the cracks could widen into a chasm, as they did during Vietnam. Red America, the home of patriotism and military service (there's a big military-recruitment center in downtown Chambersburg), would undoubtedly support the war effort, but would Blue America (there's a big gourmet dog bakery in downtown Bethesda) decide that a crude military response would only deepen animosities and make things worse? So toward the end of my project I investigated Franklin County with a heightened sense of gravity and with much more urgency. If America was not firmly united in the early days of the conflict, we would certainly not be united later, when the going got tough. "THE PEOPLE VERSUS THE POWERFUL" There are a couple of long-standing theories about why America is divided. One of the main ones holds that the division is along class lines, between the haves and the have-nots. This theory is popular chiefly on the left, and can be found in the pages of The American Prospect and other liberal magazines; in news reports by liberal journalists such as Donald L. Barlett and James B. Steele, of Time; and in books such as Middle Class Dreams (1995), by the Clinton and Gore pollster Stanley Greenberg, and America's Forgotten Majority: Why the White Working Class Still Matters (2000), by the demographer Ruy Teixeira and the social scientist Joel Rogers. According to this theory, during most of the twentieth century gaps in income between the rich and the poor in America gradually shrank. Then came the information age. The rich started getting spectacularly richer, the poor started getting poorer, and wages for the middle class stagnated, at best. Over the previous decade, these writers emphasized, remuneration for top-level executives had skyrocketed: now the average CEO made 116 times as much as the average rank-and-file worker. Assembly-line workers found themselves competing for jobs against Third World workers who earned less than a dollar an hour. Those who had once labored at wellpaying blue-collar jobs were forced to settle for poorly paying service-economy jobs without benefits. People with graduate degrees have done well over the past couple of decades: their real hourly wages climbed by 13 percent from 1979 to 1997, according to Teixeira and Rogers. But those with only some college education saw their wages fall by nine percent, while those with only high school diplomas saw their wages fall by 12 percent, and high school dropouts saw a stunning 26 percent decline in their pay. Such trends have created a new working class, these writers argue—not a traditional factory-and-mill working class but a suburban and small-town working class, made up largely of service workers and low-level whitecollar employees. Teixeira and Rogers estimate that the average household income for this group, which accounts for about 55 percent of American adults, is roughly $42,000. "It is not hard to imagine how [recent economic trends] must have felt to the forgotten majority man," they write. As at least part of America was becoming ever more affluent, an affluence that was well covered on television and in the evening news, he did not seem to be making much progress. What could he be doing wrong to be faring so poorly? Why couldn't he afford what others could? And why were they moving ahead while he was standing still? Stanley Greenberg tailored Al Gore's presidential campaign to appeal to such voters. Gore's most significant slogan was "The People Versus the Powerful," which was meant to rally members of the middle class who felt threatened by "powerful forces" beyond their control, such as HMOs, tobacco companies, big corporations, and globalization, and to channel their resentment against the upper class. Gore dressed down throughout his campaign in the hope that these middle-class workers would identify with him. Driving from Bethesda to Franklin County, one can see that the theory of a divide between the classes has a certain plausibility. In Montgomery County we have Saks Fifth Avenue, Cartier, Anthropologie, Brooks Brothers. In Franklin County they have Dollar General and Value City, along with a plethora of secondhand stores. It's as if Franklin County has only forty-five coffee tables, which are sold again and again. When the locals are asked about their economy, they tell a story very similar to the one that Greenberg, Teixeira, Rogers, and the rest of the wage-stagnation liberals recount. There used to be plenty of good factory jobs in Franklin County, and people could work at those factories for life. But some of the businesses, including the textile company J. Schoeneman, once Franklin County's largest manufacturer, have closed. Others have moved offshore. The remaining manufacturers, such as Grove Worldwide and JLG Industries, which both make cranes and aerial platforms, have laid off workers. The local Army depot, Letterkenny, has radically shrunk its work force. The new jobs are in distribution centers or nursing homes. People tend to repeat the same phrase: "We've taken some hits." And yet when they are asked about the broader theory, whether there is class conflict between the educated affluents and the stagnant middles, they stare blankly as if suddenly the interview were being conducted in Aramaic. I kept asking, Do you feel that the highly educated people around, say, New York and Washington are getting all the goodies? Do you think there is resentment toward all the latte sippers who shop at Nieman Marcus? Do you see a gulf between high-income people in the big cities and middle-income people here? I got only polite, fumbling answers as people tried to figure out what the hell I was talking about. When I rephrased the question in more-general terms, as Do you believe the country is divided between the haves and the have-nots?, everyone responded decisively: yes. But as the conversation continued, it became clear that the people saying yes did not consider themselves to be among the have-nots. Even people with incomes well below the median thought of themselves as haves. What I found was entirely consistent with the election returns from November of last year. Gore's pitch failed miserably among the voters it was intended to target: nationally he lost among non-college-educated white voters by 17 points and among non-college-educated white men by 29 points. But it worked beautifully on the affluent, educated class: for example, Gore won among women with graduate degrees by 22 points. The lesson seems to be that if you run a campaign under the slogan "The People Versus the Powerful," you will not do well in the places where "the people" live, but you will do fantastically well in the places where "the powerful" live. This phenomenon mirrors, on a larger scale, one I noted a couple of years ago, when I traveled the country for a year talking about Bobos in Paradise, a book I had written on upscale America. The richer the community, the more likely I was to be asked about wage inequality. In middle-class communities the subject almost never came up. Hanging around Franklin County, one begins to understand some of the reasons that people there don't spend much time worrying about economic class lines. The first and most obvious one is that although the incomes in Franklin County are lower than those in Montgomery County, living expenses are also lower—very much so. Driving from Montgomery County to Franklin County is like driving through an invisible deflation machine. Gas is thirty, forty, or even fifty cents a gallon cheaper in Franklin County. I parked at meters that accepted only pennies and nickels. When I got a parking ticket in Chambersburg, the fine was $3.00. At the department store in Greencastle there were racks and racks of blouses for $9.99. The biggest difference is in real-estate prices. In Franklin County one can buy a nice four-bedroom split-level house with about 2,200 square feet of living space for $150,000 to $180,000. In Bethesda that same house would cost about $450,000. (According to the Coldwell Banker Real Estate Corporation, that house would sell for $784,000 in Greenwich, Connecticut; for $812,000 in Manhattan Beach, California; and for about $1.23 million in Palo Alto, California.) Some of the people I met in Franklin County were just getting by. Some were in debt and couldn't afford to buy their kids the Christmas presents they wanted to. But I didn't find many who assessed their own place in society according to their income. Rather, the people I met commonly told me that although those in affluent places like Manhattan and Bethesda might make more money and have more-exciting jobs, they are the unlucky ones, because they don't get to live in Franklin County. They don't get to enjoy the beautiful green hillsides, the friendly people, the wonderful church groups and volunteer organizations. They may be nice people and all, but they are certainly not as happy as we are. Another thing I found is that most people don't think sociologically. They don't compare themselves with faraway millionaires who appear on their TV screens. They compare themselves with their neighbors. "One of the challenges we face is that it is hard to get people to look beyond the four-state region," Lynne Woehrle, a sociologist at Wilson College, in Chambersburg, told me, referring to the cultural zone composed of the nearby rural areas in Pennsylvania, West Virginia, Maryland, and Virginia. Many of the people in Franklin County view the lifestyles of the upper class in California or Seattle much the way we in Blue America might view the lifestyle of someone in Eritrea or Mongolia—or, for that matter, Butte, Montana. Such ways of life are distant and basically irrelevant, except as a source of academic interest or titillation. One man in Mercersburg, Pennsylvania, told me about a friend who had recently bought a car. "He paid twenty-five thousand dollars for that car!" he exclaimed, his eyes wide with amazement. "He got it fully loaded." I didn't tell him that in Bethesda almost no one but a college kid pays as little as $25,000 for a car. Franklin County is a world in which there is little obvious inequality, and the standard of living is reasonably comfortable. Youth-soccer teams are able to raise money for a summer trip to England; the Lowe's hardware superstore carries Laura Ashley carpets; many people have pools, although they are almost always above ground; the planning commission has to cope with an increasing number of cars in the county every year, even though the population is growing only gradually. But the sort of high-end experiences that are everywhere in Montgomery County are entirely missing here. On my journeys to Franklin County, I set a goal: I was going to spend $20 on a restaurant meal. But although I ordered the most expensive thing on the menu—steak au jus, "slippery beef pot pie," or whatever—I always failed. I began asking people to direct me to the most-expensive places in town. They would send me to Red Lobster or Applebee's. I'd go into a restaurant that looked from the outside as if it had some pretensions— maybe a "Les Desserts" glass cooler for the key-lime pie and the tapioca pudding. I'd scan the menu and realize that I'd been beaten once again. I went through great vats of chipped beef and "seafood delight" trying to drop twenty dollars. I waded through enough surf-and-turfs and enough creamed corn to last a lifetime. I could not do it. No wonder people in Franklin County have no class resentment or class consciousness; where they live, they can afford just about anything that is for sale. (In Montgomery County, however—and this is one of the most striking contrasts between the two counties—almost nobody can say that. In Blue America, unless you are very, very rich, there is always, all around you, stuff for sale that you cannot afford.) And if they sought to improve their situation, they would look only to themselves. If a person wants to make more money, the feeling goes, he or she had better work hard and think like an entrepreneur. I could barely get fifteen minutes into an interview before the local work ethic came up. Karen Jewell, who helps to oversee the continuing-education program for the local Penn State branch campus, told me, "People are very vested in what they do. There's an awareness of where they fit in the organization. They feel empowered to be agents of change." People do work extremely hard in Franklin County—even people in supposedly dead-end jobs. You can see it in little things, such as drugstore shelves. The drugstores in Bethesda look the way Rome must have looked after a visit from the Visigoths. But in Franklin County the boxes are in perfect little rows. Shelves are fully stocked, and cans are evenly spaced. The floors are less dusty than those in a microchip-processing plant. The nail clippers on a rack by the cash register are arranged with a precision that would put the Swiss to shame. There are few unions in Franklin County. People abhor the thought of depending on welfare; they consider themselves masters of their own economic fate. "People are really into the free market here," Bill Pukmel, formerly the editor of the weekly paper in Chambersburg, told me. In sum, I found absolutely no evidence that a Stanley Greenberg-prompted Democratic Party (or a Pat Buchanan-led Republican Party) could mobilize white middle-class Americans on the basis of class consciousness. I found no evidence that economic differences explain much of anything about the divide between Red and Blue America. Ted Hale, a Presbyterian minister in the western part of the county, spoke of the matter this way: "There's nowhere near as much resentment as you would expect. People have come to understand that they will struggle financially. It's part of their identity. But the economy is not their god. That's the thing some others don't understand. People value a sense of community far more than they do their portfolio." Hale, who worked at a church in East Hampton, New York, before coming to Franklin County, said that he saw a lot more economic resentment in New York. Hale's observations are supported by nationwide polling data. Pew has conducted a broad survey of the differences between Red and Blue states. The survey found that views on economic issues do not explain the different voting habits in the two regions. There simply isn't much of the sort of economic dissatisfaction that could drive a class-based political movement. Eighty-five percent of Americans with an annual household income between $30,000 and $50,000 are satisfied with their housing. Nearly 70 percent are satisfied with the kind of car they can afford. Roughly two thirds are satisfied with their furniture and their ability to afford a night out. These levels of satisfaction are not very different from those found in upper-middle-class America. The Pew researchers found this sort of trend in question after question. Part of the draft of their report is titled "Economic Divide Dissolves." A LOT OF RELIGION BUT FEW CRUSADERS This leaves us with the second major hypothesis about the nature of the divide between Red and Blue America, which comes mainly from conservatives: America is divided between two moral systems. Red America is traditional, religious, self-disciplined, and patriotic. Blue America is modern, secular, selfexpressive, and discomfited by blatant displays of patriotism. Proponents of this hypothesis in its most radical form contend that America is in the midst of a culture war, with two opposing armies fighting on behalf of their views. The historian Gertrude Himmelfarb offered a more moderate picture in One Nation, Two Cultures (1999), in which she argued that although America is not fatally split, it is deeply divided, between a heartland conservative population that adheres to a strict morality and a liberal population that lives by a loose one. The political journalist Michael Barone put it this way in a recent essay in National Journal: "The two Americas apparent in the 48 percent to 48 percent 2000 election are two nations of different faiths. One is observant, tradition-minded, moralistic. The other is unobservant, liberation-minded, relativistic." The values-divide school has a fair bit of statistical evidence on its side. Whereas income is a poor predictor of voting patterns, church attendance—as Barone points out—is a pretty good one. Of those who attend religious services weekly (42 percent of the electorate), 59 percent voted for Bush, 39 percent for Gore. Of those who seldom or never attend religious services (another 42 percent), 56 percent voted for Gore, 39 percent for Bush. The Pew data reveal significant divides on at least a few values issues. Take, for example, the statement "We will all be called before God on Judgment Day to answer for our sins." In Red states 70 percent of the people believe that statement. In Blue states only 50 percent do. One can feel the religiosity in Franklin County after a single day's visit. It's on the bumper stickers: WARNING: IN CASE OF RAPTURE THIS VEHICLE WILL BE UNMANNED. REAL TRUCKERS TALK ABOUT JESUS ON CHANNEL 10. It's on the radio. The airwaves are filled not with the usual mixture of hit tunes but with evangelicals preaching the gospel. The book section of Wal-Mart features titles such as The Beginner's Guide to Fasting, Deepen Your Conversation with God, and Are We Living in the End Times? Some general stores carry the "Heroes of the Faith" series, which consists of small biographies of William Carey, George Müller, and other notable missionaries, ministers, and theologians—notable in Red America, that is, but largely unknown where I live. Chambersburg and its vicinity have eighty-five churches and one synagogue. The Bethesda-Chevy Chase area, which has a vastly greater population, has forty-five churches and five synagogues. Professors at the local college in Chambersburg have learned not to schedule public lectures on Wednesday nights, because everybody is at prayer meetings. Events that are part of daily life in Franklin County are unheard of in most of Blue America. One United Brethren minister told me that he is asked to talk about morals in the public school as part of the health and sex-education curriculum, and nobody raises a fuss. A number of schools have a "Bible release program," whereby elementary school students are allowed to leave school for an hour a week to attend Bible-study meetings. At an elementary school in Waynesboro the Gideons used to distribute Bibles to any students who wanted them. (That ended after the village agnostic threatened to simultaneously distribute a booklet called God Is Just Pretend.) There are healing ministries all throughout Franklin County, and even mainstream denominations have healing teams on hand after Sunday services. As in most places where evangelism is strong, the locals are fervently pro-Israel. Almost every minister I visited has mementos in his study from visits to Jerusalem. A few had lived in Israel for extended periods and spoke Hebrew. One delivered a tirade against CNN for its bias against the Jewish state. One or two pointed out (without quite bragging) that whereas some Jewish groups had canceled trips to Israel since the upsurge in intifada violence, evangelical groups were still going. David Rawley, a United Brethren minister in Green castle, spoke for many of the social conservatives I met when he said that looking at the mainstream Hollywood culture made him feel that he was "walking against the current." "The tremendous force of culture means we can either float or fight," Rawley said. "Should you drift or stand on a rock? I tell people there is a rock we can hang on—the word of God. That rock will never give way. That rock's never going to move." When I asked Rawley what he thought of big-city culture, he said, "The individual is swallowed up by the largeness of the city. I see a world that doesn't want to take responsibility for itself. They have the babies but they decide they're not going to be the daddies. I'd really have to cling to the rock if I lived there." I met with Rawley at the height of the scandal involving Representative Gary Condit and the missing intern Chandra Levy. Levy's mother was quoted in The Washington Times as calling herself a "Heinz 57 mutt" when it came to religion. "All religions tie to similar beliefs," she said. "I believe in spirituality and God. I'm Jewish. I think we have a wonderful religion. I'm also Christian. I do believe in Jesus, too." The contrast between her New Age approach to spirituality and Rawley's Red America one could not have been greater. Life is complicated, however. Yes, there are a lot of churches in Franklin County; there are also a lot of tattoo parlors. And despite all the churches and bumper stickers, Franklin County doesn't seem much different from anywhere else. People go to a few local bars to hang out after softball games. Teenagers drive recklessly along fast-food strips. Young women in halter tops sometimes prowl in the pool halls. The local college has a gay-and-lesbian group. One conservative clergyman I spoke with estimated that 10 percent of his congregants are gay. He believes that church is the place where one should be able to leave the controversy surrounding this sort of issue behind. Another described how his congregation united behind a young man who was dying of AIDS. Sex seems to be on people's minds almost as much as it is anywhere else. Conservative evangelical circles have their own sex manuals (Tim LaHaye wrote one of them before he moved on to the "Left Behind" series), which appear to have had some effect: according to a 1994 study conducted by researchers at the University of Chicago, conservative Protestant women have more orgasms than any other group. Franklin County is probably a bit more wholesome than most suburbs in Blue America. (The notion that deviance and corruption lie underneath the seeming conformism of suburban middle-class life, popular in Hollywood and in creative-writing workshops, is largely nonsense.) But it has most of the problems that afflict other parts of the country: heroin addiction, teen pregnancy, and so on. Nobody I spoke to felt part of a pristine culture that is exempt from the problems of the big cities. There are even enough spectacular crimes in Franklin County to make a devoted New York Post reader happy. During one of my visits the front pages of the local papers were ablaze with the tale of a young woman arrested for assault and homicide after shooting her way through a Veterans of the Vietnam War post. It was reported that she had intended to rob the post for money to run away with her lesbian girlfriend. If the problems are the same as in the rest of America, so are many of the solutions. Franklin County residents who find themselves in trouble go to their clergy first, but they are often referred to psychologists and therapists as part of their recovery process. Prozac is a part of life. Almost nobody I spoke with understood, let alone embraced, the concept of a culture war. Few could see themselves as fighting such a war, in part because few have any idea where the boundary between the two sides lies. People in Franklin County may have a clear sense of what constitutes good or evil (many people in Blue America have trouble with the very concept of evil), but they will say that good and evil are in all neighborhoods, as they are in all of us. People take the Scriptures seriously but have no interest in imposing them on others. One finds little crusader zeal in Franklin County. For one thing, people in small towns don't want to offend people whom they'll be encountering on the street for the next fifty years. Potentially controversial subjects are often played down. "We would never take a stance on gun control or abortion," Sue Hadden, the editor of the Waynesboro paper, told me. Whenever I asked what the local view of abortion was, I got the same response: "We don't talk about it much," or "We try to avoid that subject." Bill Pukmel, the former Chambersburg newspaper editor, says, "A majority would be opposed to abortion around here, but it wouldn't be a big majority." It would simply be uncivil to thrust such a raw disagreement in people's faces. William Harter, a Presbyterian minister in Chambersburg, spans the divide between Red and Blue America. Harter was raised on a farm near Buffalo. He went to the prestigious Deerfield Academy, in Massachusetts, before getting a bachelor's degree in history from Williams College, a master's in education from Harvard, and, after serving for a while in the military, a Ph.D. in Judaism and Christian origins from the Union Theological Seminary, in Manhattan. He has lived in Chambersburg for the past twenty-four years, and he says that the range of opinion in Franklin County is much wider than it was in Cambridge or New York. "We're more authentically pluralistic here," he told me. I found Harter and the other preachers in Franklin County especially interesting to talk with. That was in part because the ones I met were fiercely intelligent and extremely well read, but also because I could see them wrestling with the problem of how to live according to the Scriptures while being inclusive and respectful of others' freedoms. For example, many of them struggle over whether it is right to marry a couple who are already living together. This would not be a consideration in most of Blue America. "Some of the evangelicals won't marry [such couples]," Harter told me. "Others will insist that they live apart for six months before they'll marry them. But that's not the real world. These couples often don't understand the theological basis for not living together. Even if you don't condone their situations, you have to start where they are—help them have loyal marriages." Divorce is tolerated much more than it used to be. And none of the ministers I spoke with said that they would condemn a parishioner who was having an affair. They would confront the parishioner, but with the goal of gently bringing that person back to Jesus Christ. "How could I love that person if I didn't?" Patrick Jones, of the United Brethren's King Street Church, in Chambersburg, asked. People in Franklin County are contemptuous of Bill Clinton and his serial infidelities, but they are not necessarily fans of Kenneth Starr—at least not the Kenneth Starr the media portrayed. They don't like public scolds. Roger Murray, a Pentecostal minister in Mercersburg, whose father was also a Pentecostal minister, exemplifies the way in which many church authorities are torn by the sometimes conflicting desires to uphold authority and respect personal freedom. "My father would preach about what you could do and what you couldn't do," Murray recalls. "He would preach about smoking, about TV, about ladies who dress provocatively, against divorce." As a boy, Murray used to go visit his uncle, and he would sit in another room when his uncle's family watched television. "I was sure they were going to hell," he told me. But now he would never dream of telling people how to live. For one thing, his congregants wouldn't defer. And he is in no rush to condemn others. "I don't think preaching against homosexuality is what you should do," he told me. "A positive message works better." Like most of the people I met in Franklin County, Murray regards such culture warriors as Jerry Falwell and Pat Robertson as loose cannons, and televangelists as being far too interested in raising money. "I get pretty disgusted with Christian TV," he said. And that was before Falwell and Robertson made their notorious comments about the attacks of September 11 being a judgment from God. When I asked locals about those remarks, they answered with words like "disgusting," "horrendous," and "horrible." Almost no one in the county voted for Pat Buchanan; he was simply too contentious. Certainly Red and Blue America disagree strongly on some issues, such as homosexuality and abortion. But for the most part the disagreements are not large. For example, the Pew researchers asked Americans to respond to the statement "There are clear guidelines about what's good or evil that apply to everyone regardless of their situation." Forty-three percent of people in Blue states and 49 percent of people in Red states agreed. Forty-seven percent of Blue America and 55 percent of Red America agreed with the statement "I have old-fashioned values about family and marriage." Seventy percent of the people in Blue states and 77 percent of the people in Red states agreed that "too many children are being raised in day-care centers these days." These are small gaps. And, the Pew researchers found, there is no culture gap at all among suburban voters. In a Red state like Arizona suburban voters' opinions are not much different from those in a Blue state like Connecticut. The starkest differences that exist are between people in cities and people in rural areas, especially rural areas in the South. The conservatism I found in Franklin County is not an ideological or a reactionary conservatism. It is a temperamental conservatism. People place tremendous value on being agreeable, civil, and kind. They are happy to sit quietly with one another. They are hesitant to stir one another's passions. They appreciate what they have. They value continuity and revere the past. They work hard to reinforce community bonds. Their newspapers are filled with items about fundraising drives, car washes, bake sales, penny-collection efforts, and auxiliary thrift shops. Their streets are lined with lodges: VFW, Rotarians, Elks, Moose. Luncheons go on everywhere. Retired federal employees will be holding their weekly luncheon at one restaurant, Harley riders at another. I became fascinated by a group called the Tuscarora Longbeards, a local chapter of something called the National Wild Turkey Federation. The Longbeards go around to schools distributing Wild About Turkey Education boxes, which contain posters, lesson plans, and CD-ROMs on turkey preservation. These are the sorts of things that really mobilize people in Franklin County. Building community and preserving local ways are far more important to them than any culture war. THE EGO CURTAIN The best explanation of the differences between people in Montgomery and Franklin Counties has to do with sensibility, not class or culture. If I had to describe the differences between the two sensibilities in a single phrase, it would be conception of the self. In Red America the self is small. People declare in a million ways, "I am normal. Nobody is better, nobody is worse. I am humble before God." In Blue America the self is more commonly large. People say in a million ways, "I am special. I have carved out my own unique way of life. I am independent. I make up my own mind." In Red America there is very little one-upmanship. Nobody tries to be avant-garde in choosing a wardrobe. The chocolate-brown suits and baggy denim dresses hanging in local department stores aren't there by accident; people conspicuously want to be seen as not trying to dress to impress. For a person in Blue America the blandness in Red America can be a little oppressive. But it's hard not to be struck by the enormous social pressure not to put on airs. If a Franklin County resident drove up to church one day in a shiny new Lexus, he would face huge waves of disapproval. If one hired a nanny, people would wonder who died and made her queen. In Franklin County people don't go looking for obscure beers to demonstrate their connoisseurship. They wear T-shirts and caps with big-brand names on them—Coke, McDonald's, Chevrolet. In Bethesda people prefer cognoscenti brands—the Black Dog restaurant, or the independent bookstore Politics and Prose. In Franklin County it would be an affront to the egalitarian ethos to put a Princeton sticker on the rear window of one's car. In Montgomery County some proud parents can barely see through their back windows for all the Ivy League stickers. People in Franklin County say they felt comfortable voting for Bush, because if he came to town he wouldn't act superior to anybody else; he could settle into a barber's chair and fit right in. They couldn't stand Al Gore, because they thought he'd always be trying to awe everyone with his accomplishments. People in Montgomery County tended to admire Gore's accomplishments. They were leery of Bush, because for most of his life he seemed not to have achieved anything. I sometimes think that Franklin County takes its unpretentiousness a little too far. I wouldn't care to live there, because I'd find it too unchanging. I prefer the subtle and not-so-subtle status climbing on my side of the Ego Curtain—it's more entertaining. Still, I can't help respecting the genuine modesty of Franklin County people. It shows up strikingly in data collected by Mediamark Research. In survey after survey, residents of conservative Red America come across as humbler than residents of liberal Blue America. About half of those who describe themselves as "very conservative" agree with the statement "I have more ability than most people," but nearly two thirds of those who describe themselves as "very liberal" agree. Only 53 percent of conservatives agree with the statement "I consider myself an intellectual," but 75 percent of liberals do. Only 23 percent of conservatives agree with the statement "I must admit that I like to show off," whereas 43 percent of liberals do. A CAFETERIA NATION These differences in sensibility don't in themselves mean that America has become a fundamentally divided nation. As the sociologist Seymour Martin Lipset pointed out in The First New Nation (1963), achievement and equality are the two rival themes running throughout American history. Most people, most places, and most epochs have tried to intertwine them in some way. Moreover, after bouncing between Montgomery and Franklin Counties, I became convinced that a lot of our fear that America is split into rival camps arises from mistaken notions of how society is shaped. Some of us still carry the old Marxist categories in our heads. We think that society is like a layer cake, with the upper class on top. And, like Marx, we tend to assume that wherever there is class division there is conflict. Or else we have a sort of Crossfire model in our heads: where would people we meet sit if they were guests on that show? But traveling back and forth between the two counties was not like crossing from one rival camp to another. It was like crossing a high school cafeteria. Remember high school? There were nerds, jocks, punks, bikers, techies, druggies, God Squadders, drama geeks, poets, and Dungeons & Dragons weirdoes. All these cliques were part of the same school: they had different sensibilities; sometimes they knew very little about the people in the other cliques; but the jocks knew there would always be nerds, and the nerds knew there would always be jocks. That's just the way life is. And that's the way America is. We are not a divided nation. We are a cafeteria nation. We form cliques (call them communities, or market segments, or whatever), and when they get too big, we form subcliques. Some people even get together in churches that are "nondenominational" or in political groups that are "independent." These are cliques built around the supposed rejection of cliques. We live our lives by migrating through the many different cliques associated with the activities we enjoy and the goals we have set for ourselves. Our freedom comes in the interstices; we can choose which set of standards to live by, and when. We should remember that there is generally some distance between cliques—a buffer zone that separates one set of aspirations from another. People who are happy within their cliques feel no great compulsion to go out and reform other cliques. The jocks don't try to change the nerds. David Rawley, the Greencastle minister who felt he was clinging to a rock, has been to New York City only once in his life. "I was happy to get back home," he told me. "It's a planet I'm a little scared of. I have no desire to go back." What unites the two Americas, then, is our mutual commitment to this way of life—to the idea that a person is not bound by his class, or by the religion of his fathers, but is free to build a plurality of connections for himself. We are participants in the same striving process, the same experimental journey. Never has this been more apparent than in the weeks following the September 11 attacks. Before then Montgomery County people and Franklin County people gave little thought to one another: an attitude of benign neglect toward other parts of the country generally prevailed. But the events of that day generated what one of my lunch mates in Franklin County called a primal response. Our homeland was under attack. Suddenly there was a positive sense that we Americans are all bound together—a sense that, despite some little fissures here and there, has endured. On September 11 people in Franklin County flocked to the institutions that are so strong there—the churches and the American Legion and the VFW posts. Houses of worship held spontaneous prayer services and large ecumenical services. In the weeks since, firemen, veterans, and Scouts have held rallies. There have been blood drives. Just about every service organization in the county—and there are apparently thousands—has mobilized to raise funds or ship teddy bears. The rescue squad and the Salvation Army branch went to New York to help. Early every morning Ted Hale, the Presbyterian minister who once worked in East Hampton, goes to one of the local restaurants and sits as the regulars cycle through. One of the things that has struck him since the attacks is how little partisan feeling is left. "I expected to hear a certain amount of Clinton bashing, for creating the mess in which this could take place," he told me in October. "But there's been absolutely none of that." Instead Hale has been deluged with questions—about Islam, about why God restrains himself in the face of evil, about how people could commit such acts. The area's churches have not been monolithic in their responses. Many of the most conservative churches— the Mennonites and the Brethren, for example—have pacifist traditions. Bill Harter, in contrast, told his congregation during a recent sermon that the pacifist course is not the right one. "We must face the fact that there is a power of evil loose in the universe, which is dedicated to attacking all that is good, all that comes from God," he said. This evil, Harter continued, has cloaked itself in a perverted form of one of the world's major faiths. Citing the Protestant theologian Reinhold Niebuhr, he reminded his congregants that there is no sinless way to defend ourselves against this hostile ideology. But defend we must. "We must humbly make our choice while recognizing that we must constantly turn to God for forgiveness," he told them. The churches and synagogues in Bethesda, too, have been struggling. Over the Jewish High Holy Days, I heard of three synagogues in which the sermon was interrupted by a member of the congregation. In one instance the rabbi had said that it is always impossible to know where good and evil lie. A man rose up angrily to declare that in this case that sentiment was nonsense. Most people in my part of Blue America know few who will be called on to fight in the war. In Franklin County military service is common. Many families have an enlisted son or daughter, and many more have a relative in the reserves or the National Guard. Franklin County is engaged in an urgent discussion, largely absent where I live, about how to fill in for the reservists called up for active duty. Still, there's an attitude of determination in both places. If I had to boil down all the conversations I have had in Franklin and Montgomery Counties since September 11, the essence would be this: A horrible thing happened. We're going to deal with it. We're going to restore order. We got through Pearl Harbor. We're going to get through this. "There is no flaccidity," Harter observed, in words that apply to both communities. If the September 11 attacks rallied people in both Red and Blue America, they also neutralized the political and cultural leaders who tend to exploit the differences between the two. Americans are in no mood for a class struggle or a culture war. The aftermath of the attacks has been a bit like a national Sabbath, taking us out of our usual pleasures and distractions and reminding us what is really important. Over time the shock will dissipate. But in important ways the psychological effects will linger, just as the effects of John F. Kennedy's assassination have lingered. The early evidence still holds: although there are some real differences between Red and Blue America, there is no fundamental conflict. There may be cracks, but there is no chasm. Rather, there is a common love for this nation—one nation in the end. Chapter 6 Study Questions Political Participation 1. Why does the text claim that the description, analysis, and many of the proposed remedies for low voter turnout rates in the U.S. are generally off base? 2. Why does the book say that it is incorrect to say that Americans don’t vote as a result of apathy? 3. What did Congress pass to increase voter participation and what has been the result of that law? 4. How did states try to keep blacks from voting? Summarize those tactics and how they gradually were changed. Make sure you know what a literacy test, poll tax, grandfather clause, and the white primary were. 5. What political effects have there been since the Nineteenth and Twenty-sixth Amendments? 6. Describe the factors that tend to hold down voter turnout in the U.S. 7. Make a list of the generalizations that the book makes (p. 136-7) about which groups tend to be more or less likely to vote. Memorize this list. 8. Summarize the five reasons the book gives for why Americans register and vote less frequently. Australian ballot Grandfather clause Literacy test Motor-voter law Terms Poll tax Registered voters Voting-age population White primary Unit III Political Parties, Interest Groups George Washington is the only president who didn't blame the previous administration for his troubles. ~Author Unknown Assignments Study Guide for Chapter 7 and 8 AP Govt Debate #3 Persuasive Essay Election Project Assessments Unit III Exam Ch 7 & 8- Multiple Choice Secondary Readings Jefferson- A Profession of Political Faith Chapter 7 Study Questions Political Parties 1. Define the term political party. 2. In what ways are American political parties weak? (This is an extremely important point so be sure that you understand it and can explain all the reasons. This concept will turn up again and again in this class.) This would be a good question for writing a detailed answer. As you read through the chapter, any time you see a mention of weakened parties, add to this list. Then leave room for more notes or plan to add more later since we’ll be talking about this all unit (and year). 3. Briefly summarize the differences between political parties in the United States and in Europe. You can make a bullet point chart. 4. Briefly trace the development of the party system through its four periods, and give reasons for why the parties have been in decline since the New Deal period. Do not go overboard in your notes on the four party systems; just make sure you’re familiar with the parties and the terms and the chronology. Basically, the important thing is that you understand the broad pattern in Figure 7.2 on p. 162. 5. Describe the structure of the major political parties, making sure you understand the roles of the national committees, congressional committees, and the national chairmen. 6. What has been the difference between the two parties in terms of structure and organization? 7. How have changes in how they choose delegates affected the last few Democratic nominating conventions? Take note of the 1972 McGovern changes (known as the McGovern-Frasier Commission) and the 1981 Hunt Commission. What were the effects of these changes? 8. What is a political party machine? How has the power of party machines been weakened? What were some of the positive aspects of party machines? 9. Define and give examples of an ideological party. 10. How does having a personal following reflect a weakened party system? 11. What explanations does the book give for the persistence of the two-party system? 12. Explain why minor parties form, and discuss different kinds of parties. 13. Analyze why third parties are so rarely successful. 14. Describe some of the issue differences between delegates at Democratic and Republican conventions, and indicate whether there are major differences between the parties. Compare these differences with those between delegates of each party and average voters. Terms to Know caucus Congressional campaign committee Critical or realigning periods Ideological party Mugwumps or progressives National chairman National committee National convention Office-bloc ballot Party column ballot Personal following Plurality system Political machine Political party Solidary incentives Split Tickets Sponsored party Straight tickets Superdelegates Two party system Chapter 8 Study Questions Elections and Campaigns 1. Examine the differences between the party-oriented campaigns of the nineteenth century and the Candidatesoriented campaigns of today, contrasting the major elements of successful campaigns. 2. Discuss the importance of campaign funding to election outcomes. 3. What are the major sources of this funding under current law? 4. How successful has reform legislation been in removing improper monetary influences elections in the U.S.? 5. Define the term realigning election and discuss the major examples of such elections in the past. 6. Describe what Democrats and Republicans each must do to put together a successful coalition to win an election. 7. Outline the major arguments on the question of whether elections do or do not result in major changes in public policy in the United States. 8. In A Profession of Political Faith, Thomas Jefferson outlines an early version of a political platform, in essence what he stood for politically. What were the major political ideas that would have made up Jefferson’s platform and would they still be valid topics in modern politics? Terms to Know Blanket primary Closed primary Coattails General election Gerrymandering Incumbent Independent expenditure Malapportionment Open primary Political action committee (PAC) Position issue Presidential primary Primary election Prospective voting Retrospective voting Runoff primary Soft money Sophomore surge Valence issue Premise: Congratulations ! Through your hard work and dedication, you’ve achieved success in your private career, and now you want to spread your talents to the public sector. You’ve decided to run for political office- specifically Yolo county’s representative to the State Assembly. As a local Assembly person, you will need to appeal to the widest segment of the population, so you will have to research some controversial issues, so you can debate intelligently with your political opponents. Persuasive Essay (50 points) Your essay must be at least 5 typed pages (12 point font, double spaced) in length. You should introduce yourself with a brief description of your personality, personal history, and political history. Why are you the best person for this position? You must discuss your position of at least 6 of the following issues: o Education o Tax Cuts o Prescription Drug Plans for Senior Citizens o Gun Control o Death Penalty o Abortion o State of the Armed Forces o American Intervention in Foreign Countries o Environment o Illegal Immigration o Any other controversial topic you may come across in your research Where do you stand on each of these issues? What are the strengths and weaknesses of this position? Why is your position more appropriate than opponent's? You must also mention what type of person would be your political opposite. Where do they stand on the issues you researched? What are their strengths and weaknesses? Why are they not the best candidate for this position? Within your essay, you must PERSUADE your reader to vote for you. The reader needs to know WHY you are the one to vote for and WHY other candidates are the wrong person to vote for. You must be CONVINCING of your arguments. Campaign Poster (25 points)- Create A Campaign Poster for Yourself- It should have the following components: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Your Name For what office you are campaigning Your Political Slogan Your Party Affiliation Position Views Campaign Speech- You are going to give a one minute introductory campaign speech, explaining your political positions, and why the people (the class) should vote for you. There will be several speeches in a row, followed by an open forum debate on the issues that you researched. Each person will have a maximum of 30 seconds to state their position on each issue, and then it will be opened to group debate. Jefferson, Thomas (spelling left in its original form) A PROFESSION OF POLITICAL FAITH To Elbridge Gerry Philadelphia, Jan. 26, 1799 MY DEAR SIR, -- Your favor of Nov. 12 was safely delivered to me by Mr. Binney, but not till Dec. 28, as I arrived here only three days before that date. It was received with great satisfaction. Our very long intimacy as fellow-laborers in the same cause, the recent expressions of mutual confidence which had preceded your mission, the interesting course which that had taken, & particularly & personally as it regarded yourself, made me anxious to hear from you on your return. I was the more so too, as I had myself during the whole of your absence, as well as since your return, been a constant butt for every shaft of calumny which malice & falsehood could form, & the presses, public speakers, or private letters disseminate. One of these, too, was of a nature to touch yourself; as if, wanting confidence in your efforts, I had been capable of usurping powers committed to you, & authorizing negotiations private & collateral to yours. The real truth is, that though Dr Logan, the pretended missionary, about 4. or 5. days before he sailed for Hamburg, told me he was going there, & thence to Paris, & asked & received from me a certificate of his citizenship, character, & circumstances of life, merely as a protection, should he be molested on his journey, in the present turbulent & suspicious state of Europe, yet I had been led to consider his object as relative to his private affairs; and tho', from an intimacy of some standing, he knew well my wishes for peace and my political sentiments in general, he nevertheless received then no particular declaration of them, no authority to communicate them to any mortal, nor to speak to any one in my name, or in anybody's name, on that, or on any other subject whatever; nor did I write by him a scrip of a pen to any person whatever. This he has himself honestly & publicly declared since his return; & from his well-known character & every other circumstance, every candid man must perceive that his enterprise was dictated by his own enthusiasm, without consultation or communication with any one; that he acted in Paris on his own ground, & made his own way. Yet to give some color to his proceedings, which might implicate the republicans in general, & myself particularly, they have not been ashamed to bring forward a suppositious paper, drawn by one of their own party in the name of Logan, and falsely pretended to have been presented by him to the government of France; counting that the bare mention of my name therein, would connect that in the eye of the public with this transaction. In confutation of these and all future calumnies, by way of anticipation, I shall make to you a profession of my political faith; in confidence that you will consider every future imputation on me of a contrary complexion, as bearing on its front the mark of falsehood & calumny. I do then, with sincere zeal, wish an inviolable preservation of our present federal constitution, according to the true sense in which it was adopted by the States, that in which it was advocated by it's friends, & not that which it's enemies apprehended, who therefore became it's enemies; and I am opposed to the monarchising it's features by the forms of it's administration, with a view to conciliate a first transition to a President & Senate for life, & from that to a hereditary tenure of these offices, & thus to worm out the elective principle. am for preserving to the States the powers not yielded by them to the Union, & to the legislature of the Union it's constitutional share in the division of powers; and I am not for transferring all the powers of the States to the general government, & all those of that government to the Executive branch. I am for a government rigorously frugal & simple, applying all the possible savings of the public revenue to the discharge of the national debt; and not for a multiplication of officers & salaries merely to make partisans, & for increasing, by every device, the public debt, on the principle of it's being a public blessing. I am for relying, for internal defence, on our militia solely, till actual invasion, and for such a naval force only as may protect our coasts and harbors from such depredations as we have experienced; and not for a standing army in time of peace, which may overawe the public sentiment; nor for a navy, which, by it's own expenses and the eternal wars in which it will implicate us, will grind us with public burdens, & sink us under them. I am for free commerce with all nations; political connection with none; & little or no diplomatic establishment. And I am not for linking ourselves by new treaties with the quarrels of Europe; entering that field of slaughter to preserve their balance, or joining in the confederacy of kings to war against the principles of liberty. I am for freedom of religion, & against all maneuvres to bring about a legal ascendancy of one sect over another: for freedom of the press, & against all violations of the constitution to silence by force & not by reason the complaints or criticisms, just or unjust, of our citizens against the conduct of their agents. And I am for encouraging the progress of science in all it's branches; and not for raising a hue and cry against the sacred name of philosophy; for awing the human mind by stories of raw-head & bloody bones to a distrust of its own vision, & to repose implicitly on that of others; to go backwards instead of forwards to look for improvement; to believe that government, religion, morality, & every other science were in the highest perfection in ages of the darkest ignorance, and that nothing can ever be devised more perfect than what was established by our forefathers. To these I will add, that I was a sincere well-wisher to the success of the French revolution, and still wish it may end in the establishment of a free & well-ordered republic; but I have not been insensible under the atrocious depredations they have committed on our commerce. The first object of my heart is my own country. In that is embarked my family, my fortune, & my own existence. I have not one farthing of interest, nor one fibre of attachment out of it, nor a single motive of preference of any one nation to another, but in proportion as they are more or less friendly to us. But though deeply feeling the injuries of France, I did not think war the surest means of redressing them. I did believe, that a mission sincerely disposed to preserve peace, would obtain for us a peaceable & honorable settlement & retribution; and I appeal to you to say, whether this might not have been obtained, if either of your colleagues had been of the same sentiment with yourself. These, my friend, are my principles; they are unquestionably the principles of the great body of our fellow citizens, and I know there is not one of them which is not yours also. In truth, we never differed but on one ground, the funding system; and as, from the moment of it's being adopted by the constituted authorities, I became religiously principled in the sacred discharge of it to the uttermost farthing, we are united now even on that single ground of difference. I turn now to your inquiries. The enclosed paper will answer one of them. But you also ask for such political information as may be possessed by me, & interesting to yourself in regard to your embassy. As a proof of my entire confidence in you, I shall give it fully & candidly. When Pinckney, Marshall, and Dana, were nominated to settle our differences with France, it was suspected by many, from what was understood of their dispositions, that their mission would not result in a settlement of differences, but would produce circumstances tending to widen the breach, and to provoke our citizens to consent to a war with that nation, & union with England. Dana's resignation & your appointment gave the first gleam of hope of a peaceable issue to the mission. For it was believed that you were sincerely disposed to accommodation; & it was not long after your arrival there, before symptoms were observed of that difference of views which had been suspected to exist. In the meantime, however, the aspect of our government towards the French republic had become so ardent, that the people of America generally took the alarm. To the southward, their apprehensions were early excited. In the Eastern States also, they at length began to break out. Meetings were held in many of your towns, & addresses to the government agreed on in opposition to war. The example was spreading like a wildfire. Other meetings were called in other places, & a general concurrence of sentiment against the apparent inclinations of the government was imminent; when, most critically for the government, the despatches of Octr 22, prepared by your colleague Marshall, with a view to their being made public, dropped into their laps. It was truly a God-send to them, & they made the most of it. Many thousands of copies were printed & dispersed gratis, at the public expence; & the zealots for war co-operated so heartily, that there were instances of single individuals who printed & dispersed 10. or 12,000 copies at their own expence. The odiousness of the corruption supposed in those papers excited a general & high indignation among the people. Unexperienced in such maneuvres, they did not permit themselves even to suspect that the turpitude of private swindlers might mingle itself unobserved, & give it's own hue to the communications of the French government, of whose participation there was neither proof nor probability. It served, however, for a time, the purpose intended. The people, in many places, gave a loose to the expressions of their warm indignation, & of their honest preference of war to dishonor. The fever was long & successfully kept up, and in the meantime, war measures as ardently crowded. Still, however, as it was known that your colleagues were coming away, and yourself to stay, though disclaiming a separate power to conclude a treaty, it was hoped by the lovers of peace, that a project of treaty would have been prepared, ad referendum, on principles which would have satisfied our citizens, & overawed any bias of the government towards a different policy. But the expedition of the Sophia, and, as was supposed, the suggestions of the person charged with your despatches, & his probable misrepresentations of the real wishes of the American people, prevented these hopes. They had then only to look forward to your return for such information, either through the Executive, or from yourself, as might present to our view the other side of the medal. The despatches of Oct 22, 97, had presented one face. That information, to a certain degree, is now received, & the public will see from your correspondence with Taleyrand, that France, as you testify, "was sincere and anxious to obtain a reconciliation, not wishing us to break the British treaty, but only to give her equivalent stipulations; and in general was disposed to a liberal treaty." And they will judge whether mr. Pickering's report shews an inflexible determination to believe no declarations the French government can make, nor any opinion which you, judging on the spot & from actual view, can give of their sincerity, and to meet their designs of peace with operations of war. The alien & sedition acts have already operated in the South as powerful sedatives of the X. Y. Z. inflammation. In your quarter, where violations of principle are either less regarded or more concealed, the direct tax is likely to have the same effect, & to excite inquiries into the object of the enormous expences & taxes we are bringing on. And your information supervening, that we might have a liberal accommodation if we would, there can be little doubt of the reproduction of that general movement, by the despatches of Oct. 22. And tho' small checks & stops, like Logan's pretended embassy, may be thrown in the way from time to time, & may a little retard it's motion, yet the tide is already turned, and will sweep before it all the feeble obstacles of art. The unquestionable republicanism of the American mind will break through the mist under which it has been clouded, and will oblige it's agents to reform the principles & practices of their administration. You suppose that you have been abused by both parties. As far as has come to my knowledge, you are misinformed. I have never seen or heard a sentence of blame uttered against you by the republicans; unless we were so to construe their wishes that you had more boldly co-operated in a project of a treaty, and would more explicitly state, whether there was in your colleages that flexibility, which persons earnest after peace would have practised? Whether, on the contrary, their demeanor was not cold, reserved, and distant, at least, if not backward? And whether, if they had yielded to those informal conferences which Taleyrand seems to have courted, the liberal accommodation you suppose might not have been effected, even with their agency? Your fellow-citizens think they have a right to full information, in a case of such great concern to them. It is their sweat which is to earn all the expences of the war, and their blood which is to flow in expiation of the causes of it. It may be in your power to save them from these miseries by full communications and unrestrained details, postponing motives of delicacy to those of duty. It rests for you to come forward independently; to take your stand on the high ground of your own character; to disregard calumny, and to be borne above it on the shoulders of your grateful fellow citizens; or to sink into the humble oblivion, to which the Federalists (self-called) have secretly condemned you; and even to be happy if they will indulge you with oblivion, while they have beamed on your colleagues meridian splendor. Pardon me, my dear Sir, if my expressions are strong. My feelings are so much more so, that it is with difficulty reduce them even to the tone I use. If you doubt the dispositions towards you, look into the papers, on both sides, for the toasts which were given throughout the States on the 4th of July. You will there see whose hearts were with you, and whose were ulcerated against you. Indeed, as soon as it was known that you had consented to stay in Paris, there was no measure observed in the execrations of the war party. They openly wished you might be guillotined, or sent to Cayenne, or anything else. And these expressions were finally stifled from a principle of policy only, & to prevent you from being urged to a justification of yourself. From this principle alone proceed the silence and cold respect they observe towards you. Still, they cannot prevent at times the flames bursting from under the embers, as mr. Pickering's letters, report, & conversations testify, as well as the indecent expressions respecting you, indulged by some of them in the debate on these despatches. These sufficiently show that you are never more to be honored or trusted by them, and that they await to crush you for ever, only till they can do it without danger to themselves. When I sat down to answer your letter, but two courses presented themselves, either to say nothing or everything; for half confidences are not in my character. I could not hesitate which was due to you. I have unbosomed myself fully; & it will certainly be highly gratifying if I receive like confidence from you. For even if we differ in principle more than I believe we do, you & I know too well the texture of the human mind, & the slipperiness of human reason, to consider differences of opinion otherwise than differences of form or feature. Integrity of views more than their soundness, is the basis of esteem. I shall follow your direction in conveying this by a private hand; tho' know not as yet when one worthy of confidence will occur. And my trust in you leaves me without a fear that this letter, meant as a confidential communication of my impressions, will ever go out of your hand, or be suffered in anywise to commit my name. Indeed, besides the accidents which might happen to it even under your care, considering the accident of death to which you are liable, I think it safest to pray you, after reading it as often as you please, to destroy at least the 2d & 3d leaves. The 1st contains principles only, which I fear not to avow; but the 2d & 3d contain facts stated for your information, and which, though sacredly conformable to my firm belief, yet would be galling to some, & expose me to illiberal attacks. I therefore repeat my prayer to burn the 2d & 3d leaves. And did we ever expect to see the day, when, breathing nothing but sentiments of love to our country & it's freedom & happiness, our correspondence must be as secret as if we were hatching it's destruction! Adieu, my friend, and accept my sincere & affectionate salutations. I need not add my signature. Unit IV Interest Groups and Media “We are so cleverly manipulated and influenced by the media and establishments on both the right and left, that the truth has become hopelessly lost in semantics.” Jules Carlysle Assignments Chapter 9 and 10 Study Guides Prompted Essay Interest Groups Project Reform the Media Project Assessments Unit IV Exam- Chapters 9 & 10- Three FRQ’s Secondary Readings Fallows- Why Americans Hate the Media Chapter 9 Study Questions Interest Groups 1. Why are interest groups so common in this country? 2. The book gives four factors that account for the rise of interest groups? Summarize those factors and give examples for each. 3. Define what an interest group is and what its purpose is. What are the differences between institutional interests and membership interests? Give examples of each. 4. Identify and define the incentives to join a mass-membership organization. 5. Define what a public-interest lobby is and give an example. 6. What is the difference between the staff and membership of an interest group? 7. The book discusses the environmental, feminist, and union movements. Outline or summarize the information on each. (Bullet points are fine.) 8. How do interest groups get their funds? 9. Summarize the five activities that the book lists for how interest groups work to influence policy? Give examples for each activity. Assess how successful each type of activity is in influencing policy. This is very important so be sure that you understand this section. 10. What were the weaknesses of the Federal Regulation of Lobbying Act of 1946 and why did Congress decide to enact a new law in 1995? 11. How did the 1995 Lobbyist Disclosure Act strengthen the federal government’s regulation of interest groups? You should be familiar with the following Interest Groups. Basically, I want you to know the types of issues these groups are involved in and whether they are generally supporters of liberals or conservatives, or are non-ideological. If I gave you an issue, you should know which interest groups would be involved. The groups with an asterisk by them are ones you all need to know. There are, of course, many more organizations, but one must draw a line somewhere. Use this list to pick an interest group for your assignment. AARP – American Association of Retired People* ACLU – American Civil Liberties Union* AFL-CIO * Christian Coalition* Council on American-Islamic Relations NARAL – National Abortion Rights Action League* NEA - National Education Association* National Resources Defense Council ABA - American Bar Association* American Conservative Union Emily’s List Environmental Defense Fund NOW * NRA – National Rifle Association* American Farm Bureau Family Research Council AIPAC - American Israel Public Affairs Committee AMA* ATLA - Association of Trial Lawyers of America The Business Roundtable Handgun Control, Inc. PETA – People for the Ethical Treatment of Animals Public Citizen* Lobby lobbyist interest group Club for Growth Moveon.org NAACP – National Association of Colored People* NAM - National Association of Manufacturers* Sierra Club* US Chamber of Commerce Veterans of Foreign Wars* Terms to Know purposive incentive ideological interest groups Public-interest lobby incentive solidary incentives material incentives social movement political cue ratings Interest Group Assignment Due – 1. Pick one of the interest groups listed on your Study Guide. You are free to pick another group if you have a different choice. Just ask or email me to be sure you have made a good choice. 2. Go to that group’s web site. I have some links on my links page. Also, go to News Google and search for information on your group. That will help you find what issues they’ve been involved in recently. Research the following topics and type up a report (about three pages, double-spaced) covering those topics. You can simply put the topic as a heading and then give the information on that topic. (This isn’t meant to be a thesis-driven, unified essay.) You can give your information in a bullet-points list A. What are the issues your group is concerned with? What are some examples of legislation your group supports or opposes? What actions does your group take to try to influence policy and the public agenda? What resources make it influential? Give specific examples: (e.g. use of the media, law suits, direct lobbying, public information contributions, etc.) Which parts of the government does your group target, i.e. which executive branch departments and congressional committees? B. What is the group’s political ideology? Does it favor one political party over the other? If so, does it have a history of supporting certain political candidates? What is it doing to support their favored candidates? Make the connection between their political ideology, the legislation they support, and the party they support. OR If you think your group is absolutely neutral, say so. Many interest groups are neutral. Discuss the issues that your group is concerned with and then, for the points in this section you will do the following. Find and summarize two news articles relevant to your interest group. You can use http://news.google.com/ to find such articles. Use the information to show how your group is trying to influence public policy. C. Assess your group: What are its strengths and weaknesses? How effective is it in achieving its agenda? Back up what you say with specific examples demonstrating their effectiveness or lack thereof. A. How it tries to influence policy and the public agenda Possible Points 35 B. Political Efforts/two news article summaries if your group is neutral 30 C. Assessment of your group’s strengths and weaknesses with examples supporting your conclusions 35 TOTAL 100 (This rubric must be stapled to the front of your assignment.) Your Points Chapter 10 Study Questions The Media 1. In general, how does the American media differ from that of England and France? 2. Define the terms “yellow journalism” and “muckrakers.” 3. How have the characteristics of the electronic media and the Internet affected the actions of public officials and candidates for national office? 4. What does the book conclude about the degree of competition in the media? 5. What is the impact of the “national press?” Define the roles of the national media as gateskeeper, scorekeeper, and watchdog. Think of examples for each. 6. Summarize the rules regulating the media and the government including the following: prior restraint, libel, confidentiality of sources, FCC regulations, Telecommunications Act (1996), Equal time rule, Right-of-reply rule, political editorializing rule, fairness doctrine. Make sure you understand all these rules. 7. Summarize what the book says about the effects of the media on politics. 8. How does press coverage of the president and of Congress differ? 9. What does the book say concerning press bias? 10. Why does American government have so many leaks? 11. Why do people have an increasing lack of confidence in the media? Summarize all the reasons that the book gives. Muckraker Associated Press yellow journalism “Big Three” Networks sound bites Libel Defamation Prior Restraint The Pentagon Papers trial balloon loaded languageEqual Time rule Right-of-reply rule Political editorializing rule Fairness Doctrine Selective attention Editorial endorsement Terms to Know C-Span Routine Stories Feature Stories Insider Stories News Leaks Adversarial Press “Off/On the record” “On (deep) background” Feeding Frenzy Pack Journalism New York Times Co. v. Sullivan (1964) Federal Communications Commission Telecommunications Act Shield law “Above” or “Below the fold” stories Freedom of Information Act (1974) 12. Reform the Media Project What is the proper role of media in a Democratic society? Your job is to “reform the media” to address shortcomings and orient it towards the real needs of people who want to make informed choices in society. How would a newspaper look that has a genuine interest in the people’s welfare? What would a programming guide look like for networks primarily concerned with providing people the news, information, and programming needed to meet the best interests of the people? Requirements: Choose a format, such as print media or the television. Within that format, develop either a front page or a programming guide that reflects how you believe the media should present information. Print Media: Create either a front page for a newspaper (Think Sacramento Bee, New York Times) or a front page and table or contents for a newsmagazine (Think Time, Newsweek). For either of these options you need to select the headlines, by-lines and sample news articles and photos, etc. that would appear on the front page. For the magazines, you’ll need to select an appropriate cover-page photo, then create an index of the articles that appear on the inside of the front cover. Television media: For the television you will create a 24-hour programming guide (Think TV Guide) of network programs (you only need the major networks (ABC, CBS, NBC and FOX, not cable), and include programming from 8:00a.m. to 7:30 a.m. the next day. A brief description of each show is needed to inform the viewer what the show is about. Approaches: Straightforward approach: Create articles, photos and news items that you feel are truly representative of the kinds of news and information people need to make good choices, avoid propaganda, and become more enlightened. Satirical approach: What would happen if the media were totally biased (e.g., the world from an ultraconservative perspective; world from an ultraliberal perspective; world from a communist perspective; world from an anarchist perspective). Grading: Grades will be awarded based on creativity, thoughtfulness, clarity, artistic rendering of illustrations and photos, and neatness. Why Americans Hate the Media by James Fallows In the late 1980s public-television stations aired a talking-heads series called Ethics in America. For each show more than a dozen prominent citizens sat around a horseshoe-shaped table and tried to answer troubling ethical questions posed by a moderator. The series might have seemed a good bet to be paralyzingly dull, but at least one show was riveting in its drama and tension. The episode was taped in the fall of 1987. Its title was "Under Orders, Under Fire," and most of the panelists were former soldiers talking about the ethical dilemmas of their work. The moderator was Charles Ogletree, a professor at Harvard Law School, who moved from panelist to panelist asking increasingly difficult questions in the law school's famous Socratic style. During the first half of the show Ogletree made the soldiers squirm about ethical tangles on the battlefield. The man getting the roughest treatment was Frederick Downs, a writer who as a young Army lieutenant in Vietnam had lost his left arm in a mine explosion. Ogletree asked Downs to imagine that he was a young lieutenant again. He and his platoon were in the nation of "South Kosan," advising South Kosanese troops in their struggle against invaders from "North Kosan." (This scenario was apparently a hybrid of the U.S. roles in the Korean and Vietnam wars.) A North Kosanese unit had captured several of Downs's men alive—but Downs had also captured several of the North Kosanese. Downs did not know where his men were being held, but he thought his prisoners did. And so Ogletree put the question: How far would Downs go to make a prisoner talk? Would he order him tortured? Would he torture the prisoner himself? Downs himself speculated on what he would do if he had a big knife in his hand. Would he start cutting the prisoner? When would he make himself stop, if the prisoner just wouldn't talk? Downs did not shrink from the questions or the implications of his answers. He wouldn't enjoy doing it, he told Ogletree. He would have to live with the consequences for the rest of his life. But yes, he would torture the captive. He would use the knife. Implicit in his answers was the idea that he would do the cutting himself and would listen to the captive scream. He would do whatever was necessary to try to save his own men. While explaining his decisions Downs sometimes gestured with his left hand for emphasis. The hand was a metal hook. Ogletree worked his way through the other military officials, asking all how they reacted to Frederick Downs's choice. William Westmoreland, who had commanded the whole U.S. force in Vietnam when Downs was serving there, deplored Downs's decision. After all, he said, even war has its rules. An Army chaplain wrestled with how he would react if a soldier in a morally troubling position similar to Downs's came to him privately and confessed what he had done. A Marine Corps officer juggled a related question: What would he do if he came across an American soldier who was about to torture or execute a bound and unarmed prisoner, who might be a civilian? The soldiers disagreed among themselves. Yet in describing their decisions they used phrases like "I hope I would have the courage to . . ." and "In order to live with myself later I would . . ." The whole exercise may have been set up as a rhetorical game, but Ogletree's questions clearly tapped into discussions the soldiers had already had about the consequences of choices they made. Then Ogletree turned to the two most famous members of the evening's panel, better known even than Westmoreland. These were two star TV journalists: Peter Jennings, of World News Tonight and ABC, and Mike Wallace, of 60 Minutes and CBS. Ogletree brought them into the same hypothetical war. He asked Jennings to imagine that he worked for a network that had been in contact with the enemy North Kosanese government. After much pleading Jennings and his news crew got permission from the North Kosanese to enter their country and film behind the lines. Would Jennings be willing to go? Of course, he replied. Any reporter would—and in real wars reporters from his network often had. But while Jennings and his crew were traveling with a North Kosanese unit, to visit the site of an alleged atrocity by U.S. and South Kosanese troops, they unexpectedly crossed the trail of a small group of American and South Kosanese soldiers. With Jennings in their midst the Northern soldiers set up an ambush that would let them gun down the Americans and Southerners. What would Jennings do? Would he tell his cameramen to "Roll tape!" as the North Kosanese opened fire? What would go through his mind as he watched the North Kosanese prepare to fire? Jennings sat silent for about fifteen seconds. "Well, I guess I wouldn't," he finally said. "I am going to tell you now what I am feeling, rather than the hypothesis I drew for myself. If I were with a North Kosanese unit that came upon Americans, I think that I personally would do what I could to warn the Americans." Even if it meant losing the story? Ogletree asked. Even though it would almost certainly mean losing my life, Jennings replied. "But I do not think that I could bring myself to participate in that act. That's purely personal, and other reporters might have a different reaction." Ogletree turned for reaction to Mike Wallace, who immediately replied. "I think some other reporters would have a different reaction," he said, obviously referring to himself. "They would regard it simply as another story they were there to cover." A moment later Wallace said, "I am astonished, really." He turned toward Jennings and began to lecture him: "You're a reporter. Granted you're an American" (at least for purposes of the fictional example; Jennings has actually retained Canadian citizenship). "I'm a little bit at a loss to understand why, because you're an American, you would not have covered that story." Ogletree pushed Wallace. Didn't Jennings have some higher duty to do something other than just roll film as soldiers from his own country were being shot? "No," Wallace said flatly and immediately. "You don't have a higher duty. No. No. You're a reporter!" Jennings backtracked fast. Wallace was right, he said: "I chickened out." Jennings said that he had "played the hypothetical very hard."He had lost sight of his journalistic duty to remain detached. As Jennings said he agreed with Wallace, several soldiers in the room seemed to regard the two of them with horror. Retired Air Force General Brent Scowcroft, who would soon become George Bush's National Security Advisor, said it was simply wrong to stand and watch as your side was slaughtered. "What's it worth?" he asked Wallace bitterly. "It's worth thirty seconds on the evening news, as opposed to saving a platoon." After a brief discussion between Wallace and Scowcroft, Ogletree reminded Wallace of Scowcroft's basic question. What was it worth for the reporter to stand by, looking? Shouldn't the reporter have said something ? Wallace gave a disarming grin, shrugged his shoulders, and said, "I don't know." He later mentioned extreme circumstances in which he thought journalists should intervene. But at that moment he seemed to be mugging to the crowd with a "Don't ask me!"expression, and in fact he drew a big laugh—the first such moment in the discussion. Jennings, however, was all business, and was still concerned about the first answer he had given. "I wish I had made another decision," Jennings said, as if asking permission to live the past five minutes over again. "I would like to have made his decision"—that is, Wallace's decision to keep on filming. A few minutes later Ogletree turned to George M. Connell, a Marine colonel in full uniform. Jaw muscles flexing in anger, with stress on each word, Connell said, "I feel utter contempt." Two days after this hypothetical episode, Connell said, Jennings or Wallace might be back with the American forces— and could be wounded by stray fire, as combat journalists often had been before. When that happens, he said, they are "just journalists." Yet they would expect American soldiers to run out under enemy fire and drag them back, rather than leaving them to bleed to death on the battlefield. "I'll do it!" Connell said. "And that is what makes me so contemptuous of them. Marines will die going to get . . . a couple of journalists." The last words dripped disgust. Not even Ogletree knew what to say. There was dead silence for several seconds. Then a square-jawed man with neat gray hair and aviator glasses spoke up. It was Newt Gingrich, looking a generation younger and trimmer than he would when he became speaker of the House, in 1995. One thing was clear from this exercise, Gingrich said. "The military has done a vastly better job of systematically thinking through the ethics of behavior in a violent environment than the journalists have." That was about the mildest way to put it. Although Wallace and Jennings conceded that the criticism was fair—if journalists considered themselves "detached,"they could not logically expect American soldiers to rescue them— nevertheless their reactions spoke volumes about the values of their craft. Jennings was made to feel embarrassed about his natural, decent human impulse. Wallace seemed unembarrassed about feeling no connection to the soldiers in his country's army or considering their deaths before his eyes "simply a story." In other important occupations people sometimes face the need to do the horrible. Frederick Downs, after all, was willing to torture a man and hear him scream. But Downs had thought through all the consequences and alternatives, and he knew he would live with the horror for the rest of his days. When Mike Wallace said he would do something horrible, he barely bothered to give a rationale. He did not try to explain the reasons a reporter might feel obliged to remain silent as the attack began—for instance, that in combat reporters must be beyond country, or that they have a duty to bear impartial witness to deaths on either side, or that Jennings had implicitly made a promise not to betray the North Kosanese when he agreed to accompany them. The soldiers might or might not have found such arguments convincing; Wallace didn't even make them. Not Issues But the Game of Politics A generation ago political talk programs were sleepy Sunday-morning affairs. The Secretary of State or the Senate majority leader would show up to answer questions from Lawrence Spivak or Bob Clark, and after thirty minutes another stately episode of Meet the Press or Issues and Answers would be history. Everything in public life is "brighter" and more "interesting" now. Constant competition from the weekday trash-talk shows has forced anything involving political life to liven up. Under pressure from the Saturday political-talk shows— The McLaughlin Group and its many disorderly descendants—even the Sunday-morning shows have put on rouge and push-up bras. Meet the Press, moderated by Tim Russert, is probably the meatiest of these programs. High-powered guests discuss serious topics with Russert, who worked for years in politics, and with veteran reporters. Yet the pressure to keep things lively means that squabbling replaces dialogue. The discussion shows that are supposed to enhance public understanding may actually reduce it, by hammering home the message that issues don't matter except as items for politicians to fight over. Some politicians in Washington may indeed view all issues as mere tools to use against their opponents. But far from offsetting this view of public life, the national press often encourages it. As Washington-based talk shows have become more popular in the past decade, they have had a trickle-down effect in cities across the country. In Seattle, in Los Angeles, in Boston, in Atlanta, journalists gain notice and influence by appearing regularly on talk shows—and during those appearances they mainly talk about the game of politics. In the 1992 presidential campaign candidates spent more time answering questions from "ordinary people"—citizens in town-hall forums, callers on radio and TV talk shows—than they had in previous years. The citizens asked overwhelmingly about the what of politics: What are you going to do about the health-care system? What can you do to reduce the cost of welfare? The reporters asked almost exclusively about the how: How are you going to try to take away Perot's constituency? How do you answer charges that you have flip-flopped? After the 1992 campaign the contrast between questions from citizens and those from reporters was widely discussed in journalism reviews and postmortems on campaign coverage. Reporters acknowledged that they should try harder to ask questions about things their readers and viewers seemed to care about—that is, questions about the differences that political choices would make in people's lives. In January of last year there was a chance to see how well the lesson had sunk in. In the days just before and after Bill Clinton delivered his State of the Union address to the new Republican-controlled Congress, he answered questions in a wide variety of forums in order to explain his plans. On January 31, a week after the speech, the President flew to Boston and took questions from a group of teenagers. Their questions concerned the effects of legislation or government programs on their communities or schools. These were the questions (paraphrased in some cases): * "We need stronger laws to punish those people who are caught selling guns to our youth. Basically, what can you do about that?" * "I notice that often it's the media that is responsible for the negative portrayal of young people in our society." What can political leaders do to persuade the media that there is good news about youth? * Apprenticeship programs and other ways to provide job training have been valuable for students not going to college. Can the Administration promote more of these programs? * Programs designed to keep teenagers away from drugs and gangs often emphasize sports and seem geared mainly to boys. How can such programs be made more attractive to teenage girls? * What is it like at Oxford? (This was from a student who was completing a new alternative-school curriculum in the Boston public schools, and who had been accepted at Oxford.) * "We need more police officers who are trained to deal with all the other different cultures in our cities." What can the government do about that? * "In Boston, Northeastern University has created a model of scholarships and other supports to help inner-city kids get to and stay in college. . . . As President, can you urge colleges across the country to do what Northeastern has done?" Earlier in the month the President's performance had been assessed by the three network-news anchors: Peter Jennings, of ABC; Dan Rather, of CBS; and Tom Brokaw, of NBC. There was no overlap whatsoever between the questions the students asked and those raised by the anchors. None of the questions from these news professionals concerned the impact of legislation or politics on people's lives. Nearly all concerned the struggle for individual advancement among candidates. Peter Jennings, who met with Clinton as the Gingrich-Dole Congress was getting under way, asked whether Clinton had been eclipsed as a political leader by the Republicans. Dan Rather did interviews through January with prominent politicians—Senators Edward Kennedy, Phil Gramm, and Bob Dole—building up to a profile of Clinton two days after the State of the Union address. Every question he asked was about popularity or political tactics. He asked Phil Gramm to guess whether Newt Gingrich would enter the race (no) and whether Bill Clinton would be renominated by his party (yes). He asked Bob Dole what kind of mood the President seemed to be in, and whether Dole and Gingrich were, in effect, the new bosses of Washington. When Edward Kennedy began giving his views about the balanced-budget amendment, Rather steered him back on course: "Senator, you know I'd talk about these things the rest of the afternoon, but let's move quickly to politics. Do you expect Bill Clinton to be the Democratic nominee for re-election in 1996?" The CBS Evening News profile of Clinton, which was narrated by Rather and was presented as part of the series Eye on America, contained no mention of Clinton's economic policy, his tax or budget plans, his failed attempt to pass a health- care proposal, his successful attempt to ratify NAFTA, his efforts to "reinvent government," or any substantive aspect of his proposals or plans in office. Its subject was exclusively Clinton's handling of his office—his "difficulty making decisions," his "waffling" at crucial moments. If Rather or his colleagues had any interest in the content of Clinton's speech as opposed to its political effect, neither the questions they asked nor the reports they aired revealed such a concern. Tom Brokaw's questions were more substantive, but even he concentrated mainly on politics of the moment. How did the President feel about a poll showing that 61 percent of the public felt that he had no "strong convictions" and could be "easily swayed"? What did Bill Clinton think about Newt Gingrich? "Do you think he plays fair?" How did he like it that people kept shooting at the White House? When ordinary citizens have a chance to pose questions to political leaders, they rarely ask about the game of politics. They want to know how the reality of politics will affect them—through taxes, programs, scholarship funds, wars. Journalists justify their intrusiveness and excesses by claiming that they are the public's representatives, asking the questions their fellow citizens would ask if they had the privilege of meeting with Presidents and senators. In fact they ask questions that only their fellow political professionals care about. And they often do so—as at the typical White House news conference—with a discourtesy and rancor that represent the public's views much less than they reflect the modern journalist's belief that being independent boils down to acting hostile. Reductio Ad Electionem: The One Track Mind The limited curiosity that elite reporters display in their questions is also evident in the stories they write once they have received answers. They are interested mainly in pure politics and can be coerced into examining the substance of an issue only as a last resort. The subtle but sure result is a stream of daily messages that the real meaning of public life is the struggle of Bob Dole against Newt Gingrich against Bill Clinton, rather than our collective efforts to solve collective problems. The natural instinct of newspapers and TV is to present every public issue as if its "real" meaning were political in the meanest and narrowest sense of that term—the attempt by parties and candidates to gain an advantage over their rivals. Reporters do, of course, write stories about political life in the broader sense and about the substance of issues—the pluses and minuses of diplomatic recognition for Vietnam, the difficulties of holding down the Medicare budget, whether immigrants help or hurt the nation's economic base. But when there is a chance to use these issues as props or raw material for a story about political tactics, most reporters leap at it. It is more fun—and easier—to write about Bill Clinton's "positioning" on the Vietnam issue, or how Newt Gingrich is "handling" the need to cut Medicare, than it is to look into the issues themselves. Examples of this preference occur so often that they're difficult to notice. But every morning's newspaper, along with every evening's newscast, reveals this pattern of thought. * Last February, when the Democratic President and the Republican Congress were fighting over how much federal money would go to local law-enforcement agencies, one network-news broadcast showed a clip of Gingrich denouncing Clinton and another of Clinton standing in front of a sea of uniformed police officers while making a tough-on-crime speech. The correspondent's sign-off line was "The White House thinks 'cops on the beat' has a simple but appealing ring to it." That is, the President was pushing the plan because it would sound good in his campaign ads. Whether or not that was Clinton's real motive, nothing in the broadcast gave the slightest hint of where the extra policemen would go, how much they might cost, whether there was reason to think they'd do any good. Everything in the story suggested that the crime bill mattered only as a chapter in the real saga, which was the struggle between Bill and Newt. * Last April, after the explosion at the federal building in Oklahoma City, discussion changed quickly from the event itself to politicians' "handling" of the event. On the Sunday after the blast President Clinton announced a series of new anti-terrorism measures. The next morning, on National Public Radio's Morning Edition, Cokie Roberts was asked about the prospects of the proposals' taking effect. "In some ways it's not even the point," she replied. What mattered was that Clinton "looked good" taking the tough side of the issue. No one expects Cokie Roberts or other political correspondents to be experts on controlling terrorism, negotiating with the Syrians, or the other specific measures on which Presidents make stands. But all issues are shoehorned into the area of expertise the most-prominent correspondents do have:the struggle for one-upmanship among a handful of political leaders. * When health-care reform was the focus of big political battles between Republicans and Democrats, it was on the front page and the evening newscast every day. When the Clinton Administration declared defeat in 1994 and there were no more battles to be fought, health-care news coverage virtually stopped too—even though the medical system still represented one seventh of the economy, even though HMOs and corporations and hospitals and pharmaceutical companies were rapidly changing policies in the face of ever-rising costs. Health care was no longer political news, and therefore it was no longer interesting news. * After California's voters approved Proposition 187 in the 1994 elections, drastically limiting the benefits available to illegal immigrants, the national press ran a trickle of stories on what this would mean for California's economy, its school and legal systems, even its relations with Mexico. A flood of stories examined the political impact of the immigration issue—how the Republicans might exploit it, how the Democrats might be divided by it, whether it might propel Pete Wilson to the White House. * On August 16 last year Bill Bradley announced that after representing New Jersey in the Senate for three terms he would not run for a fourth term. In interviews and at the news conferences he conducted afterward Bradley did his best to talk about the deep problems of public life and economic adjustment that had left him frustrated with the political process. Each of the parties had locked itself into rigid positions that kept it from dealing with the realistic concerns of ordinary people, he said. American corporations were doing what they had to do for survival in international competition: they were downsizing and making themselves radically more efficient and productive. But the result was to leave "decent, hardworking Americans" more vulnerable to layoffs and the loss of their careers, medical coverage, pension rights, and social standing than they had been in decades. Somehow, Bradley said, we had to move past the focus on short-term political maneuvering and determine how to deal with the forces that were leaving Americans frustrated and insecure. That, at least, was what Bill Bradley said. What turned up in the press was almost exclusively speculation about what the move meant for this year's presidential race and the party lineup on Capitol Hill. Might Bradley challenge Bill Clinton in the Democratic primaries? If not, was he preparing for an independent run? Could the Democrats come up with any other candidate capable of holding on to Bradley's seat? Wasn't this a slap in the face for Bill Clinton and the party he purported to lead? In the aftermath of Bradley's announcement prominent TV and newspaper reporters competed to come up with the shrewdest analysis of the political impact of the move. None of the country's major papers or networks used Bradley's announcement as a news peg for an analysis of the real issues he had raised. The day after his announcement Bradley was interviewed by Judy Woodruff on the CNN program Inside Politics. Woodruff is a widely respected and knowledgeable reporter, but her interaction with Bradley was like the meeting of two beings from different universes. Every answer Bradley gave was about the substance of national problems that concerned him. Every one of Woodruff's responses or questions was about short-term political tactics. Woodruff asked about the political implications of his move for Bill Clinton and Newt Gingrich. Bradley replied that it was more important to concentrate on the difficulties both parties had in dealing with real national problems. Midway through the interview Bradley gave a long answer to the effect that everyone involved in politics had to get out of the rut of converting every subject or comment into a political "issue," used for partisan advantage. Let's stop talking, Bradley said, about who will win what race and start responding to one another's ideas. As soon as he finished, Woodruff asked her next question: "Do you want to be President?" It was as if she had not heard a word he had been saying—or couldn't hear it, because the media's language of political analysis is utterly separate from the terms in which people describe real problems in their lives. The effect is as if the discussion of every new advance in medicine boiled down to speculation about whether its creator would win the Nobel Prize that year. Regardless of the tone of coverage, medical research will go on. But a relentless emphasis on the cynical game of politics threatens public life itself, by implying day after day that the political sphere is nothing more than an arena in which ambitious politicians struggle for dominance, rather than a structure in which citizens can deal with worrisome collective problems. Pointless Prediction: The Political Experts On Sunday, November 6, 1994, two days before the congressional elections that swept the Republicans to power, The Washington Post published the results of its "Crystal Ball" poll. Fourteen prominent journalists, pollsters, and all-around analysts made their predictions about how many seats each party would win in the House and Senate and how many governorships each would take. One week later many of these same experts would be saying on their talk shows that the Republican landslide was "inevitable" and "a long time coming" and "a sign of deep discontent in the heartland." But before the returns were in, how many of the fourteen experts predicted that the Republicans would win both houses of Congress and that Newt Gingrich would be speaker? Exactly three. What is interesting about this event is not just that so many experts could be so wrong. Immediately after the election even Newt Gingrich seemed dazed by the idea that the forty-year reign of the Democrats in the House had actually come to an end. Rather, the episode said something about the futility of political prediction itself—a task to which the big-time press devotes enormous effort and time. Two days before the election many of the country's most admired analysts had no idea what was about to happen. Yet within a matter of weeks these same people, unfazed, would be writing articles and giving speeches and being quoted about who was "ahead" and "behind" in the emerging race for the White House in 1996. As with medieval doctors who applied leeches and trepanned skulls, the practitioners cannot be blamed for the limits of their profession. But we can ask why reporters spend so much time directing our attention toward what is not much more than guesswork on their part. It builds the impression that journalism is about what's entertaining—guessing what might or might not happen next month—rather than what's useful, such as extracting lessons of success and failure from events that have already occurred. Competing predictions add almost nothing to our ability to solve public problems or to make sensible choices among complex alternatives. Yet such useless distractions have become a specialty of the political press. They are easy to produce, they allow reporters to act as if they possessed special inside knowledge, and there are no consequences for being wrong. Spoon Feeding: The White House Press Corps In the early spring of last year, when Newt Gingrich was dominating the news from Washington and the O. J. Simpson trial was dominating the news as a whole, The Washington Post ran an article about the pathos of the White House press room. Nobody wanted to hear what the President was doing, so the people who cover the President could not get on the air. Howard Kurtz, the Post's media writer, described the human cost of this political change: Brit Hume is in his closet-size White House cubicle, watching Kato Kaelin testify on CNN. Bill Plante, in the adjoining cubicle, has his feet up and is buried in the New York Times. Brian Williams is in the corridor, idling away the time with Jim Miklaszewski. An announcement is made for a bill-signing ceremony. Some of America's highest-paid television correspondents begin ambling toward the pressroom door. "Are you coming with us?" Williams asks. "I guess so," says Hume, looking forlorn. The White House spokesman, Mike McCurry, told Kurtz that there was some benefit to the enforced silence: "Brit Hume has now got his crossword puzzle capacity down to record time. And some of the reporters have been out on the lecture circuit." The deadpan restraint with which Kurtz told this story is admirable. But the question many readers would want to scream at the idle correspondents is Why don't you go out and do some work? Why not go out and interview someone, even if you're not going to get any airtime that night? Why not escape the monotonous tyranny of the White House press room, which reporters are always complaining about? The knowledge that O.J. will keep you off the air yet again should liberate you to look into those stories you never "had time" to deal with before. Why not read a book—about welfare reform, about Russia or China, about race relations, about anything? Why not imagine, just for a moment, that your journalistic duty might involve something more varied and constructive than doing standups from the White House lawn and sounding skeptical about whatever announcement the President's spokesman put out that day? What might these well-paid, well-trained correspondents have done while waiting for the O.J. trial to become boring enough that they could get back on the air? They might have tried to learn something that would be of use to their viewers when the story of the moment went away. Without leaving Washington, without going farther than ten minutes by taxi from the White House (so that they could be on hand if a sudden press conference was called), they could have prepared themselves to discuss the substance of issues that affect the public. For example, two years earlier Vice President Al Gore had announced an ambitious plan to "reinvent" the federal government. Had it made any difference, either in improving the performance of government or in reducing its cost, or was it all for show? Republicans and Democrats were sure to spend the next few months fighting about cuts in the capital-gains tax. Capital-gains tax rates were higher in some countries and lower in others. What did the experience of these countries show about whether cutting the rates helped an economy to grow? The rate of immigration was rising again, and in California and Florida it was becoming an important political issue. What was the latest evidence on the economic and social effects of immigration? Should Americans feel confident or threatened that so many foreigners were trying to make their way in? Soon both political parties would be advancing plans to reform the welfare system. Within a two-mile radius of the White House lived plenty of families on welfare. Why not go and see how the system had affected them, and what they would do if it changed? The federal government had gone further than most private industries in trying to open opportunities to racial minorities and women. The Pentagon had gone furthest of all. What did people involved in this process—men and women, blacks and whites—think about its successes and failures? What light did their experience shed on the impending affirmative-action debate? The list could go on for pages. With a few minutes' effort—about as long as it takes to do a crossword puzzle—the correspondents could have drawn up lists of other subjects they had never before "had time" to investigate. They had the time now. What they lacked was a sense that their responsibility involved something more than standing up to rehash the day's announcements when there was room for them on the news. Glass Houses: Journalists and Financial Disclosure Half a century ago reporters knew but didn't say that Franklin D. Roosevelt was in a wheelchair. A generation ago many reporters knew but didn't write about John F. Kennedy's insatiable appetite for women. For several months in the early Clinton era reporters knew about but didn't disclose Paula Jones's allegation that, as governor of Arkansas, Bill Clinton had exposed himself to her. Eventually this claim found its way into all the major newspapers, proving that there is no longer any such thing as an accusation too embarrassing to be printed if it seems to bear on a politician's "character." It is not just the President who has given up his privacy in the name of the public's right to know. Over the past two decades officials whose power is tiny compared with the President's have had to reveal embarrassing details about what most Americans consider very private matters: their income and wealth. Each of the more than 3,000 people appointed by the President to executive-branch jobs must reveal previous sources of income and summarize his or her financial holdings. Congressmen have changed their rules to forbid themselves to accept honoraria for speaking to interest groups or lobbyists. The money that politicians do raise from individuals and groups must be disclosed to the Federal Election Commission. The information they disclose is available to the public and appears often in publications, most prominently The Washington Post. No one contends that every contribution makes every politician corrupt. But financial disclosure has become commonplace on the "Better safe than sorry" principle. If politicians and officials are not corrupt, the reasoning goes, they have nothing to fear from letting their finances be publicized. And if they are corrupt, public disclosure is a way to stop them before they do too much harm. The process may be embarrassing, but this is the cost of public life. How different the "Better safe than sorry" calculation seems when journalists are involved! Reporters and pundits hold no elected office, but they are obviously public figures. The most prominent TV-talk-show personalities are better known than all but a handful of congressmen. When politicians and pundits sit alongside one another on Washington talk shows and trade opinions, they underscore the essential similarity of their political roles. The pundits have no vote in Congress, but the overall political impact of a word from George Will, Ted Koppel, William Safire, or any of their colleagues who run the major editorial pages dwarfs anything a third-term congressman could do. If an interest group had the choice of buying the favor of one prominent media figure or of two junior congressmen, it wouldn't even have to think about the decision. The pundit is obviously more valuable. If a reporter is sued for libel by a prominent but unelected personality, such as David Letterman or Donald Trump, he or she says that the offended party is a "public figure"—about whom nearly anything can be written in the press. Public figures, according to the rulings that shape today's libel law, can win a libel suit only if they can prove that a reporter knew that what he or she was writing was false, or had "reckless disregard" for its truth, and went ahead and published it anyway. Public figures, according to the law, pay a price for being well known. And who are these people? The category is not limited to those who hold public office but includes all who "thrust themselves into the public eye." Most journalists would eloquently argue the logic of this broad definition of public figures—until the same standard was applied to them. In 1993 Sam Donaldson, of ABC, described himself in an interview as being in touch with the concerns of the average American. "I'm trying to get a little ranching business started in New Mexico," he said. "I've got five people on the payroll. I'm making out those government forms." Thus he understood the travails of the small businessman and the annoyances of government regulation. Donaldson, whose base pay from ABC is reported to be some $2 million a year, did not point out that his several ranches in New Mexico together covered some 20,000 acres. When doing a segment attacking farm subsidies on Prime Time Live in 1993 he did not point out that "those government forms" allowed him to claim nearly $97,000 in sheep and mohair subsidies over two years. William Neuman, a reporter for the New York Post, said that when his photographer tried to take pictures of Donaldson's ranch house, Donaldson had him thrown off his property. ("In the West trespassing is a serious offense," Donaldson explained.) Had Donaldson as a journalist been pursuing a politician or even a corporate executive, he would have felt justified in using the most aggressive reportorial techniques. When these techniques were turned on him, he complained that the reporters were going too far. The analysts who are so clear-eyed about the conflict of interest in Newt Gingrich's book deal claim that they see no reason, none at all, why their own finances might be of public interest. Last May one of Donaldson's colleagues on This Week With David Brinkley, George Will, wrote a column and delivered on-air comments ridiculing the Clinton Administration's plan to impose tariffs on Japanese luxury cars, notably the Lexus. On the Brinkley show Will said that the tariffs would be "illegal" and would merely amount to "a subsidy for Mercedes dealerships." Neither in his column nor on the show did Will disclose that his wife, Mari Maseng Will, ran a firm that had been paid some $200,000 as a registered foreign agent for the Japan Automobile Manufacturers Association, and that one of the duties for which she was hired was to get American commentators to criticize the tariff plan. When Will was asked why he had never mentioned this, he replied that it was "just too silly" to think that his views might have been affected by his wife's contract. Will had, in fact, espoused such views for years, since long before his wife worked for the JAMA and even before he had married her. Few of his readers would leap to the conclusion that Will was serving as a mouthpiece for his wife's employers. But surely most would have preferred to learn that information from Will himself. A third member of the regular Brinkley panel, Cokie Roberts, is, along with Will and Donaldson, a frequent and highly paid speaker before corporate audiences. She has made a point of not disclosing which interest groups she speaks to or how much money she is paid. She has criticized the Clinton Administration for its secretive handling of the controversy surrounding Hillary Clinton's lucrative cattle-future trades and of the Whitewater affair, yet like the other pundits, she refuses to acknowledge that secrecy about financial interests undermines journalism's credibility too. Out of Touch With America In the week leading up to a State of the Union address White House aides always leak word to reporters that this year the speech will be "different." No more laundry list of all the government's activities, no more boring survey of every potential trouble spot in the world. This time, for a change, the speech is going to be short, punchy, and thematic. When the actual speech occurs, it is never short, punchy, or thematic. It is long and detailed, like all its predecessors, because as the deadline nears, every part of the government scrambles desperately to have a mention of its activities crammed into the speech somewhere. In the days before Bill Clinton's address a year ago aides said that no matter what had happened to all those other Presidents, this time the speech really would be short, punchy, and thematic. The President understood the situation, he recognized his altered role, and he saw this as an opportunity to set a new theme for his third and fourth years in office. That evening the promises once again proved false. Bill Clinton gave a speech that was enormously long even by the standards of previous State of the Union addresses. The speech had three or four apparent endings, it had ad-libbed inserts, and it covered both the details of policy and the President's theories about what had gone wrong with America. An hour and twenty-one minutes after he took the podium, the President stepped down. Less than a minute later the mockery from commentators began. For instant analysis NBC went to Peggy Noonan, who had been a speechwriter for Presidents Ronald Reagan and George Bush. She grimaced and barely tried to conceal her disdain for such an ungainly, sprawling speech. Other commentators soon mentioned that congressmen had been slipping out of the Capitol building before the end of the speech, that Clinton had once more failed to stick to an agenda, that the speech probably would not give the President the new start he sought. The comments were virtually all about the tactics of the speech, and they were almost all thumbs down. A day and a half later the first newspaper columns showed up. They were even more critical. On January 26 The Washington Post's op-ed page consisted mainly of stories about the speech, all of which were withering. "All Mush and No Message" was the headline on a column by Richard Cohen. "An Opportunity Missed" was the more statesmanlike judgment from David Broder. Cohen wrote: "Pardon me if I thought of an awful metaphor: Clinton at a buffet table, eating everything in sight." What a big fat jerk that Clinton was! How little he understood the obligations of leadership! Yet the news section of the same day's Post had a long article based on discussions with a focus group of ordinary citizens in Chicago who had watched the President's speech. "For these voters, the State of the Union speech was an antidote to weeks of unrelenting criticism of Clinton's presidency," the article said. "Tonight reminded us of what has been accomplished," said Maureen Prince, who works as the office manager in her husband's business and has raised five children. "We are so busy hearing the negatives all the time, from the time you wake up on your clock radio in the morning. . . ." The group's immediate impressions mirrored the results of several polls conducted immediately after the president's speech. ABC News found that eight out of 10 approved of the president's speech. CBS News said that 74 percent of those surveyed said they had a "clear idea" of what Clinton stands for, compared with just 41 percent before the speech. A Gallup Poll for USA Today and Cable News Network found that eight in 10 said Clinton is leading the country in the right direction. Nielsen ratings reported in the same day's paper showed that the longer the speech went on, the larger the number of people who tuned in to watch. The point is not that the pundits are necessarily wrong and the public necessarily right. The point is the gulf between the two groups' reactions. The very aspects of the speech that had seemed so ridiculous to the professional commentators— its detail, its inclusiveness, the hyperearnestness of Clinton's conclusion about the "common good"—seemed attractive and worthwhile to most viewers. "I'm wondering what so much of the public heard that our highly trained expert analysts completely missed," Carol Cantor, a software consultant from California, wrote in a discussion on the WELL, a popular online forum, three days after the speech. What they heard was, in fact, the speech, which allowed them to draw their own conclusions rather than being forced to accept an expert "analysis" of how the President "handled" the speech. In most cases the analysis goes unchallenged, because the public has no chance to see whatever event the pundits are describing. In this instance viewers had exactly the same evidence about Clinton's performance that the "experts" did, and from it they drew radically different conclusions. In 1992 political professionals had laughed at Ross Perot's "boring" and "complex" charts about the federal budget deficit—until it became obvious that viewers loved them. And for a week or two after this State of the Union speech there were little jokes on the weekend talk shows about how out of step the pundit reaction had been with opinion "out there." But after a polite chuckle the talk shifted to how the President and the speaker and Senator Dole were handling their jobs. Term Limits As soon as the Democrats were routed in the 1994 elections, commentators and TV analysts said it was obvious that the American people were tired of seeing the same old faces in Washington. The argument went that those who lived inside the Beltway had forgotten what it was like in the rest of the country. They didn't get it. They were out of touch. The only way to jerk the congressional system back to reality was to bring in new blood. A few days after the new Congress was sworn in, CNN began running an updated series of promotional ads for its program Crossfire. (Previous ads had featured shots of locomotives colliding head-on and rams locking horns, to symbolize the meeting of minds on the show.) Everything has been shaken up in the capital, one of the ads began. New faces. New names. New people in charge of all the committees. "In fact," the announcer said, in a tone meant to indicate whimsy, "only one committee hasn't changed. The welcoming committee." The camera pulled back to reveal the three hosts of Crossfire—Pat Buchanan, John Sununu, and Michael Kinsley— standing with arms crossed on the steps of the Capitol building, blocking the path of the new arrivals trying to make their way in. "Watch your step," one of the hosts said. Talk about not getting it! The people who put together this ad must have imagined that the popular irritation with insidethe-Beltway culture was confined to members of Congress—and didn't extend to members of the punditocracy, many of whom had held their positions much longer than the typical congressman had. The difference between the "welcoming committee" and the congressional committees headed by fallen Democratic titans like Tom Foley and Jack Brooks was that the congressmen can be booted out. "Polls show that both Republicans and Democrats felt better about the Congress just after the 1994 elections," a Clinton Administration official said last year. "They had 'made the monkey jump'—they were able to discipline an institution they didn't like. They could register the fact that they were unhappy. There doesn't seem to be any way to do that with the press, except to stop watching and reading, which more and more people have done." Lost Credibility There is an astonishing gulf between the way journalists—especially the most prominent ones—think about their impact and the way the public does. In movies of the 1930s reporters were gritty characters who instinctively sided with the common man. In the 1970s Robert Redford and Dustin Hoffman, starring as Bob Woodward and Carl Bernstein in All the President's Men, were better-paid but still gritty reporters unafraid to challenge big power. Even the local-TV-news crew featured on The Mary Tyler Moore Show had a certain down-to-earth pluck. Ted Knight, as the pea-brained news anchor Ted Baxter, was a ridiculously pompous figure but not an arrogant one. Since the early 1980s the journalists who have shown up in movies have often been portrayed as more loathsome than the lawyers, politicians, and business moguls who are the traditional bad guys in films about the white-collar world. In Absence of Malice, made in 1981, an ambitious newspaper reporter (Sally Field) ruins the reputation of a businessman (Paul Newman) by rashly publishing articles accusing him of murder. In Broadcast News, released in 1987, the anchorman (William Hurt) is still an airhead, like Ted Baxter, but unlike Ted, he works in a business that is systematically hostile to anything except profit and bland good looks. The only sympathetic characters in the movie, an overeducated reporter (Albert Brooks) and a hyperactive and hyperidealistic producer (Holly Hunter), would have triumphed as heroes in a newspaper movie of the 1930s. In this one they are ground down by the philistines at their network. In the Die Hard series, which started in 1988, a TV journalist (William Atherton) is an unctuous creep who will lie and push helpless people around in order to get on the air. In The Bonfire of the Vanities (1990) the tabloid writer Peter Fallow (Bruce Willis) is a disheveled British sot who will do anything for a free drink. In Rising Sun (1993) a newspaper reporter known as "Weasel" (Steve Buscemi) is an out-and-out criminal, accepting bribes to influence his coverage. As Antonia Zerbisias pointed out in the Toronto Star in 1993, movies and TV shows offer almost no illustrations of journalists who are not full of themselves, shallow, and indifferent to the harm they do. During Operation Desert Storm, Saturday Night Live ridiculed American reporters who asked military spokesmen questions like "Can you tell us exactly when and where you are going to launch your attack?" "The journalists were portrayed as ignorant, arrogant and pointlessly adversarial," Jay Rosen, of New York University, wrote about the episode. "By gently rebuffing their ludicrous questions, the Pentagon briefer [on SNL] came off as a model of sanity." Even real-life members of the Washington pundit corps have made their way into movies—Eleanor Clift, Morton Kondracke, hosts from Crossfire—in 1990s releases such as Dave and Rising Sun. Significantly, their role in the narrative is as buffoons. The joke in these movies is how rapidly the pundits leap to conclusions, how predictable their reactions are, how automatically they polarize the debate without any clear idea of what has really occurred. That reallife journalists are willing to keep appearing in such movies, knowing how they will be cast, says something about the source of self-respect in today's media: celebrity, on whatever basis, matters more than being taken seriously. Movies do not necessarily capture reality, but they suggest a public mood—in this case, a contrast between the apparent self-satisfaction of the media celebrities and the contempt in which they are held by the public. "The news media has a generally positive view of itself in the watchdog role," wrote the authors of an exhaustive survey of public attitudes and the attitudes of journalists themselves toward the press. (The survey was conducted by the Times Mirror Center for the People and the Press, and was released last May.)But "the outside world strongly faults the news media for its negativism. . . . The public goes so far as to say that the press gets in the way of society solving its problems. . . ." According to the survey, "two out of three members of the public had nothing or nothing good to say about the media." The media establishment is beginning to get at least an inkling of this message. Through the past decade discussions among newspaper editors and publishers have been a litany of woes: fewer readers; lower "penetration" rates, as a decreasing share of the public pays attention to news; a more and more desperate search for ways to attract the public's interest. In the short run these challenges to credibility are a problem for journalists and journalism. In the longer run they are a problem for democracy. Turning a Calling Into a Sideshow Even if practiced perfectly, journalism will leave some resentment and bruised feelings in its wake. The justification that journalists can offer for the harm they inevitably inflict is to show, through their actions, their understanding that what they do matters and that it should be done with care. This is why the most depressing aspect of the new talking-pundit industry may be the argument made by many practitioners: the whole thing is just a game, which no one should take too seriously. Michael Kinsley, a highly respected and indisputably talented policy journalist, has written that his paid speaking engagements are usually mock debates, in which he takes the liberal side. Since the audiences are generally composed of affluent businessmen, my role is like that of the team that gets to lose to the Harlem Globetrotters. But Ido it because it pays well, because it's fun to fly around the country and stay in hotels, and because even a politically unsympathetic audience can provide a cheap ego boost. Last year Morton Kondracke, of The McLaughlin Group, told Mark Jurkowitz, of The Boston Globe, "This is not writing, this is not thought." He was describing the talk-show activity to which he has devoted a major part of his time for fifteen years. "You should not take it a hundred percent seriously. Anybody who does is a fool." Fred Barnes wrote that he was happy to appear in a mock McLaughlin segment on Murphy Brown, because "the line between news and fun barely exists anymore." The McLaughlin Group often takes its act on the road, gimmicks and all, for fees reported to be about $20,000 per appearance. Crossfire goes for paid jaunts on the road. So do panelists from The Capital Gang. Contracts for such appearances contain a routine clause specifying that the performance may not be taped or broadcast. This provision allows speakers to recycle their material, especially those who stitch together anecdotes about "the mood in Washington today." It also reassures the speakers that the sessions aren't really serious. They won't be held to account for what they say, so the normal standards don't apply. Yet the fact that no one takes the shows seriously is precisely what's wrong with them, because they jeopardize the credibility of everything that journalists do. "I think one of the really destructive developments in Washington in the last fifteen years has been the rise in these reporter talk shows,"Tom Brokaw has said. "Reporters used to cover policy—not spend all of their time yelling at each other and making philistine judgments about what happened the week before. It's not enlightening. It makes me cringe." When talk shows go on the road for performances in which hostility and disagreement are staged for entertainment value; when reporters pick up thousands of dollars appearing before interest groups and sharing tidbits of what they have heard; when all the participants then dash off for the next plane, caring about none of it except the money—when these things happen, they send a message. The message is: We don't respect what we're doing. Why should anyone else? Why Americans Hate the Media by James Fallows 1. How did the answers to the hypothetical question that Charles Ogletree asked Peter Jennings and Mike Wallace horrify military leaders? What would have been your answer? 2. How were the types of questions that average Americans asked during the 1992 presidential campaign different than those of reporters? 3. According to Fallows, what is the rationale behind reporters focusing on the politics of an issue rather than the facts behind an issue? 4. Why don’t reporters spend more time investigating stories and issues rather than just reporting what information is given to them? 5. Should reporters on the national level be treated with the same “star” treatment as other celebrities? Why don’t Americans treat them that way? 6. According to Fallows, how is the modern media out of touch with its viewers and readers when it comes to politics? 7. How have television and movies portrayed journalists in recent years? 8. How has television news become more like an entertainment show? What types of stories are on television news that a generation ago, would have never made headlines? 9. How have “news” talk shows changed the public perception of journalism? Unit V- Branches of GovernmentPart A- The Congress Suppose you were an idiot and suppose you were a member of Congress. But I repeat myself. Mark Twain Assignments Study Guide for Chapter 11, Article on Congress Essay Mock Legislation Simulation Prompted Essay Assessments Chapter 11 Exam- Multiple Choice and One FRQ Secondary Readings Burke- Speech to the Electors of Bristol Ellwood- In Praise of Pork Riedl- Nine Thousand Earmarks Starobin- Pork a Time Honored Tradition Chapter 11 Study Questions The Congress 1. Summarize the differences between Congress and a parliament. 2. Why is Congress a decentralized institution and why is Congress inevitably unpopular with voters. 3. Read through the six phases of the House of Representatives so that you are clear about the rules changes and the balance of power between the Speaker and committee chairmen. Briefly summarize phases four-six. (It is not important for you to learn the name of individual Speakers – unless you want to be a history major or quiz bowl whiz.) 4. How has the history and structure of the Senate meant that it would be different from the House of Representatives? 5. What were the main issues in the development of the Senate and how were these issues settled? Make sure that you understand what these terms refer to: filibuster, cloture, Rule 22 6. Summarize the points that Edmund Burke made in his speech to the Bristol Electors about the responsibilities of a representative to his constituents. 7. Briefly summarize the trends in the sex and race of members of Congress. 8. What were the reasons why there were more new members to the House in the early 1990s? 9. Why have more congressional districts become safer for incumbent reelection? 10. What are the possible explanations for why the Democrats dominated Congress from 1933-1994? 11. Why has Congress become more ideologically partisan since the 1980s? 12. Define malapportionment, gerrymandering, majority-minority districts. 13. How have districts been designed to increase minority representation and what has the Supreme Court ruled about this? What is the difference between descriptive and substantive representation? 14. What is the sophomore surge? Why does it happen? What effects does it have? 15. Summarize the three theories of how members of Congress behave. 16. Why has civility decreased among legislators? 17. What are the principal jobs and responsibilities in the party leadership in the Senate? 18. What are the powers of the Speaker of the House? How did Newt Gingrich change the structure of the House? 19. Why are the members of each party so polarized today? 20. What are caucuses and why are they important? 21. Define the four different types of committees. 22. How has the committee structure changed in the past 30 years? What has been the effect of these changes and how does having a large staff create a demand for more staff? 23. What do the GAO, and CBO do? 24. You must know 16 terms in bold on pages 313 – 318. Find some way to memorize them: choose what works for you – flashcards, notes, sleeping on them. You will be quizzed on them 25. How can a filibuster be broken? What do the changes for breaking a filibuster mean for trying to pass a bill in the Senate. 26. Think about it and give your opinion as to the impact the differences between the House and Senate have on policy-making. You must know the chart on p. 319 summarizing the differences between the House and Senate. Figure out a way to learn it. 27. Make a list of the different powers that the Constitution gives to either the House or Senate. This is a review question and you should be able to do it off the top of your head. Then go check yourself by looking at the Constitution. (It’s in an appendix in the back of the book or you have your own copy.) Read through Article I, Sections 1, 3, and 7 and Article II, Section 2. Add in anything you may have forgotten. 28. What are the arguments for and against term limits? 29. How have the Congressmen’s powers and perks been reduced? 30. In general, what type of rules are there to make sure our Congress members are ethical? 31. After reading the articles by Paul Starobin, John Ellwood and Eric Patashik, and Brian Riedl, make a list of the arguments for and against pork. Include arguments from the textbook. 32. Look at the short article regarding Gerrymandering. How has the practice of Gerrymandering made it easier for members of Congress to remain in office? What political hurdles does a newcomer have when dealing with districts like the examples shown? Terms to Know “one man, one vote” 17th Amendment Attitudinal theory Baker v. Carr (1962) bicameral Blue Dog Democrats Caucus Christmas tree bill closed rule cloture cloture rule Committee of the Whole Committee on Committees (R) Concurrent resolution Conference Committees Congressional Black Caucus Congressional Budget Office (CBO) Congressional courtesy Congressional Research Service descriptive representation discharge petition double-tracking Earmarks Edmund Burke filibuster franking privilege General Accounting Office (GAO) gerrymandering Harry Reid Holds House Banking scandal House Post office scandal Joint Committees Joint resolution logrolling Majority and Minority leaders majority-minority districts malapportionment Marginal districts multiple referral Nancy Pelosi Newt Gingrich Nongermane amendment open rule Organizational theory Party caucus Party polarization Party Whip Policy Committee Pork-Barrel President Pro Tempore privileged speech quorum quorum call Reapportionment redistricting Representational theory restrictive rule rider roll-call vote Rule 22 Rules Committee Safe districts Select Committees seniority system sequential referral Shaw v. Reno (1993) Simple resolution sophomore surge Speaker of the House Standing Committees Steering Committee (D) substantive representation term limits Unanimous consent unicameral US Term Limits, Inc. v. Thornton (1995) Wesberry v. Sanders 1964 Article on Congress Assignment Due Date – by but feel quite free to turn it in earlier. Find one article or editorial on Congress from the past three months. The article must relate to themes that we have studied in class or in the book. Print out or cut out the article. 1. First, write up a short summary of the main points in the article. 2. Then write up how what the article says supports or contradicts what we have been studying. This is the most important part of your write-up, so be sure to pick an article that lends itself to this assignment. Also, make sure that you pick an article of sufficient length to have substance in it. My secret, nefarious goal is for you to develop your own current example of some aspect of political theory and practice that we’re studying. You will be handing this in for a grade. Here is an easy way to find an article. 1. Go to News Google http://news.google.com/ 2. Type in Congress plus one of the key terms from your study guide about something that you’re interested in such as redistricting, cloture, filibuster, pork, gerrymander, congressional courtesy, Speaker of the House, etc. Remember to put quotation marks around phrases or your search will turn up anything that has speaker, of, house in the same article. You could also put in the names of prominent members of Congress. Any article about Nancy Pelosi or Harry Reid, for example, is probably about something that relates to this course. 3. Pick one of the choices that looks substantial (as in having substance and sufficient length to cover material and get you an excellent grade.) 4. Double check that the article refers to the U.S. Congress and not a state legislature. If you have any doubt, ask me. 5. You’re ready to write up the assignment. Mock Legislation For homework- you will write up an idea that could be proposed as a possible law. Feel free to do some research to back up your idea; facts and figures always impress members of the legislature (your class) Your “Law Book”- The PHS Student Handbook The Constitution- CA Ed Code and actual Constitution (Your instructor will be playing the role of the Supreme Court) 1. You will be divided into groups of 4-5 members each. Each group will assign different committee chairperson and a recording secretary. 2. Each committee will discuss the different bills written by each student before the activity. The committee chairperson will lead the discussion. Each student must be given at least 2 minutes to present his/her bill. 3. After the discussions, each committee will choose one particular bill to propose to the whole assembly of legislators. This shall be done through voting. Decisions will be made through majority vote. 4. After a bill has been considered, the committee will now decide what changes to make, if any, this is called the mark-up session. 5. When all changes have been made, the committee votes either to kill the bill or to report it. 6. If the committee decides to report it, they send the revised bill to the whole legislative assembly. All the members of the committees will now assume the role of the whole assembly. At this point the following leaders are chosen, presiding officer, or speaker, Sergeant at Arms, and recording-clerk. The Speaker- They will run the assembly, deciding which order each committee will present. Sergeant at Arms- They make sure the committees stay on track, and do not deviate from the task at hand. Recording-clerk- They keep a written record of the decisions of the assembly. 7. Each committee will present its own proposed bill by allowing one person from the group to present the bill to the whole assembly. After the presentation, questions will be asked by members of the assembly. These questions must be on the mechanics of the bill, in essence what impact the bill would have on the American public. 8. After all committees have made their presentations; members of the assembly will now vote for the bill(s) they would propose to become a law(s). Step 1- Bill Draft What is your initial idea? What problem would your idea solve? How would the school enforce your idea? Does your idea require any money to make it work? Side A Side B Side A will vote on the following positions Side B will vote on the following positions Speaker Sergeant at Arms Speaker Sergeant at Arms Recording Clerk Recording Clerk Step 2: You will introduce your initial idea to Step 2: You will introduce your initial idea to your your Side part of the assembly The two Sides will compare all the potential bills. Only ideas that both groups have in common will move on to the next round. Step 3: Based on your idea(s) you will be placed into a committee to discuss the strengths and weaknesses of your idea. You will debate each person’s ideas Step 3: Based on your idea(s) you will be placed into a committee to discuss the strengths and weaknesses of your idea. You will debate each person’s ideas Your committee must choose only ONE idea to take back to Side A Step 4: What is your committees bill? Your committee must choose only ONE idea to take back to Side B Step 4: What is your committees bill? Is it good enough to win? Why? Is it good enough to win? Why? Each committee will appoint a spokesperson who will discuss the strengths and weaknesses of your group’s idea. Each committee will appoint a spokesperson who will discuss the strengths and weaknesses of your group’s idea. Step 5: Your Speaker will decide on the order in which the committees will present with time for debate (4 minutes maximum for each committee) Sergeant at Arms will keep track of the remaining time Step 5: Your Speaker will decide on the order in which the committees will present with time for debate (4 minutes maximum for each committee) Sergeant at Arms will keep track of the remaining time Side A will vote and choose one bill to move forward Side B will vote and choose one bill to move forward At this time, the two sides will swap their two bills. Side A will debate the merits of Side B and vice versa If the two bills are radically different from each other, both of the sides must draft their own version of the bill. If the two bills are similar, they will move to the next step Step 6: Both Sides will discuss the one shared bill that both groups have agreed upon. Both sides must agree that the idea has merit, has a chance of working. Both sides must agree on the language of the policy being written. The two recording clerks will work together to draft the final version of the bill The two Sides will vote on the Final version The bill proposal will be presented to the Administration Step 7 – The Administration either approves or denies the idea (veto) Step 8- (Not going to happen tomorrow) Idea is written into the Student Handbook Step 9- Administration begins to enforce policy in August 2010 Description of Activity Step 1- Draft Bill Step 2- Introduction Step 3- Committee Action Step 4- Vote to Report Bill Step5- Floor Activity Step 6- Conference Step 7 – Presidential Action Step 8- Law is codified Step 9 –Regulatory Activity What is done at each level Edmund Burke, Speech to the Electors of Bristol 3 Nov. 1774 Works 1:446--48 I am sorry I cannot conclude without saying a word on a topic touched upon by my worthy colleague. I wish that topic had been passed by at a time when I have so little leisure to discuss it. But since he has thought proper to throw it out, I owe you a clear explanation of my poor sentiments on that subject. He tells you that "the topic of instructions has occasioned much altercation and uneasiness in this city;" and he expresses himself (if I understand him rightly) in favour of the coercive authority of such instructions. Certainly, gentlemen, it ought to be the happiness and glory of a representative to live in the strictest union, the closest correspondence, and the most unreserved communication with his constituents. Their wishes ought to have great weight with him; their opinion, high respect; their business, unremitted attention. It is his duty to sacrifice his repose, his pleasures, his satisfactions, to theirs; and above all, ever, and in all cases, to prefer their interest to his own. But his unbiassed opinion, his mature judgment, his enlightened conscience, he ought not to sacrifice to you, to any man, or to any set of men living. These he does not derive from your pleasure; no, nor from the law and the constitution. They are a trust from Providence, for the abuse of which he is deeply answerable. Your representative owes you, not his industry only, but his judgment; and he betrays, instead of serving you, if he sacrifices it to your opinion. My worthy colleague says, his will ought to be subservient to yours. If that be all, the thing is innocent. If government were a matter of will upon any side, yours, without question, ought to be superior. But government and legislation are matters of reason and judgment, and not of inclination; and what sort of reason is that, in which the determination precedes the discussion; in which one set of men deliberate, and another decide; and where those who form the conclusion are perhaps three hundred miles distant from those who hear the arguments? To deliver an opinion, is the right of all men; that of constituents is a weighty and respectable opinion, which a representative ought always to rejoice to hear; and which he ought always most seriously to consider. But authoritative instructions; mandates issued, which the member is bound blindly and implicitly to obey, to vote, and to argue for, though contrary to the clearest conviction of his judgment and conscience,--these are things utterly unknown to the laws of this land, and which arise from a fundamental mistake of the whole order and tenor of our constitution. Parliament is not a congress of ambassadors from different and hostile interests; which interests each must maintain, as an agent and advocate, against other agents and advocates; but parliament is a deliberative assembly of one nation, with one interest, that of the whole; where, not local purposes, not local prejudices, ought to guide, but the general good, resulting from the general reason of the whole. You choose a member indeed; but when you have chosen him, he is not member of Bristol, but he is a member of parliament. If the local constituent should have an interest, or should form an hasty opinion, evidently opposite to the real good of the rest of the community, the member for that place ought to be as far, as any other, from any endeavour to give it effect. I beg pardon for saying so much on this subject. I have been unwillingly drawn into it; but I shall ever use a respectful frankness of communication with you. Your faithful friend, your devoted servant, I shall be to the end of my life: a flatterer you do not wish for. The Founders' Constitution Volume 1, Chapter 13, Document 7 http://press-pubs.uchicago.edu/founders/documents/v1ch13s7.html The University of Chicago Press Burke- Speech at Bristol Questions 1. Do you agree that the public will, or opinions of constituents, should be subordinate to the judgment of the elected representative. If 80% of a congressional district’s voters desire one policy outcome, and the representative desires another, is the representative justified in voting his conscience and not the will of his constituents? Should officials be subject to mandates and instructions from the populace? 2. What is the national interest? Can it be defined? Burke argues that a deliberative body serves on national interest, and not the diverse and hostile interests of different localities and districts. Critics of Congress often argue that it fails to serve the nation, fragmenting instead into warring factions serving narrow, local interests. Is Burke’s reasoning still valid if there is no national interest? 3. Have recent development in American politics taken us away from Burkean theory of representation? Recall elections, candidate-centered elections, pandering to public opinion through photo opportunities, and constant poling – do these mechanisms of modern politics threaten the freedom of elected officials to decide based on their own judgment, their trust from Providence? JOHN ELLWOOD ERIC PATASHNIK In Praise of Pork Pork-barrel spending is high on Americans' list of gripes against Congress. "Asparagus research and mink reproduction" typify the wasteful spending that seems to enrich congressional districts and states while bankrupting the nation. John Ellwood and Eric Patashnik take a different view. Pork is not the real cause of the nation's budget crisis, they feel. In fact, pork projects may be just what members of the House and Senate need to be able to satisfy constituents in order to summon the courage to vote for real significant,' painful budget cuts. . IN A WHITE HOUSE address. . . [in] March [1992], President Bush challenged Congress to cut $5.7 billion of pork barrel projects to help reduce the deficit. * Among the projects Bush proposed eliminating were such congressional favorites as funding for asparagus research, mink reproduction, and local parking garages. The examples he cited would be funny, said the President, "if the effect weren't so serious." . . . Such episodes are a regular occurrence in Washington. Indeed, since the first Congress convened in 1789 and debated whether to build a lighthouse to protect the Chesapeake Bay, legislators of both parties have attempted to deliver federal funds back home for capital improvements and other projects, while presidents have tried to excise pork from the congressional diet. . . . In recent years, public outrage over government waste has run high. Many observers see pork barrel spending not only as a symbol of an out of control Congress but as a leading cause of the nation's worsening budget deficit. To cite one prominent example, Washington Post editor Brian Kelly claims in his recent book, Adventures in Porkland: My Washington Can't Stop Spending Your Money, that the 1992 federal budget alone contains $97 billion of pork projects so entirely without merit that they could be "lopped out" without affecting the "welfare of the nation." Kelly's claims are surely overblown. For example, he includes the lower prices that consumers would pay if certain price supports were withdrawn, even though these savings (while certainly desirable) would for the most part not show up in the government's ledgers. Yet reductions in pork barrel spending have also been advocated by those who acknowledge that pork, properly measured, comprises only a tiny fraction of total federal outlays. For example, Kansas Democrat Jim Slattery, who led the battle in the House in 1991 against using $500,000 in federal funds to turn Lawrence WeIk's birthplace into a shrine, told Common Cause Magazine, "it's important from the standpoint of restoring public confidence in Congress to show we are prepared to stop wasteful spending," even if the cuts are only symbolic. In a similar vein, a recent Newsweek cover story, while conceding that "cutting out the most extreme forms of pork wouldn't eliminate the federal deficit;' emphasizes that doing so "would demonstrate that Washington has the political will to reform its profligate ways." The premise of these statements is that the first thing anyone-whether an individual consumer or the United States government-trying to save money should cut out is the fluff. As Time magazine rhetorically asks: "when Congress is struggling without much success to reduce the federal budget deficit, the question naturally arises: is pork really necessary?" Our answer is yes. We believe in pork not because every new dam or overpass deserves to be funded, nor because we consider pork an appropriate instrument of fiscal policy (there are more efficient ways of stimulating a $5 trillion economy). Rather, we think that pork, doled out strategically, can help to sweeten an otherwise unpalatable piece of legislation. No bill tastes so bitter to the average member of Congress as one that raises taxes or cuts popular programs. Any credible deficit-reduction package will almost certainly have to do both. In exchange for an increase in pork barrel spending, however, members of Congress just might be willing to bite the bullet and make the politically difficult decisions that will be required if the federal deficit is ever to be brought under control. In a perfect world it would not be necessary to bribe elected officials to perform their jobs well. But, as James Madison pointed out two centuries ago in Federalist 51, men are not angels and we do not live in a perfect world. The object of government is therefore not to suppress the imperfections of human nature, which would be futile, but rather to harness the pursuit of self-interest to public ends. Unfortunately, in the debate over how to reduce the deficit, Madison's advice has all too often gone ignored. Indeed, if there is anything the major budget-reform proposals of the last decade (Gramm-Rudman, the balanced-budget amendment, an entitlement cap*) have in common, it is that in seeking to impose artificial limits on government spending without offering anything in return, they work against the electoral interests of congressmen instead of with them - which is why these reforms have been so vigorously resisted. No reasonable observer would argue that pork barrel spending has always been employed as a force for good or that there are no pork projects what would have been better left unbuilt. But singling out pork as the culprit for our fiscal troubles directs attention away from the largest sources of budgetary growth and contributes to the illusion that the budget can be balanced simply by eliminating waste and abuse. While proposals to achieve a pork-tree budget are not without superficial appeal, they risk depriving leaders trying to enact real deficit-reduction measures of one of the most effective coalition-building tools at their disposal. In order to appreciate why congressmen are so enamored of pork it is helpful to understand exactly what pork is. But defining pork is not as easy as it sounds. According to Congressional Quarterly, pork is usually considered to be "wasteful" spending that flows to a particular state or district in order to please voters back home. Like beauty, however, waste is in the eye of the beholder. As University of Michigan budget expert Edward M. Gramlich puts it, "one guy's pork is another guy's red meat" To a district plagued by double-digit unemployment, a new highway project is a sound investment, regardless of local transportation needs. Some scholars simply define pork as any program that is economically inefficient-that is, any program whose total costs exceed its total benefits. But this definition tars with the same brush both real pork and programs that, while inefficient, can be justified on grounds of distributional equity or in which geographic legislative influence is small or nonexistent. A more promising approach is suggested by political scientist David Mayhew in his 1974 book, Congress: The Electoral Connection. According to Mayhew, congressional life consists largely of "a relentless search" for ways of claiming credit for making good things happen back home and thereby increasing the likelihood of remaining in office. Because there are 535 congressmen and not one, each individual congressman must try to "peel off pieces of governmental accomplishment for which he can believably generate a sense of responsibility." For most congressmen, the easiest way of doing this is to supply goods to their home districts. From this perspective, the ideal pork barrel project has three key properties. First, benefits are conferred on a specific geographical constituency small enough to allow a single congressman to be recognized as the benefactor. Second, benefits are given out in such a fashion as to lead constituents to believe that the congressman had a hand in the allocation. Third, costs resulting from the project are widely diffused or otherwise obscured from taxpayer notice. Political pork, then, offers a congressman's constituents an array of benefits at little apparent cost. Because pork projects are easily distinguished by voters from the ordinary outputs of government, they provide an incumbent with the opportunity to portray himself as a "prime mover" who deserves to be reelected. When a congressman attends a ribbon-cutting ceremony for a shiny new building in his district, every voter can see that he is accomplishing something in Washington. . . . "It's outrageous that you've got to have such political payoffs to get Congress to do the nation's business," says James Miller, OMB director under Ronald Reagan. Miller's outrage is understandable but ultimately unproductive. Human nature and the electoral imperative being what they are, the pork barrel is here to stay. But if pork is a permanent part of the political landscape, it is incumbent upon leaders to ensure that taxpayers get something for their money. Our most effective presidents have been those who have linked the distribution of pork to the achievement of critical national objectives. When Franklin Roosevelt discovered he could not develop an atomic bomb without the support of Tennessee Senator Kenneth McKellar, chairman of the Appropriations Committee, he readily agreed to locate the bomb facility in Oak Ridge. By contrast, our least effective presidents-Jimmy Carter comes to mind-have either given away plum projects for nothing or waged hopeless battles against pork, squandering scarce political capital and weakening their ability to govern in the process. The real value of pork projects ultimately lies in their ability to induce rational legislators into taking electorally risky actions for the sake of the public good. Over the last ten years, as the discretionary part of the budget has shrunk, congressmen have had fewer and fewer opportunities to claim credit for directly aiding their constituents. As Brookings scholar R. Kent Weaver has argued, in an era of scarcity and difficult political choices, many legislators gave up on trying to accomplish anything positive, focusing their energies instead on blame avoidance. The result has been the creation of a political climate in which elected officials now believe the only way they can bring the nation back to fiscal health is to injure their own electoral chances. This cannot be good for the future of the republic. Politics got us into the deficit mess, however, and only politics can get us out. According to both government and private estimates, annual deficits will soar after the mid-1990s, and could exceed $600 billion in 2002 if the economy performs poorly. Virtually every prominent mainstream economist agrees that reducing the deficit significantly will require Congress to do what it has been strenuously trying to avoid for more than a decade-rein in spending for Social Security, Medicare, and other popular, middle-class entitlement programs. Tax increases may also be necessary. From the vantage point of the average legislator, the risk of electoral retribution seems enormous. If reductions in popular programs and increases in taxes are required to put our national economic house back in order, the strategic use of pork to obtain the support of key legislators for these measures will be crucial. . . . . . . [T]he president should ignore the advice of fiscal puritans who would completely exorcise pork from the body politic. Favoring legislators with small gifts for their districts in order to achieve great things for the nation is an act not of sin but of statesmanship. To be sure, determining how much pork is needed and to which members it should be distributed is difficult. Rather than asking elected officials to become selfless angels, however, we would ask of them only that they be smart politicians. We suspect Madison would agree that the latter request has a far better chance of being favorably received. Starobin, Paul. “Pork: A Time-Honored Tradition.” POLITICAL PORK. Since the first Congress convened two centuries ago, lawmakers have ladled it out to home constituencies in the form of cash for roads, bridges and sundry other civic projects. It is a safe bet that the distribution of such largess will continue for at least as long into the future.* Pork-barrel politics, in fact, is as much a part of the congressional scene as the two parties or the rules of courtesy for floor debate. . . . And yet pork-barrel politics always has stirred controversy. Critics dislike seeing raw politics guiding decisions on the distribution of federal money for parochial needs. They say disinterested experts, if possible, should guide that money flow. And fiscal conservatives wonder how Congress will ever get a handle on the federal budget with so many lawmakers grabbing so forcefully for pork-barrel funds. "Let's change the system so we don't have so much porking," says James C. Miller III, director of the White House Office of Management and Budget (OMB). Miller says he gets complaints on the order of one a day from congressional members taking issue with OMB suggestions that particular "pork" items in the budget are wasteful. But pork has its unabashed defenders. How, these people ask, can lawmakers ignore the legitimate demands of their constituents? When a highway needs to be built or a waterway constructed, the home folks quite naturally look to their congressional representative for help. Failure to respond amounts to political suicide. I’ve really always been a defender of pork-barreling because that's what I think people elect us for," says Rep. Douglas H. Bosco, D-Calif. Moreover, many accept pork as a staple of the legislative process, lubricating the squeaky wheels of Congress by giving members a personal stake in major bills. . . . Not only does the flow of pork continue pretty much unabated, it seems to be spreading to areas that traditionally haven't been subject to pork-barrel competition. Pork traditionally was identified with public- works projects such as roads, bridges, dams and harbors. But, as the economy and country have changed, lawmakers have shifted their appetites to what might be called "post-industrial" pork. Some examples: Green Pork. During the 1960s and 1970s, when dam-builders fought epic struggles with environmentalists, "pork-barrel" projects stereotypically meant bulldozers and concrete. But many of today's projects are more likely to draw praise than blame from environmentalists. The list includes sewer projects, waste-site cleanups, solar energy laboratories, pollution-control research, parks and park improvements and fish hatcheries, to name a few. . . . Academic Pork. Almost no federal funds for construction of university research facilities are being appropriated these days, except for special projects sponsored by lawmakers for campuses back home. Many of the sponsors sit on the Appropriations committees, from which they are well positioned to channel such funds. . . . Defense Pork. While the distribution of pork in the form of defense contracts and location of military installations certainly isn't new, there's no question that Reagan's military buildup has expanded opportunities for lawmakers to practice pork-barrel politics. . . . This spread of the pork-barrel system to new areas raises a question: What exactly is pork? Reaching a definition isn't easy. Many people consider it wasteful spending that flows to a particular state or district and is sought to please the folks back home. But what is wasteful? One man's boondoggle is another man's civic pride. Perhaps the most sensible definition is that which a member seeks for his own state or district but would not seek for anyone else's constituency. Thus, pork goes to the heart of the age-old tension between a lawmaker's twin roles as representative of a particular area and member of a national legislative body. In the former capacity, the task is to promote the local interest; in the latter it is to weigh the national interest. . . . Like other fraternities, the system has a code of behavior and a pecking order. It commands loyalty and serves the purpose of dividing up federal money that presumably has to go somewhere, of helping re-elect incumbents and of keeping the wheels of legislation turning. . . . When applied with skill, pork can act as a lubricant to smooth passage of complex legislation. At the same time, when local benefits are distributed for merely "strategic" purposes, it can lead to waste. . . . Just about everyone agrees that the budget crunch has made the competition to get pet projects in spending legislation more intense. Demand for such items has not shrunk nearly as much as the pool of available funds. *The interesting, little-known, and ignominious origin of the tenn "pork barrel" comes from early in American history, when a barrel of salt pork was given to slaves as a reward for their work. The slaves had to compete among themselves to get their piece of the handout. -Eds. Nine Thousand Earmarks By: Brian Riedl Tuesday, March 03, 2009 Even a recession and record $1.4 trillion budget deficit has not altered Congress's business-as-usual culture of spending and pork. While families and entrepreneurs are responsibly bringing their own budgets under control, Congress is spending and earmarking as if nothing has changed in the economy. The House has already passed—and the Senate will soon take up—a mammoth FY 2009 omnibus appropriation bill[1] that: Provides an 8 percent discretionary spending hike for the second consecutive year; Combines with the "stimulus" bill for a staggering 80 percent increase in these discretionary programs; May contribute to a permanent $2,000 per-household tax hike; Contains 9,287 pork projects at a cost of nearly $13 billion; and Likely terminates the Washington, D.C., school voucher program, removing 1,715 low-income students from their current schools. This bill represents nearly everything Democrats had criticized about the earlier Republican Congresses. It forces lawmakers to vote quickly on a bloated package combining nine separate appropriations bills. It irresponsibly expands the already-record budget deficit. And despite strongly worded proclamations about cleaning up Washington, the 2009 appropriation bills will have the second-most earmarks in history. During this time of recession and skyrocketing budget deficits, America cannot afford budgets that continue to spend and earmark as usual. Runaway Spending The omnibus spending bill increases discretionary spending by 8 percent for the second consecutive year. But that is only part of the story. These same discretionary programs have already received much of the colossal $1.1 trillion stimulus bill enacted recently. Counting those funds, this omnibus spending will finalize a staggering 80 percent spending increase for these programs in 2009—from $378 billion to $680 billion (see Chart 1).[2] This spending binge is virtually unprecedented in American history. Domestic discretionary programs—the subject of most of the omnibus bill—have not exactly been starved in the past, either. From 2001 through 2008, these programs grew 23 percent faster than inflation, due in part to large increases for education (35 percent), health research (37 percent), and veterans' benefits (54 percent).[3] Clearly, these programs do not need even more budget increases. Yet rather than ask federal agencies to join the American people in some recessionary belt-tightening, Congress expanded these programs by 8 percent last year and is in the process of adding another 8 percent this year—not even counting the historic 71 percent hike resulting from the "stimulus." Some insist that this "stimulus" spending will be only temporary. Yet it is difficult to imagine lawmakers allowing programs like Pell grants and health spending to return to their original levels in two years. Consequently, much of this 80 percent discretionary spending surge is likely to eventually become part of the permanent discretionary spending baseline. This would permanently raise spending—and therefore taxes—by over $2,000 per household annually. Regrettably, the omnibus bill does not offset this new spending. In failing to offer spending reductions, congressional appropriators ignored: At least $55 billion in annual program overpayments; $60 billion for corporate welfare; $123 billion for programs for which government auditors can find no evidence of success; $140 billion in potential budget savings identified in the Congressional Budget Office's (CBO) "Budget Options" books; and Massive program duplication, such as the 342 economic development programs, the 130 programs serving the disabled, the 130 programs serving at-risk youth, and the 90 early childhood development programs.[4] Unfortunately, taxpayers should perhaps expect more of the same over the next few years. President Obama has already signed into law a large expansion of the State Children's Health Insurance Program (SCHIP), as well as a budget-busting $1.1 trillion "stimulus" bill. Many of the "stimulus" provisions—such as education, infrastructure, and the weakening of the 1996 welfare reforms—are long-term government expansions that have nothing to do with immediate stimulus. President Obama has not yet offered the tough decisions he has promised. 9,287 Earmarks Although Democrats strongly criticized the proliferation of earmarks under Republican rule, they have made no serious efforts to pare them back. The omnibus bill spends $12.8 billion on 9,287 earmarks.[5] When combined with the early 2009 spending bills ($16.1 billion spent on 2,627 earmarks[6]), the 2009 total comes to 11,914 earmarks at a cost of $28.9 billion. This represents the second most earmarks—and the second highest cost—in American history.[7] Clearly, the earmark culture has not been swept away. The Washington Post recently summarized a Taxpayers for Common Sense study that found that "60 percent of the members of the House Armed Services Committee who arranged earmarks also received campaign contributions from the companies that received the funding. Almost all the members of the committee received campaign contributions from companies that got earmarks this year."[8] And yet despite repeated scandals—some resulting in lawmakers being sentenced to prison—the number of annual earmarks continues to increase. Lawmakers have even rejected a modest proposal to temporarily suspend earmarks until the process can be cleaned up.[9] In addition to waste and corruption, lawmakers' obsession with pork raises a larger concern about the role of Congress. Members of the U.S. Congress—a national legislature that has historically debated war, Americans' rights, and broad economic policy—have become, in the words of Rep. Dan Lungren (R–CA), "mere errand boys for local government and constituents."[10] The American people elected their federal lawmakers to focus on national priorities like recession, job losses, the financial collapse, and the war on terrorism. And yet these lawmakers failed to pass appropriations bills by the start of the fiscal year and instead spent a substantial portion of 2008 securing pork projects such as: * $1,049,000 to combat Mormon Crickets in Utah; * $332,500 to build a school sidewalk in Franklin, Texas; * $225,000 for Everybody Wins!; * $200,000 for a tattoo removal program in Mission Hills, California; * $190,000 for the Buffalo Bill Historical Center in Cody, Wyoming; * $237,500 for theater renovation in Merced, California; and * $75,000 for the Totally Teen Zone in Albany, Georgia. View a list of pork projects in the FY 2009 omnibus. Tending to such matters is why state and local governments exist. Perhaps Congress does not believe that local governments can handle the job; former House Speaker Dennis Hastert (R–IL) endorsed congressional pork by asking rhetorically, "Who knows best where to put a bridge or a highway or a red light in their district?"[11] Not mayors or city councils, apparently. Of course, lawmakers say these projects are vital to "bringing home federal dollars." In reality, many earmarks are carved out of funding streams that were already coming back to state and local governments and local organizations anyway. All of the earmarks taken from the $5 billion Community Development Block Grant program for parks, pools, street signs, and community centers just reduce the pot of money left over to distribute to local governments for the projects they would choose. And by diverting transportation dollars into projects that are often frivolous and having nothing to do with reducing congestion or improving mobility, earmarks starve higher-priorities like road maintenance and construction, which in turn forces Congress to increase spending to replenish that funding. But earmarks generate press releases and campaign contributions for lawmakers who have only tied strings to federal money that was already coming home. Last year, President Bush signed an executive order mandating that federal agencies ignore earmarks that appear in nonbinding conference reports and instead implement only those in the bill text.[12] That executive order currently remains in effect. President Obama, who campaigned on ending politics-as-usual in Washington, could strike a blow to the earmark culture by simply leaving this executive order in place. Doing so would eliminate all earmarks that Congress has not incorporated by reference into the omnibus bill text. He should go one step further and veto any omnibus bill that explicitly has earmarks. No End in Sight In the past six months, Congress has enacted a $700 billion financial bailout and a $1.1 trillion stimulus. It has also expanded health insurance subsidies and is considering an expensive homeowner bailout. Now, with an 8 percent discretionary spending hike, Congress has seemingly lost the ability to say "no." Runaway spending and budget deficits threaten to steeply increase interest rates and eventually result in painful tax increases. If Congress cannot even reduce the number of pork projects in this environment, there is little reason to believe it is ready to make the truly difficult choices on large programs like Social Security, Medicare, and Medicaid. If Congress cannot strip the unnecessary earmarks and pare back the spending increase in this omnibus bill, the President should show the nation he is well prepared to use his veto pen. ENDNOTES: [1] Omnibus Appropriations Act of 2009, H.R. 1105, 111th Cong., 1st Sess. [2] Based on data provided by the House Appropriations Committee, Minority Staff. [3] Brian M. Riedl, "Federal Spending by the Numbers: 2008," Heritage Foundation WebMemo No. 1829, February 25, 2008, at http://www.heritage.org/Research/Taxes/wm1829.cfm. [4] Ibid. [5] Earlier FY 2009 earmark totals are listed at CR + Minibus + Supplemental Spending, Budget Committee, U.S. House of Representatives, 111th Cong., 1st Sess., September 24, 2008, at http://www.house.gov/budget_ republicans/press/2007/pr20080924minibus.pdf (March 2, 2009). [6] Omnibus earmark totals calculated by The Heritage Foundation using Congressional data. [7] See Citizens Against Government Waste, "Pork-Barrel Report," at http://www.cagw.org/site/PageServer?pagename=reports_porkbarrelreport (March 2, 2009). Only in FY 2005 did the number and (inflation-adjusted) cost of earmarks exceed this year's total. [8] Robert O'Harrow, Jr., "Earmark Spending Makes a Comeback," The Washington Post, June 13, 2008 at http://www.washingtonpost.com/wpdyn/content/article/2008/06/12/AR2008061204282_pf.html (March 2, 2009). [9] By a 71–29 vote, the Senate rejected a temporary earmark moratorium on March 13, 2008. See U.S. Senate, "U.S. Senate Roll Call Votes 110th Congress: 2nd Session," at http://www.senate.gov/legislative/LIS/roll_c all_lists/roll_call_vote_cfm.cfm?congress=110&session=2&vote=00075 (March 2, 2009). [10] John Fund, "Time for a Time-Out?" OpinionJournal.com, September 18, 2006, at http://www.opinionjournal.com/diary/?id=110008960 (March 2, 2009). [11] Robert Novak, "Looking to Fry Pork," The Washington Post, January 30, 2006, p. A17. [12] Executive Order No. 13457, January 29, 2008. Gerrymandering The term gerrymandering is derived from Elbridge Gerry (1744-1814), the governor of Massachusetts from 1810 to 1812. In 1812, Governor Gerry signed a bill into law that redistricted his state to overwhelmingly benefit his party, the Republican Party. The opposition party, the Federalists, were quite upset. Governor Gerry went on to become vice president under James Madison from 1813 until his death a year later. Gerry was the second vice president to die in office. One of the congressional districts was shaped very strangely and, as the story goes, one Federalist remarked that the district looked like a salamander. No, said another Federalist, it’s a gerrymander. The Boston Weekly Messenger brought the term gerrymander into common usage when it subsequently printed an editorial cartoon that showed the district in question with a monster’s head, arms, and tail and named the creature a gerrymander. Gerrymandering Examples The unusual earmuff shape of Illinois's 4th congressional district connects two Hispanic neighborhoods while remaining connected by narrowly tracing Interstate 294. A similar district is New York's 28th congressional district which connects the heavily Democratic cities of Rochester and Buffalo with a narrow strip of territory hugging the Lake Ontario and Niagara River coastlines to connect them. Arizona's 2nd congressional district contains the northwestern corner of the state, and some of the western suburbs of Phoenix. The odd shape of the district is indicative of the use of gerrymandering in its construction. The unusual division was not, however, drawn to favor politicians. Owing to historic tensions between the Hopi and the Navajo, and since tribal boundary disputes are a Federal matter, it was thought inappropriate that both tribes should be represented by the same U.S. House of Representatives member. Since the Hopi reservation is completely surrounded by the Navajo reservation, and in order to comply with current Arizona redistricting laws, some means of connection was required that avoided including large portions of Navajo land, hence the narrow riverine connection. List of faithless electors The following is a list of all faithless electors (most recent first). The number preceding each entry is the number of faithless electors for the given year. (1) 2004 election: A Minnesota elector, pledged for Democrats John Kerry and John Edwards, cast his or her presidential vote for John Ewards (sic), apparently accidentally. (All of Minnesota's electors cast their vice presidential ballots for John Edwards.) Minnesota's electors cast secret ballots, so unless one of the electors claims responsibility, it is unlikely that the identity of the faithless elector will ever be known. As a result of this incident, Minnesota Statutes were amended to provide for public balloting of the electors' votes and invalidation of a vote cast for someone other than the candidate pledged for by the elector. (1) 2000 election: D.C. Elector Barbara Lett-Simmons, pledged for Democrats Al Gore and Joe Lieberman, cast no electoral votes as a protest of Washington D.C.'s lack of statehood, which she described as the federal district's "colonial status". (1) 1988 election: West Virginia Elector Margaret Leach, pledged for Democrats Michael Dukakis and Lloyd Bentsen, instead of casting her votes for the candidates in their positions on the national ticket, cast her presidential vote for Bentsen and her vice presidential vote for Dukakis. (-) 1984 election: In Illinois, the electors, pledged to Ronald Reagan and George H. W. Bush, conducted their vote in a secret ballot. When the electors voted for Vice President, one of the votes was for Geraldine Ferraro, the Democratic nominee. After several minutes of confusion, a second ballot was taken. Bush won unanimously in this ballot, and it was this ballot that was reported to Congress. (1) 1976 election: Washington Elector Mike Padden, pledged for Republican Gerald Ford and Bob Dole, cast his presidential electoral vote for Ronald Reagan, who had challenged Ford for the Republican nomination. He cast his vice presidential vote, as pledged, for Dole. (1) 1972 election: Virginia Elector Roger MacBride, pledged for Republicans Richard Nixon and Spiro Agnew, cast his electoral votes for Libertarian candidates John Hospers and Theodora Nathan. MacBride's vote for Nathan was the first electoral vote cast for a woman in U.S. history. MacBride became the Libertarian candidate for President in the 1976 election. (1) 1968 election: North Carolina Elector Lloyd W. Bailey, pledged for Republicans Richard Nixon and Spiro Agnew, cast his votes for American Independent Party candidates George Wallace and Curtis LeMay (1) 1960 election: Oklahoma Elector Henry D. Irwin, pledged for Republicans Richard Nixon and Henry Cabot Lodge, Jr., cast his presidential electoral vote for independent candidate Harry Flood Byrd. Unlike other electors who voted for Byrd for president, Irwin cast his vice presidential electoral vote for Barry Goldwater. (1) 1956 election: Alabama Elector W. F. Turner, pledged for Democrats Adlai Stevenson and Estes Kefauver, cast his votes for Walter Burgwyn Jones and Herman Talmadge. (1) 1948 election: Two Tennessee electors were on both the Democratic Party and the States' Rights Democratic Party slates. When the Democratic Party slate won, one of these electors voted for the Democratic nominees Harry Truman and Alben Barkley. The other, Preston Parks, cast his votes for States' Rights Democratic Party candidates Strom Thurmond and Fielding Wright, making him a faithless elector. (8) 1912 election: Republican vice presidential candidate James S. Sherman died before the election. Eight Republican electors had pledged their votes to him but voted for Nicholas Murray Butler instead. (4) 1896 election: The Democratic Party and the People’s Party both ran William Jennings Bryan as their presidential candidate, but ran different candidates for Vice President. The Democratic Party nominated Arthur Sewall and the People’s Party nominated Thomas Watson. The People’s Party won 31 electoral votes but four of those electors voted with the Democratic ticket, supporting Bryan as President and Sewall as Vice President. (63) 1872 election: 63 electors for Horace Greeley changed their votes after Greeley's death. Greeley's remaining three electors cast their presidential votes for Greeley and had their votes discounted by Congress. (23) 1836 election: The Democratic Party nominated Richard M. Johnson of Kentucky as their vice presidential candidate. The 23 electors from Virginia refused to support Johnson with their votes upon learning of the allegation that he had lived with an African-American woman. There was no majority in the Electoral College and the decision was deferred to the Senate, which supported Johnson as the Vice President. (32) 1832 election: Two National Republican Party electors from the state of Maryland refused to vote for presidential candidate Henry Clay and did not cast a vote for him or for his running mate. All 30 electors from Pennsylvania refused to support the Democratic vice presidential candidate Martin Van Buren, voting instead for William Wilkins. (7) 1828 election: Seven (of nine) electors from Georgia refused to vote for vice presidential candidate John Calhoun. All seven cast their vice presidential votes for William Smith instead. (1) 1820 election: William Plumer pledged to vote for Democratic Republican candidate James Monroe, but he cast his vote for John Quincy Adams who was also a Democratic Republican, but was not a candidate in the 1820 election. Some historians contend that Plumer did not feel that the Electoral College should unanimously elect any President other than George Washington, but this claim is disputed. (Monroe lost another three votes because three electors died before casting ballots and were not replaced.) (4) 1812 election: Three electors pledged to vote for Federalist vice presidential candidate Jared Ingersoll voted for Democratic Republican Elbridge Gerry. One Ohio elector did not vote. (6) 1808 election: Six electors from New York were pledged to vote for Democratic Republican James Madison as President and George Clinton as Vice President. Instead, they voted for Clinton to be President, with three voting for Madison as Vice President and the other three voting for James Monroe to be Vice President. (1) 1796 election: Samuel Miles, an elector from Pennsylvania, was pledged to vote for Federalist presidential candidate John Adams, but voted for Democratic Republican candidate Thomas Jefferson. He cast his other presidential vote as pledged for Thomas Pinckney. (This election took place prior to the passage of the 12th Amendment, so there were not separate ballots for president and vice president.) Unit V- Branches of GovernmentPart B - The Presidency and the Bureaucracy “The nine most terrifying words in the English language are: “I’m from the government and I’m here to help.” Ronald Reagan Assignments Chapter 12 and 13 Study Guides Checks that Weaken the Presidency (ws) Congress v. The President: Who Has More Power (ws) Federal Government Leaders Chart (ws) Assessments Unit Exam- Chapter 12 and 13- Multiple Choice and Two FRQs Secondary Readings Neustadt- Presidential Power and the Modern PresidentPresidential Power Questions Weber- Bureaucracy Chapter 12 Study Questions The Presidency 1. List the differences between a president and a prime minister. 2. What does it mean to have a divided or a unified government? Why do we still have gridlock, even with a unified government? 3. What are the arguments for why we have gridlock? 4. How does the difference between representative and direct democracy explain gridlock? 5. What concerns did the Founders have about the idea of having of president? How did the creation of the Electoral College allay those fears? 6. You don’t need to know the details of presidencies before FDR, but the historical trends are important. The book talks about our modern concept of the presidency. When did that really begin and what counter-evidence is there to that concept? 7. Learn the list of presidential powers. You should know all of them. Pay attention to which powers the Presidents shares with the Senate or Congress as a whole or has sole power. 8. What are the three structures for a president to organize his staff? What are the advantages and disadvantages of each? 9. Explain how much influence the president has over his cabinet officials and agency heads. 10. Why is there a tension between the White House staff and cabinet secretaries? 11. Explain the differences in the three audiences that the president speaks to. Think about how Presidents Clinton and Bush have managed to address these three audiences. 12. Explain the reasons why the president’s popularity does and does not have an effect on getting congressional support for his programs. 13. Give details about the following terms: veto message, pocket veto, line-item veto, and executive privilege, and impoundment of funds 14. What are the four groups that the book talks about who have input on a president’s program? Be familiar with the strengths and weaknesses 15. What are the three constraints on the president’s ability to plan a program? 16. What is the role of political polls in decision-making? What are the two models the book describes for using polls? 17. What is the present line of succession if the president should die in office? 18. Summarize the conclusion the text makes about the power of the president and the federal government. Ad hoc structure Cabinet Circular structure Delegate model Direct democracy Divided government Impeachment Lame duck Legislative veto Terms to Know Line item veto Perks Pocket veto Pyramid structure Representative democracy Trustee approach Unified government Veto message December 20, 2005 RICHARD NEUSTADT Presidential Power and the Modern President From this often-read book comes the classic concept of presidential power as "the power to persuade. " Richard Neustadt observed the essence of presidential power when working in the executive branch during Franklin Roosevelt's term as president. He stayed to serve under President Truman. It is said that President Kennedy brought Presidential Power with him to the White House, and Neustadt worked briefly for JFK. The first half of the excerpt, in which he shows how presidents' well-developed personal characteristics permit successful persuasive abilities, comes from the book's first edition. The excerpt's closing pages reflect Neustadt's recent musings on the nation, on world affairs, and on the challenges presidents face. IN THE EARLY summer of 1952, before the heat of the campaign, President [Harry] Truman used to contemplate the problems of the general-become-President should [Dwight David] Eisenhower win the forthcoming election. "He'll sit here," Truman would remark (tapping his desk for emphasis), "and he'll say, 'Do this! Do that!' And nothing will happen. Poor Ike-it won't be a bit like the Army. He'll find it very frustrating." Eisenhower evidently found it so. "In the face of the continuing dissidence and disunity, the President sometimes simply exploded with exasperation," wrote Robert Donovan in comment on the early months of Eisenhower's first term. "What was the use, he demanded to know, of his trying to lead the Republican Party. ..... And this reaction was not limited to early months alone, or to his party only. "The President still feels," an Eisenhower aide remarked to me in 1958, "that when he's decided something, that ought to be the end of it ... and when it bounces back undone or done wrong, he tends to react with shocked surprise." Truman knew whereof he spoke. With "resignation" in the place of "shocked surprise," the aide's description would have fitted Truman. The former senator may have been less shocked than the former general, but he was no less subjected to that painful and repetitive experience: "Do this, do that, and nothing will happen." Long before he came to talk of Eisenhower he had put his own experience in other words: "I sit here all day trying to persuade people to do the things they ought to have sense enough to do without my persuading them.... That's all the powers of the President amount to." In these words of a President, spoken on the job, one finds the essence of the problem now before us: "powers" are no guarantee of power; clerkship is no guarantee of leadership. The President of the United States has an extraordinary range of formal powers, of authority in statute law and in the Constitution. Here is testimony that despite his "powers" he does not obtain results by giving orders-or not, at any rate, merely by giving orders. He also has extraordinary status, ex officio, according to the customs of our government and politics. Here is testimony that despite his status he does not get action without argument. Presidential power is the power to persuade.... The limits on command suggest the structure of our government. The Constitutional Convention of 1787 is supposed to have created a government of "separated powers." It did nothing of the sort. Rather, it created a government of separated institutions sharing powers. "I am part of the legislative process," Eisenhower often said in 1959 as a reminder of his veto. Congress, the dispenser of authority and funds, is no less part of the administrative process. Federalism adds another set of separated institutions. The Bill of Rights adds others. Many public purposes can only be achieved by voluntary acts of private institutions; the press, for one, in Douglass Cater's phrase, is a "fourth branch of government." And with the coming of alliances abroad, the separate institutions of a London, or a Bonn, share in the making of American public policy. What the Constitution separates our political parties do not combine. The parties are themselves composed of separated organizations sharing public authority. The authority consists of nominating powers. Our national parties are confederations of state and local party institutions, with a headquarters that represents the White House, more or less, if the party has a President in office. These confederacies manage presidential nominations. All other public offices depend upon electorates confined within the states. All other nominations are controlled within the states. The President and congressmen who bear one party's label are divided by dependence upon different sets of voters. The differences are sharpest at the stage of nomination. The White House has too small a share in nominating congressmen, and Congress has too little weight in nominating presidents for party to erase their constitutional separation. Party links are stronger than is frequently supposed, but nominating processes assure the separation. The separateness of institutions and the sharing of authority prescribe the terms on which a President persuades. When one man shares authority with another, but does not gain or lose his job upon the other's whim, his willingness to act upon the urging of the other turns on whether he conceives the action right for him. The essence of a President's persuasive task is to convince such men that what the White House wants of them is what they ought to do for their sake and on their authority. (Sex matters not at all; for man read woman.) Persuasive power, thus defined, amounts to more than charm or reasoned argument. These have their uses for a President, but these are not the whole of his resources. For the individuals he would induce to do what he wants done on their own responsibility will need or fear some acts by him on his responsibility. If they share his authority, he has some share in theirs. Presidential "powers" may be inconclusive when a President commands, but always remain relevant as he persuades. The status and authority inherent in his office reinforce his logic and his charm.... A President's authority and status give him great advantages in dealing with the men he would persuade. Each "power" is a vantage point for him in the degree that other men have use for his authority. From the veto to appointments, from publicity to budgeting, and so down a long list, the White House now controls the most encompassing array of vantage points in the American political system. With hardly an exception, those who share in governing this country are aware that at some time, in some degree, the doing of their jobs, the furthering of their ambitions, may depend upon the President of the United States. Their need for presidential action, or their fear of it, is bound to be recurrent if not actually continuous. Their need or fear is his advantage. A President's advantages are greater than mere listing of his "powers" might suggest. Those with whom he deals must deal with him until the last day of his term. Because they have continuing relationships with him, his future, while it lasts, supports his present influence. Even though there is no need or fear of him today, what he could do tomorrow may supply today's advantage. Continuing relationships may convert any "power,' any aspect of his status, into vantage points in almost any case. When he induces other people to do what he wants done, a President can trade on their dependence now and later. The President's advantages are checked by the advantages of others. Continuing relationships will pull in both directions. These are relationships of mutual dependence. A President depends upon the persons whom he would persuade; he has to reckon with his need or fear of them. They too will possess status, or authority, or both, else they would be of little use to him. Their vantage points confront his own; their power tempers his.... The power to persuade is the power to bargain. Status and authority yield bargaining advantages. But in a government of "separated institutions sharing powers," they yield them to all sides. With the array of vantage points at his disposal, a President may be far more persuasive than his logic or his charm could make him. But outcomes are not guaranteed by his advantages. There remain the counter pressures those whom he would influence can bring to bear on him from vantage points at their disposal. Command has limited utility; persuasion becomes give-and-take. It is well that the White House holds the vantage points it does. In such a business any President may need them all-and more.... When a President confronts divergent policy advisers, disputing experts, conflicting data, and uncertain outlooks, yet must choose, there plainly are some other things he can do for himself besides consulting his own power stakes. But there is a proviso-provided he has done that first and keeps clear in his mind how much his prospects may depend on his authority, how much on reputation, how much on public standing. In the world Reagan inhabited where reputation and prestige are far more intertwined than they had been in Truman's time, or even LBJ's, this proviso is no easy test of presidential expertise. It calls for a good ear and a fine eye.... But when a President turns to others, regardless of the mode, he is dependent on their knowledge, judgment, and good will. If he turns essentially to one, alone, he puts a heavy burden on that other's knowledge. If he chooses not to read or hear details, he puts an even greater burden on the other's judgment. If he consents, besides, to secrecy from everyone whose task in life is to protect his flanks, he courts deep trouble. Good will should not be stretched beyond endurance. In a system characterized by separated institutions sharing powers, where presidential interests will diverge in some degree from those of almost everybody else, that suggests not stretching very far.... Personally, I prefer Presidents ... more skeptical than trustful, more curious than committed, more nearly Roosevelts than Reagans. I think the former energize our governmental system better and bring out its defects less than do the latter. Reagan's years did not persuade me otherwise, in spite of his appeal on other scores. Every scandal in his wake, for instance, must owe something to the narrow range of his convictions and the breadth of his incuriosity, along with all that trust. A President cannot abolish bad behavior, but he sets a tone, and if he is alert to possibilities he can set traps, and with them limits. Reagan's tone, apparently, was heard by all too many as "enrich yourselves," while those few traps deregulation spared appear to have been sprung and left unbaited for the most part. But this book has not been written to expound my personal preferences. Rather it endeavors to expose the problem for a President of either sort who seeks to buttress prospects for his future influence while making present choices-"looking toward tomorrow from today," as I wrote at the start. For me that remains a crucial enterprise. It is not, of course, the only thing a President should put his mind to, but it is the subject to which I have put my own throughout this book. It remains crucial, in my view, not simply for the purposes of Presidents, but also for the products of the system, whether effective policy, or flawed or none. Thus it becomes crucial for us all. We now stand on the threshold of a time institutions, Congress and the President, share in which those separated powers fully and uncomfortably across the board of policy, both foreign and domestic. From the 1940s through the 1960s-"midcentury" in this book's terms--Congress, having been embarrassed at Pearl Harbor by the isolationism it displayed beforehand, gave successive Presidents more scope in defense budgeting and in the conduct of diplomacy toward Europe and Japan than was the norm between the two world wars. Once the Cold War had gotten under way, and then been largely militarized after Korea, that scope widened. With the onset of the missile age it deepened. Should nuclear war impend, the President became the system's final arbiter. Thus I characterized JFK against the background of the Cuban missile crisis. But by 1975 the denouement of Watergate and that of Vietnam, eight months apart, had put a period to what remained of congressional reticence left over from Pearl Harbor. And the closing of the Cold War, now in sight though by no means achieved, promises an end to nuclear danger as between the Soviet Union and the United States. Threats of nuclear attack could well remain, from Third World dictators or terrorists, but not destruction of the Northern Hemisphere. So in the realm of military preparationseven, indeed, covert actions-the congressional role waxes as the Cold War wanes, returning toward normality as understood in Franklin Roosevelt's first two terms. In a multipolar world, crisscrossed by transnational relations, with economic and environmental issues paramount, and issues of security reshaped on regional lines, our Presidents will less and less have reason to seek solace in foreign relations from the piled-up frustrations of home affairs. Their foreign frustrations will be piled high too. Since FDR in wartime, every President including Bush has found the role of superpower sovereign beguiling: personal responsibility at once direct and high, issues at once gripping and arcane, opposite numbers frequently intriguing and wellmannered, acclaim by foreign audiences echoing well at home, foreign travel relatively glamorous, compared with home, interest groups less clamorous, excepting special cases, authority always stronger, Congress often tamer. But the distinctions lessencompare Bush's time with Nixon's to say nothing of Eisenhower's-and we should expect that they will lessen further. Telecommunications, trade, aid, banking and stock markets combined with AIDS and birth control and hunger, topped off by toxic waste and global warming-these are not the stuff of which the Congress of Vienna* was made, much less the summits of yore. Moreover, Europeans ten years hence, as well as Japanese, may not resemble much the relatively acquiescent "middle powers" we grew used to in the 1960s and 1970s. Cooperating with them may come to seem to Presidents no easier than cooperating with Congress. Our friends abroad will see it quite the other way around: How are they to cooperate with our peculiar mix of separated institutions sharing powers? Theirs are ordered governments, ours a rat race. Complaints of us by others in these terms are nothing new. They have been rife throughout this century. But by the next, some of the chief complainants may have fewer needs of us, while ours of them grow relatively greater, than at any other time since World War II. In that case foreign policy could cease to be a source of pleasure for a President. By the same token, he or she would have to do abroad as on the Hill and in Peoria: Check carefully the possible effects of present choices on prospective reputation and prestigethinking of other governments and publics quite as hard as those at home. It is not just our accustomed NATO and Pacific allies who may force the pace here, but the Soviet Union, if it holds together, and potentially great powers-China, India, perhaps Brazil-as well as our neighbors, north and south. From the multicentered, interdependent world now coming into being, environmentally endangered as it is, Presidents may look back on the Cold War as an era of stability, authority, and glamour. They may yearn for the simplicity they see in retrospect, and also for the solace. Too bad. The job of being President is tougher when incumbents have to struggle for effective influence in foreign and domestic spheres at once, with their command of nuclear forces losing immediate relevance, and the American economy shorn of its former clout. There are, however, compensations, one in particular. If we outlive the Cold War,* the personal responsibility attached to nuclear weapons should become less burdensome for Presidents themselves, while contemplation of their mere humanity becomes less haunting for the rest of us. To me that seems a fair exchange. *After the 1814 defeat of the French leader Napoleon by Russia, Prussia, Austria, and Britain, these great powers met in Vienna, Austria, to ensure that the future of Europe would be peaceful. At the Congress of Vienna, they created a "balance of power" system so that no single European nation could dominate the continent.-Ens. *The Cold War refers to the hostility that existed between the United States and the Soviet Union from the end of World War 11 until recent times. The Cold War involved many forms of hostility: democracy versus communism; America's NATO allies versus the Soviet Union's Warsaw Pact military partners; the threat of nuclear war; economic competition; the dividing of Third World nations into pro-U.S. and pro-Soviet camps. With the demise of communism in Eastern Europe and the disintegration of the Soviet Union, the Cold War era has ended.-Em. From Alpha.Fdu.Edu online at http://alpha.fdu.edu/~peabody/neustadt.html. Presidential Power and the Modern President Richard Neustadt 1. To what degree do you agree with the following statement: “’powers’ are no guarantee of power; clerkship is no guarantee of leadership?” Give two examples of your own. 2. What is Neustadt’s take on the concept of separation of powers? Do you agree with him? What evidence does he give? 3. Distinguish between “command” and “persuade.” How does this related to presidential power? 4. How does the following passage relate to Federalist 10? The President's advantages are checked by the advantages of others. Continuing relationships will pull in both directions. These are relationships of mutual dependence. A President depends upon the persons whom he would persuade; he has to reckon with his need or fear of them. They too will possess status, or authority, or both, else they would be of little use to him. Their vantage points confront his own; their power tempers his.... 5. Assess Neustadt’s conclusions on nuclear proliferation. Do you agree with him? Explain. Chapter 13 Study Questions The Bureaucracy 1. What makes American bureaucracy distinctive? 2. What controls does Congress have over the bureaucracy? 3. What concerns does the president have in choosing whom to appoint? How have these concerns changed since the 19th century? 4. How and why has the role of bureaucratic agencies changed since the Civil War? 5. How does the manner in which officials are recruited and rewarded explain their behavior? 6. How do the personal attributes and political attitudes affect their behavior? 7. How can bureaucrats sabotage their political bosses? 8. What are the constraints on what an agency can do? Why do we have such constraints and what effect do these constraints have on agency behavior? 9. Explain what iron triangles are and why they are less common today. 10. How does Congress exercise supervision over the bureaucracy? Explain all the different methods of oversight. 11. What are the five bureaucratic pathologies that the book identifies? Explain why each exists. Why is it so difficult to reform the bureaucracy? Representative democracy Direct democracy Electoral college Faithless electors Pyramid structure Circular structure Terms to Know United States v. Nixon (1973) Congressional Budget and Impoundment Act (1974) Impoundment War Powers Act (1973) Trustee approach and Delegate model Independent Counsel law Lame duck Presidential Succession Act of 1947 Ad hoc structure Cabinet 12th Amendment 22nd Amendment Divided government Unified Government Executive Office of the President 25th Amendment Office of Management and Budget Impeachment (OMB) National Security Council (NSC) Bully Pulpit Council of Economic Advisers (CEA) Inherent power Executive Agencies Executive orders Independent Agencies Approval ratings Acting appointments Imperial presidency Presidential honeymoon Rule of propinquity Veto message and pocket veto bureaucracy Line-item veto patronage Clinton v. New York City (1998) spoils system Executive privilege Pendleton Act (1883) Laissez-faire economics 16th Amendment Discretionary authority Competitive service Office of Personnel Management Excepted service Merit system Civil Service Reform Act of 1978 Hatch Act (1933 and 1993) Whistle Blower Protection Act (1989) Issues network Authorization legislation Appropriations Committee clearance Legislative veto INS v. Chadha 1983) Red tape National Performance Review Going native Freedom of Information Act (1966) National Environmental Policy Act (1969) Max Weber: Bureaucracy (1922) Any discussion about bureaucracy-in the United States or anywhere else-must begin with Max Weber, who is best known for his work laying the intellectual foundation for the study of modern sociology. Weber wrote extensively on modern social and political organization; his works include the unfinished Wirtschaft und Gesellschaft (Economy and Society) (1922) and the influential The Protestant Ethic and the Spirit of Capitalism (1904-1905). His observations on bureaucracy were heavily informed by his experiences in the United States. While traveling in the New World, Weber was struck by the role of bureaucracy in a democratic society. The problem, as he saw it, was that a modern democracy required bureaucratic structures of all kinds in the administration of government and even in the conduct of professional party politics. Handing over the reins to a class of unelected "experts," however, threatened to undermine the very basis of democracy itself. In particular, Weber stressed two problems: the unaccountability of unelected civil servants and the bureaucratic tendency toward inflexibility in the application of rules. In this brief selection, Weber describes the essential nature of bureaucracy. I: Characteristics of Bureaucracy Modern officialdom functions in the following specific manner: I. There is the principle of fixed and official jurisdictional areas, which are generally ordered by rules, that is, by laws or administrative regulations. 1. The regular activities required for the purposes of the bureaucratically governed structure are distributed in a fixed way as official duties. 2. The authority to give the commands required for the discharge of these duties is distributed in a stable way and is strictly delimited by rules concerning the coercive means, physical, sacerdotal, or otherwise, which may be placed at the disposal of officials. 3. Methodical provision is made for the regular and continuous fulfillment of these duties and for the execution of the corresponding rights; only persons who have the generally regulated qualifications to serve are employed. In public and lawful government these three elements constitute "bureaucratic authority." In private economic domination, they constitute bureaucratic "management." Bureaucracy, thus understood, is fully developed in political and ecclesiastical communities only in the modern state, and, in the private economy, only in the most advanced institutions of capitalism. Permanent and public office authority, with fixed jurisdiction, is not the historical rule but rather the exception. This is so even in large political structures such as those of the ancient Orient, the Germanic and Mongolian empires of conquest, or of many feudal structures of state. In all these cases, the ruler executes the most important measures through personal trustees, table-companions, or court-servants. Their commissions and authority are not precisely delimited and are temporarily called into being for each case. II. The principles of office hierarchy and of levels of graded authority mean a firmly ordered system of superand subordination in which there is a supervision of the lower offices by the higher ones. Such a system offers the governed the possibility of appealing the decision of a lower office to its higher authority, in a definitely regulated manner. With the full development of the bureaucratic type, the office hierarchy is monocratically organized. The principle of hierarchical office authority is found in all bureaucratic structures: in state and ecclesiastical structures as well as in large party organizations and private enterprises. It does not matter for the character of bureaucracy whether its authority is called "private" or "public." When the principle of jurisdictional "competency" is fully carried through, hierarchical subordination-at least in public office-does not mean that the "higher" authority is simply authorized to take over the business of the "lower." Indeed, the opposite is the rule. Once established and having fulfilled its task, an office tends to continue in existence and be held by another incumbent. III. The management of the modem office is based upon written documents ("the files"), which are preserved in their original or draught form. There is, therefore, a staff of subaltern officials and scribes of all sorts. The body of officials actively engaged in a "public" office, along with the respective apparatus of material implements and the files, make up a "bureau." In private enterprise, "the bureau" is often called "the office." In principle, the modern organization of the civil service separates the bureau from the private domicile of the official, and, in general, bureaucracy segregates official activity as something distinct from the sphere of private life. Public monies and equipment are divorced from the private property of the official. This condition is everywhere the product of a long development. Nowadays, it is found in public as well as in private enterprises; in the latter, the principle extends even to the leading entrepreneur. In principle, the executive office is separated from the household, business from private correspondence, and business assets from private fortunes. The more consistently the modern type of business management has been carried through the more are these separations the case. The beginnings of this process are to be found as early as the Middle Ages. It is the peculiarity of the modem entrepreneur that he conducts himself as the "first official" of his enterprise, in the very same way in which the ruler of a specifically modern bureaucratic state spoke of himself as "the first servant" of the state. The idea that the bureau activities of the state are intrinsically different in character from the management of private economic offices is a continental European notion and, by way of contrast, is totally foreign to the American way. IV. Office management, at least all specialized office management-and such management is distinctly modem-usually presupposes thorough and expert training. This increasingly holds for the modern executive and employee of private enterprises, in the same manner as it holds for the state official. V. When the office is fully developed, official activity demands the full working capacity of the official, irrespective of the fact that his obligatory time in the bureau may be firmly delimited. In the normal case, this is only the product of a long development, in the public as well as in the private office. Formerly, in all cases, the normal state of affairs was reversed: official business was discharged as a secondary activity. VI. The management of the office follows general rules, which are more or less stable, more or less exhaustive, and which can be learned. Knowledge of these rules represents a special technical learning which the officials possess. It involves jurisprudence, or administrative or business management. The reduction of modem office management to rules is deeply embedded in its very nature. The theory of modem public administration, for instance, assumes that the authority to order certain matters by decreewhich has been legally granted to public authorities-does not entitle the bureau to regulate the matter by commands given for each case, but only to regulate the matter abstractly. This stands in extreme contrast to the regulation of all relationships through individual privileges and bestowals of favor, which is absolutely dominant in patrimonialism, at least in so far as such relationships are not fixed by sacred tradition.... Technical Advantages of Bureaucratic Organization The decisive reason for the advance of bureaucratic organization has always been its purely technical superiority over any other form of organization. The fully developed bureaucratic mechanism compares with other organizations exactly as does the machine with the nonmechanical modes of production. Precision, speed, unambiguity, knowledge of the files, continuity, discretion, unity, strict subordination, reduction of friction and of material and personal costs-these are raised to the optimum point in the strictly bureaucratic administration, and especially in its monocratic form. As compared with all collegiate, honorific, and avocational forms of administration, trained bureaucracy is superior on all these points. And as far as complicated tasks are concerned, paid bureaucratic work is not only more precise but, in the last analysis, it is often cheaper than even formally unremunerated honorific service. Honorific arrangements make administrative work an avocation and, for this reason alone, honorific service normally functions more slowly; being less bound to schemata and being more formless. Hence it is less precise and less unified than bureaucratic work because it is less dependent upon superiors and because the establishment and exploitation of the apparatus of subordinate officials and filing services are almost unavoidably less economical. Honorific service is less continuous than bureaucratic and frequently quite expensive. This is especially the case if one thinks not only of the money costs to the public treasury-costs which bureaucratic administration, in comparison with administration by notables, usually substantially increases-but also of the frequent economic losses of the governed caused by delays and lack of precision. The possibility of administration by notables normally and permanently exists only where official management can be satisfactorily discharged as an avocation. With the qualitative increase of tasks the administration has to face, administration by notables reaches its limits-today, even in England. Work organized by collegiate bodies causes friction and delay and requires compromises between colliding interests and views. The administration, therefore, runs less precisely and is more independent of superiors; hence, it is less unified and slower. All advances of the Prussian administrative organization have been and will in the future be advances of the bureaucratic, and especially of the monocratic, principle. Today, it is primarily the capitalist market economy which demands that the official business of the administration be discharged precisely, unambiguously, continuously, and with as much speed as possible. Normally, the very large, modem capitalist enterprises are themselves unequalled models of strict bureaucratic organization. Business management throughout rests on increasing precision, steadiness, and, above all, the speed of operations. This, in turn, is determined by the peculiar nature of the modern means of communication, including, among ~other things, the news service of the press. The extraordinary increase in the speed by which public announcements, as well as economic and political facts, are transmitted exerts a steady and sharp pressure in the direction of speeding up the tempo of administrative reaction towards various situations. The optimum of such reaction time is normally attained only by a strictly bureaucratic organization. Bureaucratization offers above all the optimum possibility for carrying through the principle of specializing administrative functions according to purely objective considerations. Individual performances are allocated to functionaries who have specialized training and who by constant practice learn more and more. The "objective" discharge of business primarily means a discharge of business according to calculable rules and "without regard for persons. "Without regard for persons" is also the watchword of the "market" and, in general, of all pursuits of naked economic interests. A consistent execution of bureaucratic domination means the leveling of status "honor." Hence, if the principle of the free-market is not at the same time restricted, it means the universal domination of the class situation." That this consequence of bureaucratic domination has not set in everywhere, parallel to the extent of bureaucratization, is due to the differences among possible principles by which polities may meet their demands. The second element mentioned, "calculable rules," also is of paramount importance for modern bureaucracy. The peculiarity of modern culture, and specifically of its technical and economic basis, demands this very "calculability" of results. … [The] specific nature [of bureaucracy], which is welcomed by capitalism, develops the more perfectly the more the bureaucracy is "dehumanized," the more completely it succeeds in eliminating from official business love, hatred, and all purely -personal, irrational, and emotional elements which escape calculation. This is the specific nature of bureaucracy and it is appraised as its special virtue. The more complicated and specialized modern culture becomes, the more its external supporting apparatus demands the personally detached and strictly "objective" expert, in lieu of the master of older social structures, who was moved by personal sympathy and favor, by grace and gratitude. Bureaucracy offers the attitudes demanded by the external apparatus of modern culture in the most favorable combination. As a rule, only bureaucracy has established the foundation for the administration of a rational law conceptually systematized on the basis of such enactments as the latter Roman imperial period first created with a high degree of -technical perfection. During the Middle Ages, this law was received along with the bureaucratization of legal administration, that is to say, with the displacement I of the old trial procedure which was bound to tradition or to irrational presuppositions, by the rationally trained and specialized expert. Questions to think about 1. What are the characteristics of the bureaucratic form of governmental power? What are bureaucracy's strong points? weak points? 2. Why are the rules so important in a bureaucracy? What are the advantages and disadvantages of making decisions on the basis of general rules, rather than on a case-by-case basis? Unit V- Branches of GovernmentPart C -The Judiciary All the rights secured to the citizens under the Constitution are worth nothing, and a mere bubble, except guaranteed to them by an independent and virtuous Judiciary. Andrew Jackson Assignments Chapter 14 Study Guide Supreme Court Writing Assignment Assessments Unit V Exam- Multiple Choice Secondary Readings Scalia- Liberty and Abortion; A Strict Constructionist’s View” Chapter 14 The Judiciary 6. Define judicial review. Make sure you memorize the case, Marbury v. Madison 7. Summarize the two approaches to using the Constitution to decide cases. 8. The book discusses three main stages in the evolution of today’s Supreme Court. Give brief generalizations that summarize the main issues of each of these three stages. 9. Define: district court, courts of appeals, senatorial courtesy, blue slips, and litmus tests. Explain why litmus tests have grown in importance. 10. List and understand the ten reasons why David Yalof says that the modern selection process for justices has changed. 11. What does it mean to say that our system is a dual court system? Explain how our dual court system works. 12. Find a way to commit to memory the path that a case takes to get to the Supreme Court. 13. Summarize rules governing standing. 14. Explain what a class action suit is. What are the pros and cons of having class action suits? 15. Define brief, amicus curiae, Solicitor General, per curiam opinion, opinion of the Court, concurring opinion, dissenting opinion. 16. The book discuses four indicators of how courts have become more powerful. Explain what these four measures are. 17. What arguments does the book present in favor of and against judicial activism? 18. What explanations does the book give for why we have activist courts? 19. List and explain the checks on judicial power from both the other branches of government and public opinion. 20. According to Scalia, what issues would a strict constitutional constructionist have with the current Roe v. Wade debate? Terms to Know Amicus curiae Antonin Scalia In forma pauperis John Marshall Appellate jurisdiction Blue Slips Judicial activist Judicial review Law clerks Briefs Burger Court Civil law Clarence Thomas Class action suit Legislative courts Litmus test Marbury v. Madison (1803) McCulloch v. Maryland (1819) Concurrent jurisdiction Opinion of the Court Concurring opinion Original jurisdiction per curiam opinion Plaintiff Political question Constitutional court Courts of Appeals Court order Court packing plan Criminal law David Souter Defendant Rehnquist Court Remedy Robert Bork Roger B. Taney Dissenting opinion Ruth Bader Ginsburg District court Dred Scott v. Sanford (1857) Senatorial courtesy Dual Court System Dual sovereignty Exclusive jurisdiction Federalist No. 78 Federal-question cases Fee shifting Gang of 14 Gibbons v. Ogden (1824) Impeachment Solicitor General Sonia Sotomayor Sovereign immunity Standing Stare decisis Strict constructionist Warren Court William Rehnquist Writ of certiorari Supreme Court Writing Assignment You must pick your case by although you can do so earlier. Your paper is due on ______________________* For this assignment, you will choose one Supreme Court case from the past fifty years that you think was decided wrongly. (You may not choose Roe v. Wade or Bush v. Gore. They’ve been done way too much!! .) You may also not pick a case that has since been overturned. Your task will be to write a convincing argument to explain why the Supreme Court’s decision was, in your opinion, incorrect. You must base your reasoning on Constitutional arguments, precedents, and history. It is not enough to say that the decision was wrong and unfair. You must demonstrate your grasp of the issues we have discussed throughout the year in your analysis. This is not as intimidating as it may sound. Few decisions are decided unanimously. The justices in the minority have issued dissenting opinions explaining why they think the majority decided the case incorrectly. These dissenting opinions would be a good starting point for your preparation for the essay. You may quote from the dissents (with appropriate citations, of course) but I am not looking for a simple cut and paste job. You have the advantage of hindsight and so know the impact the decision has had on American life and jurisprudence. What problems do we encounter in today’s society because of the way that your case was decided? I encourage you to explore that approach. Here are some sites that might help you find a good case on issues that interest you: http://www.law.umkc.edu/faculty/projects/ftrials/conlaw/home.html (Scroll down for links by topic) http://www.firstamendmentcenter.org/topicssummary.aspx I have also provided several links on the Links page for AP Government under the Constitution and Supreme Court that may help you. You may access all Supreme Court decisions at the Oyez site. http://oyez.nwu.edu/cases/cases.cgi or at Cornell’s site http://supct.law.cornell.edu/supct/ This is what I’m looking for in an ‘A’ paper: You show your understanding of the facts, issues involved in the case, and the factors that went into the decision for each side. You argue that the Supreme Court decided the case incorrectly with an impressive array of Constitutional arguments, discussion of applicable precedents, and an examination of how their decision has had or will have a deleterious effect on the country. You write beautifully with excellent English. You make no ugly grammar, spelling, or punctuation errors. You do not use the first person. Your writing flows from paragraph to paragraph without abrupt transitions that jar the reader’s attention. You cite all quotations and analyses that you borrow. It is not enough to simply cite that which you quoted. If you adapted an argument from some source, you should acknowledge your work’s provenance. To do otherwise is outright theft. You include a bibliography of all sources that you consulted. For citing a SC decision I want to see: Name of the case (in italics), year, and URL. Indicate if the opinion is the main opinion, concurring, or dissenting. Your paper uses a 12 pt. font and is typed and double-spaced. I would predict that your papers would be in the four-to-six-page range. * Papers that do not fully meet these criteria will receive lesser grades. This will count as a test grade. You will lose 10 points per day that your paper is late. If you are going to be absent on the day its due, please find a way to get the paper to me. Try messengers, e-mail, or carrier pigeons. You may receive two points per day that you hand this in early for a maximum of 10 points extra credit. If you’re not going to be here on the due date, you must turn in your paper earlier. You will lose 10 points per day for being late. Liberty and Abortion: A Strict Constructionist's View Justice Antonin Scalia . . . Laws against bigamy. . . which entire societies of reasonable people disagree with-intrude upon men and women's liberty to marry and live with one another. But bigamy happens not to be a liberty specially "protected" by the Constitution. That is, quite simply, the issue in this case: not whether the power of a woman to abort her unborn child is a "liberty" in the absolute sense; or even whether it is a liberty of great importance to many women. Of course it is both. The issue is whether it is a liberty protected by the Constitution of the United States. I am sure it is not. I reach that conclusion not because of anything so exalted as my views concerning the "concept of existence, of meaning, of the universe, and of the mystery of human life." Rather, I reach it for the same reason I reach the conclusion that bigamy is not constitutionally protectedbecause of two simple facts: (1) the Constitution says absolutely nothing about it, and (2) the longstanding traditions of American society have permitted it to be legally proscribed. . . . The emptiness of the "reasoned judgment" that produced Roe is displayed in plain view by the fact that, after more than 19 years of effort by some of the brightest (and most determined) legal minds in the country, after more than 10 cases upholding abortion rights in this Court, and after dozens upon dozens of amicus briefs submitted in this and other cases, the best the Court can do to explain how it is that the word "liberty" must be thought to include the right to destroy human fetuses is to rattle off a collection of adjectives that simply decorate a value judgment and conceal a political choice. The right to abort, we are told, inheres in "liberty" because it is among "a person's most basic decisions," it involves a "most intimate and personal choic[e]," it is "central to personal dignity and autonomy," it "originate[s] within the zone of conscience and belief," it is "too intimate and personal" for state interference, it reflects "intimate views" of a "deep, personal character," it involves "intimate relationships," and notions of "personal autonomy and bodily integrity," and it concerns a particularly "important decision[n]." But it is obvious to anyone applying "reasoned judgment" that the same adjectives can be applied to many forms of conduct that this Court ... has held are not entitled to constitutional protection-because, like abortion, they are forms of conduct that have long been criminalized in American society. Those adjectives might be applied, for example, to homosexual sodomy, polygamy, adult incest, and suicide, all of which are equally "intimate" and "deep[ly] personal" decisions involving "personal autonomy and bodily integrity," and all of which can constitutionally be proscribed because it is our unquestionable constitutional tradition that they are proscribable. It is not reasoned judgment that supports the Court's decision; only personal predilection. . . . [W]hether it would "subvert the Court's legitimacy" or not, the notion that we would decide a case differently from the way we otherwise would have in order to show that we can stand firm against public disapproval is frightening. It is a bad enough idea, even in the head of someone like me, who believes that the text of the Constitution, and our traditions, say what they say and there is no fiddling with them. But when it is in the mind of a Court that believes the Constitution has an evolving meaning; that the Ninth Amendment's reference to "othe[r]" rights is not a disclaimer, but a charter for action; and that the function of this Court is to "speak before all others for constitutional ideals" unrestrained by meaningful text or tradition-then the notion that the Court must adhere to a decision for as long as the decision faces "great opposition" and the Court is "under fire" acquires a character of almost czarist arrogance. We are offended by these marchers who descend upon us, every year on the anniversary of Roe, to protest our saying that the Constitution requires what our society has never thought the Constitution requires. These people who refuse to be "tested by following" must be taught a lesson. We have no Cossacks, but at least we can stubbornly refuse to abandon an erroneous opinion that we might otherwise change-to show how little they intimidate us. . . . We should get out of this area, where we have no right to be, and where we do neither ourselves nor the country any good by remaining. Scalia, Justice Antonin. “Liberty and Abortion: A Strict Constructionist’s View”. Ed. Peter Woll. New York. Pearson Longman, 2004. 444-445. Unit VI- Public Policy I want to make a policy statement. I am unabashedly in favor of women. Lyndon B. Johnson Assignments Chapter 15, 16, 16, 17, 20, 21 Study Guides (Most are short so don’t freak out !) Public Policy Project Assessments Unit Exam Multiple Choice and FRQs Secondary Readings Will- Why Didn’t Bush Ask Congress? Easterbrook- Some Convenient Truths Chapter 15 Study Questions The Policy Making Process 1. How are certain issues (at certain times) placed on the public agenda for action? 2. Define the following terms as used in this chapter: a) costs; b) benefits; c) perception 3. Use the above terms to explain the four types of politics presented in the text: majoritarian, client, interest group, and entrepreneurial. 4. Discuss the roles played in the process of public policy formation by people’s perceptions, beliefs, interests, and values. Terms to Know Poltical agendas costs benefit majoritarian politics interest group policy client politics pork barrel projects logrolling entrepreneurial politics policy entrepreneurs boycott process regulation Occupational Safety and Health Act (OSHA) Superfund Sherman Act Federal Trade Commission Act Clayton Act The Grange Wagner Act National Labor Relations Board Pure Food and Drug Act deregulation Public Policy Project You will be assigned one of the following policy areas to research: Economic Policy (Ch. 16) Social Welfare Policy (Ch. 17) Foreign and Military Policy (Ch. 20) Environmental Policy (Ch 21) Begin by reading about the Policy-Making Process in general from Ch. 15 in your textbook. Then, using your textbook, the Internet, library materials, and other resources available to you, thoroughly research your policy area paying attention to 1) historical development, 2) current policy, 3) issues at debate. Next, having researched your assigned policy area, develop your own opinion in regard to the appropriateness, and/or efficacy of current policy. Express your opinion in 5-paragraph essay format. The results of your research and thought will be presented in two ways: an individual student paper, and a group presentation. Individual paper requirements: a. Title Page b. Historical Development section (1-3 pages) c. Current Policy section (1-3 Pages) d. Issues-at-debate section (1-3 pages) e. Position Essay (1-2 pages)—defend a position related to one of the issues-at-debate. (Special Note- This will replace the normal Prompted Essay assignment for the week!) f. Visual Aid (graph, chart, drawing, etc.) that you create and that helps explain or illustrate some key point of your paper. Note: this is separate from whatever visual your group might have uses in their presentation g. Bibliography (MLA Format) All papers must be typed, double-spaced (12 point font, 1 inch margins) and properly documented (MLA). Submit a hard copy of your paper to Mr. Guemmer or an electronic copy through Classjump. You should work in cooperation with others in the class who have been assigned the same policy area, but each student is to complete an individual report on a specific issue if possible (“sharing” information is O.K., but write your own paper, using your own words) Wherever possible, your discussion of your specific policy area should reflect an understanding of the policymaking process in general as discussed in Ch. 15 of your textbook (I will look for key terms and concepts, e.g. “majoritarian politics,” “client politics,” etc.). Chapter 16 Study Questions Economic Policy 1. Summarize how economics affects politics and how politicians respond. 2. How do two kinds of majoritarian politics complicate the politics of taxing and spending? 3. Summarize the following economic theories: Monetarism, Keynesianism, economic planning, industrial policy, supply-side, Reaganomics. 4. Define fiscal policy, budget deficit, budget surplus, monetary policy, and fiscal year. 5. Summarize the role of the CEA, OMB and secretary of the treasury. 6. What are the two sides of the debate on free trade? 7. How did the Congressional Budget Act of 1974 change the budget process? In your answer indicate how the budget process is supposed to work. 8. What are entitlements? What impact do they have on the federal budget? 9. What was in the Gramm-Rudman Act or Balanced Budget Act of 1985? Define sequester. What strategy was adopted when sequestration didn’t work? 10. Using the handout, define gross domestic product, recession, fiscal policy, discretionary spending, mandatory spending 11. How did the Budget Enforcement Act of 1990 reform the process? 12. Define tax loopholes, progressive tax, marginal rate, regressive tax, sin taxes, flat tax, capital-gains tax (from handout) 13. What is the main function of the Federal Reserve and what are the three main tools they at their disposal to implement their policies? Make sure you know this. (Of course, that’s true for everything….) Adam Smith Arthur Laffer Budget deficit Budget Resolution budget surplus Council of Economic Advisers (CEA) Economic planning entitlements Federal Reserve Fiscal policy Fiscal Year (FY) Inflation John Maynard Keynes Terms to Know Keynesianism Milton Friedman Monetary policy North American Free Trade Agreement (NAFTA) Monetarism Opportunity costs Price and wage controls Reaganomics Recession Scarcity sequester Substitutability Supply-side theory Chapter 17 Social Welfare 1. Describe the goals of the welfare system. 2. Contrast its programs with those of the British in terms of centralization. 3. Describe the major elements of the system, including the Social Security Act of 1935, the Medicare Act of 1965, and the abolition of the Aid to Families with Dependent Children (AFDC) program. 4. Why are some welfare policies considered majoritarian politics and other client politics? 5. Give examples and indicate the political consequences of each. Discuss the politics of welfare reform. Terms to Know Majoritarian politics client politics insurance program assistance program means test Earned Income Tax Credit service strategy income strategy Social Security Act Medicare Chapter 20 Foreign and Military Policy 1. List the constitutional powers of the president and compare them with the authority of Congress in foreign affairs. 2. Why is it naïve to read the Constitution literally with regards to foreign affairs? 3. Explain the changing role of public opinion in shaping foreign policy. 4. Why are checks on the powers of the national government in foreign affairs primarily political rather than constitutional? 5. Analyze the key allocative decisions about the defense budget. 6. According to George Will, what were the justifications the Bush Administration used to order the NSA to start electronic surveillance following 9/11? 7. Looking back, did the Bush Administration, at the time and based on their interpretation of the Constitution, have a strong argument for electronic surveillance? Could that interpretation be used by the current administration? Why or why not? Terms to Know Military-industrial complex “Peace dividend” “World’s policeman” Joint Chiefs of Staff (JCS) Armed Services Committees Strategic defense Initiative (SDI) or “Star Wars” Intercontinental ballistic missiles (ICBMS) Mutual assured destruction (MAD) “Don ask, don’t tell” Cost overruns Gold plating Readiness Commission on Base Realignment and closure (BRAC) National Security Act (1947) Chain of Command Goldwater-Nichols Act (1986) Chapter 21 Environmental Policy Why is environmental policy frequently controversial? Outline the major provisions of the Clean Air Act (1970), the Water Quality Improvement Act (1970), the revised Clean Air Act (1990), and the National Environmental Policy Act (1969). What political point of view does Gregg Easterbrook have in regards to Global Warming and the United States environmental policies? Does he have any points that you agree with? What parts of his arguments are not particularly strong? Terms to Know Clean Air Act (1963) Auto emission standards Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) (1970) Water Quality Improvement Act (1970) Endangered Species Act (1973) Kyoto Protocol Smog toxic Waste Acid Rain Environmental impact statement (EIS) Why Didn't Bush Ask Congress? By George Will WASHINGTON -- The president's authorization of domestic surveillance by the National Security Agency contravened a statute's clear language. Assuming that urgent facts convinced him that he should proceed anyway and on his own, what argument convinced him that he lawfully could? Presumably the argument is that the president's implied powers as commander in chief, particularly with the nation under attack and some of the enemy within the gates, are not limited by statutes. A classified legal brief probably makes an argument akin to one Attorney General John Ashcroft made in 2002: ``The Constitution vests in the president inherent authority to conduct warrantless intelligence surveillance (electronic or otherwise) of foreign powers or their agents, and Congress cannot by statute extinguish that constitutional authority.'' Perhaps the brief argues, as its author John Yoo -- now a professor of law at Berkeley, but then a deputy assistant attorney general -- argued 14 days after 9/11 in a memorandum on ``the president's constitutional authority to conduct military operations against terrorists and nations supporting them,'' that the president's constitutional power to take ``military actions'' is ``plenary.'' The Oxford English Dictionary defines ``plenary'' as ``complete, entire, perfect, not deficient in any element or respect.'' The brief should be declassified and debated, beginning with this question: Who decides which tactics -- e.g., domestic surveillance -- should be considered part of taking ``military actions''? Without more information than can be publicly available concerning threats from enemies operating in America, the executive branch deserves considerable discretion in combating terrorist conspiracies utilizing new technologies such as cell phones and the Internet. In September 2001 the president surely had sound reasons for desiring the surveillance capabilities at issue. But did he have sound reasons for seizing them while giving only minimal information to, and having no formal complicity with, Congress? Perhaps. But Congress, if asked, almost certainly would have made such modifications of law as the president's plans required. Courts, too, would have been compliant. After all, on Sept. 14, 2001, Congress had unanimously declared that ``the president has authority under the Constitution to take action to deter and prevent acts of international terrorism,'' and had authorized ``all necessary and appropriate force'' against those involved in 9/11 or threatening future attacks. For more than 500 years -- since the rise of nation-states and parliaments -- a preoccupation of Western political thought has been the problem of defining and confining executive power. The problem is expressed in the title of a brilliant book, ``Taming the Prince: The Ambivalence of Modern Executive Power,'' by Harvey Mansfield, Harvard's conservative. Particularly in time of war or the threat of it, government needs concentrated decisiveness -- a capacity for swift and nimble action that legislatures normally cannot manage. But the inescapable corollary of this need is the danger of arbitrary power. Modern American conservatism grew in reaction against the New Deal's creation of the regulatory state, and the enlargement of the executive branch power that such a state entails. The intellectual vigor of conservatism was quickened by reaction against the Great Society and the aggrandizement of the modern presidency by Lyndon Johnson, whose aspiration was to complete the project begun by Franklin Roosevelt. Because of what Alexander Hamilton praised as ``energy in the executive,'' which often drives the growth of government, for years many conservatives were advocates of congressional supremacy. There were, they said, reasons why the Founders, having waged a revolutionary war against overbearing executive power, gave the legislative branch pride of place in Article I of the Constitution. One reason was that Congress' cumbersomeness, which is a function of its fractiousness, is a virtue because it makes the government slow and difficult to move. But conservatives' wholesome wariness of presidential power has been a casualty of conservative presidents winning seven of the last 10 elections. On the assumption that Congress or a court would have been cooperative in September 2001, and that the cooperation could have kept necessary actions clearly lawful without conferring any benefit on the nation's enemies, the president's decision to authorize NSA's surveillance without the complicity of a court or Congress was a mistake. Perhaps one caused by this administration's almost metabolic urge to keep Congress unnecessarily distant and hence disgruntled. Charles de Gaulle, a profound conservative, said of another such, Otto von Bismarck -- de Gaulle was thinking of Bismarck not pressing his advantage in 1870 in the Franco-Prussian War -- that genius sometimes consists of knowing when to stop. In peace and in war, but especially in the latter, presidents have pressed their institutional advantages to expand their powers to act without Congress. This president might look for occasions to stop pressing. © 2005, Washington Post Writers Group Some Convenient Truths Runaway global warming looks all but unstoppable. Maybe that’s because we haven’t really tried to stop it by Gregg Easterbrook If there is now a scientific consensus that global warming must be taken seriously, there is also a related political consensus: that the issue is Gloom City. In An Inconvenient Truth, Al Gore warns of sea levels rising to engulf New York and San Francisco and implies that only wrenching lifestyle sacrifice can save us. The opposing view is just as glum. Even mild restrictions on greenhouse gases could “cripple our economy,” Republican Senator Kit Bond of Missouri said in 2003. Other conservatives suggest that greenhouse-gas rules for Americans would be pointless anyway, owing to increased fossil-fuel use in China and India. When commentators hash this issue out, it’s often a contest to see which side can sound more pessimistic. Here’s a different way of thinking about the greenhouse effect: that action to prevent runaway global warming may prove cheap, practical, effective, and totally consistent with economic growth. Which makes a body wonder: Why is such environmental optimism absent from American political debate? Greenhouse gases are an air-pollution problem—and all previous air-pollution problems have been reduced faster and more cheaply than predicted, without economic harm. Some of these problems once seemed scary and intractable, just as greenhouse gases seem today. About forty years ago urban smog was increasing so fast that President Lyndon Johnson warned, “Either we stop poisoning our air or we become a nation [in] gas masks groping our way through dying cities.” During Ronald Reagan’s presidency, emissions of chlorofluorocarbons, or CFCs, threatened to deplete the stratospheric ozone layer. As recently as George H. W. Bush’s administration, acid rain was said to threaten a “new silent spring” of dead Appalachian forests. But in each case, strong regulations were enacted, and what happened? Since 1970, smog-forming air pollution has declined by a third to a half. Emissions of CFCs have been nearly eliminated, and studies suggest that ozone-layer replenishment is beginning. Acid rain, meanwhile, has declined by a third since 1990, while Appalachian forest health has improved sharply. Most progress against air pollution has been cheaper than expected. Smog controls on automobiles, for example, were predicted to cost thousands of dollars for each vehicle. Today’s new cars emit less than 2 percent as much smog-forming pollution as the cars of 1970, and the cars are still as affordable today as they were then. Acid-rain control has cost about 10 percent of what was predicted in 1990, when Congress enacted new rules. At that time, opponents said the regulations would cause a “clean-air recession”; instead, the economy boomed. Greenhouse gases, being global, are the biggest air-pollution problem ever faced. And because widespread fossil-fuel use is inevitable for some time to come, the best-case scenario for the next few decades may be a slowing of the rate of greenhouse-gas buildup, to prevent runaway climate change. Still, the basic pattern observed in all other forms of air-pollution control—rapid progress at low cost—should repeat for greenhouse-gas controls. Yet a paralyzing negativism dominates global-warming politics. Environmentalists depict climate change as nearly unstoppable; skeptics speak of the problem as either imaginary (the “greatest hoax ever perpetrated,” in the words of Senator James Inhofe, chairman of the Senate’s environment committee) or ruinously expensive to address. Even conscientious politicians may struggle for views that aren’t dismal. Mandy Grunwald, a Democratic political consultant, says, “When political candidates talk about new energy sources, they use a positive, can- do vocabulary. Voters have personal experience with energy use, so they can relate to discussion of solutions. If you say a car can use a new kind of fuel, this makes intuitive sense to people. But global warming is of such scale and magnitude, people don’t have any commonsense way to grasp what the solutions would be. So political candidates tend to talk about the greenhouse effect in a depressing way.” One reason the global-warming problem seems so daunting is that the success of previous antipollution efforts remains something of a secret. Polls show that Americans think the air is getting dirtier, not cleaner, perhaps because media coverage of the environment rarely if ever mentions improvements. For instance, did you know that smog and acid rain have continued to diminish throughout George W. Bush’s presidency? One might expect Democrats to trumpet the decline of air pollution, which stands as one of government’s leading postwar achievements. But just as Republicans have found they can bash Democrats by falsely accusing them of being soft on defense, Democrats have found they can bash Republicans by falsely accusing them of destroying the environment. If that’s your argument, you might skip over the evidence that many environmental trends are positive. One might also expect Republicans to trumpet the reduction of air pollution, since it signifies responsible behavior by industry. But to acknowledge that air pollution has declined would require Republicans to say the words, “The regulations worked.” Does it matter that so many in politics seem so pessimistic about the prospect of addressing global warming? Absolutely. Making the problem appear unsolvable encourages a sort of listless fatalism, blunting the drive to take first steps toward a solution. Historically, first steps against air pollution have often led to pleasant surprises. When Congress, in 1970, mandated major reductions in smog caused by automobiles, even many supporters of the rule feared it would be hugely expensive. But the catalytic converter was not practical then; soon it was perfected, and suddenly, major reductions in smog became affordable. Even a small step by the United States against greenhouse gases could lead to a similar breakthrough. And to those who worry that any greenhouse-gas reductions in the United States will be swamped by new emissions from China and India, here’s a final reason to be optimistic: technology can move across borders with considerable speed. Today it’s not clear that American inventors or entrepreneurs can make money by reducing greenhouse gases, so relatively few are trying. But suppose the United States regulated greenhouse gases, using its own domestic program, not the cumbersome Kyoto Protocol; then America’s formidable entrepreneurial and engineering communities would fully engage the problem. Innovations pioneered here could spread throughout the world, and suddenly rapid global warming would not seem inevitable. The two big technical advances against smog—the catalytic converter and the chemical engineering that removes pollutants from gasoline at the refinery stage—were invented in the United States. The big economic advance against acid rain—a credit-trading system that gives power-plant managers a profit incentive to reduce pollution—was pioneered here as well. These advances are now spreading globally. Smog and acid rain are still increasing in some parts of the world, but the trend lines suggest that both will decline fairly soon, even in developing nations. For instance, two decades ago urban smog was rising at a dangerous rate in Mexico; today it is diminishing there, though the country’s population continues to grow. A short time ago declining smog and acid rain in developing nations seemed an impossibility; today declining greenhouse gases seem an impossibility. The history of air-pollution control says otherwise. Americans love challenges, and preventing artificial climate change is just the sort of technological and economic challenge at which this nation excels. It only remains for the right politician to recast the challenge in practical, optimistic tones. Gore seldom has, and Bush seems to have no interest in trying. But cheap and fast improvement is not a pipe dream; it is the pattern of previous efforts against air pollution. The only reason runaway global warming seems unstoppable is that we have not yet tried to stop it. Unit VII- Civil Liberties – Civil Rights “To announce that there must be no criticism of the president, or that we are to stand by the president right or wrong, is not only unpatriotic and servile, but is morally treasonable to the American public. “ Theodore Roosevelt Assignments Study Guide for Chapter 18 and 19 Supreme Decisions- Civil Rights Project Assessments Unit IX Exam Ch 18 & 19- Multiple Choice and FRQs Secondary Readings Williams- Proposition 209 Chapter 18 Study Questions Civil Liberties. 1. What are the three reasons why the liberties claimed by some people become major issues? Give one or two examples for each reason. 2. Explain briefly how the Supreme Court has interpreted the Free Exercise and Establishment clauses. 3. What are the difficulties in using the “wall of separation” principle? 4. List and explain the circumstances when the Supreme Court has ruled that freedom of speech may be limited. 5. Define the “clear-and-present-danger test,” libel, preferred position, prior restraint, imminent danger, and symbolic speech. You may just want to put these straight onto your flashcards 6. Summarize the Supreme Court’s changing interpretations of how to protect both the due process rights of accused criminals and to preserve the safety of the community. Define the exclusionary rule and the “good faith exception.”. Terms to Know Civil Liberties McCarthyism Incorporation Doctrine* Fourteenth Amendment Equal protection clause* Due process clause* Selective Incorporation* Preferred freedoms* Establishment Clause* Free Exercise Clause* Wall of Separation Principle Lemon Test* Equal Access Act Parochial Schools School Vouchers Freedom of Expression* Oliver Wendell Holmes “Clear and Present Danger” “time, place, and manner” restrictions* Symbolic Speech* “Hate Crime” Speech codes Prior Restraint* Libel* “actual malice” Obscenity “Community standards” “Prurient interests” Preferred position Imminent danger* Neutrality and Clarity Least-restrictive means John Peter Zenger Pentagon Papers Slander Commercial speech Right to assemble Right to associate* Search warrant Indictment* Grand Jury* Substantive due process* Procedural due process Probable cause* Exclusionary rule* “fruit of the poison tree” “good faith” exception* Miranda rights Capital Punishment Self-incrimination* Patriot Act Chapter 19 Study Questions Civil Rights 1. Why did ratification of the Equal Rights Amendment prove impossible, despite strong congressional and popular support? What does the book say is the pertinent question regarding civil rights? 2. What were the strategies that black leaders followed in order to obtain civil rights? Once basic rights such as voting and integration had been obtained, what issues did civil rights leaders focus on? 3. Briefly outline the steps in the NAACP’s strategy in the fight against segregated schools and indicate the success they had in the courts and in implementing desegregation. 4. What was the issue concerning desegregation vs. integration? How has this issue been resolved? 5. What were the four developments that made it possible to pass civil rights bills? 6. What accounts for the change in attitude in Congress towards civil rights issues from the 1960s to the present? 7. How has the Supreme Court changed in its attitudes towards equal rights for women from the early 20th century to today? What are the two standards the Court uses today to in considering sex discrimination cases? 8. What is the debate between those who support “equality of result” and those who support “equality of opportunity”? 9. What are the criteria that the Supreme Court has adapted in defining strict scrutiny of any law involving racial preferences? 10. Briefly summarize the highlights of the government’s response to abortion. 11. How did activists for the disabled manage to get The Americans with Disabilities Act passed? Briefly summarize what is included in the law and the objections that some have had to the law. 12. In Walter Williams’s article, he expressed a very strong opinion regarding Proposition 209. Summarize his argument and express your own opinions on the subject. Terms to Know Civil Rights Suspect classifications* Strict Scrutiny and semi-strict scrutiny* Reasonabless or rationality standard* Jim Crow laws* “equal protections of the laws” “separate but equal” “with all deliberate speed” Segregation and desegregation * integration* de jure segregation de facto segregation Civil disobedience Civil Rights Act of 1957 Equal Pay Act of 1963 Civil Rights Act of 1964* Voting Rights Act of 1965* Reverse discrimination* “Equality of opportunity: “Equality of result” Open Housing Act of 1968 (Title VIII) Higher Education Act of 1972 (Title IX) * Education of All Handicapped Children Act of 1975) Voting Rights Act of 1982 Civil Rights Act of 1988 American with Disabilities Act of 1990* Sexual harassment Equal Employment Opportunities Commission Equal Rights Amendment* Right to privacy* Affirmative Action* Quotas and preferences Compensatory action “compelling government interest” * “narrowly tailored” * Concurring opinion* Dissenting opinion* “comparable worth” Supreme Court Cases for this unit Incorporation Barron v. Baltimore (1833) *Gitlow v. New York (1925) Near v. Minnesota (1931) Palko v. Connecticut (1937) Freedom of Religion: Establishment Clause *Everson v. Board of Education (1942) *Lemon v. Kurtzman (1971) Westside Community Schools v. Mergens (1990) Santa Fe Independent School District v. Doe (2000) Ten Commandments cases: McCreary County, KY v. American Civil Liberties Union of Kentucky and Van Orden v. Perry (2005) Freedom of Religion: Free Exercise Clause Reynolds v. United States (1879) Sherbert v. Verner (1963) Employment Division, Department of Human Resources of Oregon v. Smith (1990) Church of the Lukuani Babalu Ave., v. City of Hialeah (1993) Freedom of Speech and Press *Schenck v. United States (1919) *Gitlow v. New York (1925) Near v. Minnesota (1931) New York Times Co. v. Sullivan (1964) *Tinker v. Des Moines Independent Community School District (1969) *New York Times Co. v. U.S. (1971) Miller v. California (1973) Hazelwood School District v. Kuhlmeier (1988) Texas v. Johnson (1989) Freedom of Assembly and Petition NAACP v. Alabama (1958) Boy Scouts of American v. Dale (2000) 2nd Amendment rights District of Columbia v. Heller (2008) Due Process and the Rights of the Accused *Mapp v. Ohio (1961) *Gideon v. Wainwright (1963) *Miranda v. Arizona (1966) Death Penalty cases: Furman v. Georgia (1972) and Gregg v. Georgia (1976) New Jersey v. T.L.O (1985) Equal Protection of the Laws – Minorities *Plessy v. Ferguson (1896) *Korematsu v. United States (1944) *Brown v. Board of Education of Topeka (1954) *Regents of the University of California v. Bakke (1978) Lawrence v. Texas (2003) Grutter v. Bollinger (2003) and Gratz v. Bollinger (2003) Equal Protection of the Laws – Women and the Rights to Privacy and Abortion *Griswold v. Connecticut (1965) Reed v. Reed (1971) *Roe v. Wade (1973) Webster v. Reproductive Health Services (1989) Planned Parenthood v. Casey (1992) Gonzales v. Carhart (2007) * indicates you should know this case by name. You can know them by their shorthand name such as Plessy or Bakke. For the others knowing them by name would be ideal, but is not required. Its more important to understand the cases and their ramifications. Supreme Decision Project (Civil Rights) The Process The Procedure: Get into a group of six people. Enter the lottery and win your choice of a landmark Supreme Court case. Research your case. Find out the story behind the case. What really happened to cause this case to come to the court. Read the text of the court’s majority opinion. Possible sources: In the Reference section (these do not circulate, so they will always be there!): Landmark Decisions of the United States Supreme Court (Five volumes), R 347.7326. Johnson, John W., Editor. Historic U.S. Court Cases, 1690-1990: An Encyclopedia, R 349.73026. Knappman, Edward W., Editor. Great American Trials: From Salem Witchcraft to Rodney King. R 347.737 Internet: http://supct.law.cornell.edu/supct/ http://www.fedworld.gov/supcourt/csearch.htm THE PRODUCT: Each person in the group will: Write a one page legal brief for your case which will be presented in typed form. o Create a presentation which supplies all of the facts regarding your case BEFORE it came to the Court. You may NOT have actual Supreme Court room scenes in your drama. This will be presented by your group in the formal setting of a drama. You may present your project as a live performance complete with props and costumes or as a video documentary. Remember that your goal is to enlighten your audience. Of course, it's nice to be entertained too! Your presentation must be 10 minutes in length. Projects will be presented on: Grading will be based on: Variety, quality, and breadth of scholarly research Historical accuracy of information presented Clarity of expression, both written and oral Creativity of presentation, not of factual information Effective conveying of information to the class Incorporation of legal precedents and issues rather than your opinions Length of presentation (10 minutes). Major penalties will be assessed to presentations that are too short. For subjects that are controversial, how you TASTEFULLY present the facts of the case. How to Write a Legal Brief There will be three parts to your legal brief regarding your landmark Supreme Court Case. They are: Statement of the case: State the question to be settled by the court. For example, Shall there be mandatory testing for AIDS for all pregnant women? Summary of the argument: Summarize the pro and con arguments. This will state the principles involved in the case. Conclusion of the court: State the principle which the court handed down in its majority opinion. For example, There will be no mandatory testing for AIDS for all pregnant women. Format: The brief will include the title of the case and everybody's name in your group (in the upper-right corner). Your case’s brief must be two pages (limited to one piece of paper, both sides). The brief must be typed, double spaced. The brief must have the lines numbered down the left column of the page (for reference purposes) Proposition 209 Walter E. Williams, June 5, 1997 California voters passed the California Civil Rights Initiative of 1996, more popularly known as Proposition 209 that says, "The state shall not discriminate against, or grant preferential treatment to, any individual or group on the basis of race, sex, color, ethnicity, or national origin in the operation of public employment, public education, or public contracting." The spirit of Proposition 209 is identical to the Civil Rights Act of 1964: "No person in the United States shall, on the grounds of race, color, or national origin, be excluded from participation in, be denied the benefits of, or be subject to discrimination under any program or activity receiving federal financial assistance." Through logical contortionism, liberals and the civil rights establishment praise the Civil Rights Act of 1964 and condemn Proposition 209 as racist and unconstitutional. Let's look at some of Proposition 209's initial results. Recently released acceptance figures, by UCLA's School of Law, show that only 21 black applicants were accepted, down 80 percent from the 104 accepted the previous year. At UC Berkeley's Law School, of the 792 students accepted this year, there were only 14 blacks compared to 75 last year. There were also declines in the number of Mexican-American students accepted. At each school, the number of white and Asian students accepted rose. How should people concerned with the upward mobility of blacks and Mexican-Americans respond? One strategy is to try to overturn Proposition 209. The first attempt to do so failed where the 9th Circuit Court of Appeals overruled a lower court's preliminary injunction. Another strategy is to support President Clinton's legal manipulation to "mend not end" affirmative action. A far superior strategy emerges if we ask why blacks need preferential treatment in the first place. We darn sure don't need preferential treatment to be in, and in fact dominate, the NBA or the NFL. It all has to do with excellence. If blacks graduated from college with the same grade point averages and LSAT scores there'd be no question, they'd be admitted to law schools at the same rate as whites and Asians. Nobody has claimed that law schools are turning away blacks with academic credentials equal to and higher than whites and Asians. The truth of the matter is that too many blacks receive twelve years of fraudulent primary and secondary education that cannot be overcome by four years of college. Unfortunately, liberals and civil rights organizations add to that disaster by giving unquestioned support to a corrupt education establishment that produces the fraud. Any kind of effective education reform, including educational vouchers, tuition tax credits and even private voucher programs, are fought tooth and nail. I reject the notion that blacks need preferential treatment. What's needed is more of what my friend Mr. Alfred Jenkins, a retired Los Angeles Assistant District Attorney, is doing. Al is concerned about the problems blacks have passing the bar examination, but he doesn't charge the exam as racist or culturally biased. He conducts a free intensive tutorial program. To give you a flavor of his approach, he asks students, "How many hours can you study for the bar each day?" Students might respond with 6 hours, 10 hours and so forth. Then Al asks, "If I had an Uzi pointed at your head, how long could you study?" Then he says, "Tell your friends and family goodbye, eliminate any other distractions and pretend there's an Uzi pointed at your head." Jenkins has chalked up a phenomenal success record. Unlike white liberals and the civil rights establishment, Al and I have confidence in black abilities. Walter E. Williams June 5, 1997 Unit I: Introduction to Economic Concepts Capital Capital good Capitalism Command economy Competition Consumer good Consumer sovereignty Cost benefit analysis Division of labor Economic growth Economic interdependence Economic Product Economic system Economics Economy Entrepreneur Factor market Factors of production Financial capital Fixed income Free enterprise Free enterprise economy Good Gross Domestic Product Human capital Inflation Labor Land Market Market economy Mixed economy Modified private enterprise economy Need Opportunity cost Paradox of value Private property rights Product market Production Production possibilities frontier Productivity Profit Profit motive Scarcity Service Social Security Specialization Standard of living Trade-off Traditional economy Unit Terms Utility Value Voluntary exchange Want Wealth Major Ideas What is Economics What are Three Basic Economic Questions What are the Four Factors of Production What is the difference between a need and a want What are the Seven major Goals of the US Economy What were the major ideas and contributions of Adam Smith and Karl Marx to Economic theory? Major Assignments Chapters 1 and 2- Economics Text Summer Assignment o Current Events o Comparison Essay Adam Smith and the Origin of Capitalism The Communist Manifesto- Karl Marx, Friedrich Engels o Textbook Reading and Review o Local Business Project Local Business Project (Poster or Powerpoint and Spoken Presentation) 40 points for Visual, 20 points for Spoken Presentation) Presentations will be given in alphabetical order of the name of the business NAME OF THE BUSINESS: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Why did you research this business? List the natural resources needed for this business List the capital goods needed for this business List the type of labor required for this business ( manager, cashier, cook, etc. . ) Who was the Entrepreneur (Either the Business Founder or local Franchise owner) a. When did he/she start this business locally? How does this business reduce costs? With whom or with what does this business compete (may not be local) a. What makes this business different from its local competition? How does this business market itself (advertise)? How has current, either nationally or regionally, economy effected this business? How have local and state regulations helped or hindered the growth of this business? Looking forward, what will happen to this business in the future? A. Projects will have all Basic Questions answered in your Poster/Powerpoint and Presentation with as much specific information as possible. B. It is encouraged, but not required that you have photos, actual advertisements, pamphlets, job applications, and other useful documents from the business you researched Your Project will be graded on the following Criteria 1. Completeness- Are all the basic questions answered as fully as possible. 2. Professionalism- Is it neat, clean, spelled correctly 3. Creativity- Does your project clearly show that you spent considerable time working on this project. If you wish to create a power point for this project, copy your files onto a flash drive for the purposes of presenting it either the first or second day of class. Tips for Success on this Project 1. Start Early 2. Be polite and introduce yourself to the Owner/Manager, explain what your assignment and what information you require. 3. Try to fit the Owner/Manager’s schedule, if they are busy, they will be less likely to help you. 4. Don’t get discouraged, some businesses will not want to give you information, it might be their corporate policy. 5. Thank the Owner/Manager when you are finished, they are doing you a favor Bankruptcy Better business bureau Bond break even point Cash flow Chamber of commerce Change in demand Change in quantity demanded Change in quantity supplied Change in supply Charter stock Collective bargaining Complements Conglomerate Co-op Cooperative Corporation Credit union Demand Demand curve Demand elasticity Demand schedule Depreciation Diminishing marginal utility Diminishing returns Dividend Double taxation e-commerce Elastic Unit II America’s Market Economy Elasticity Fixed cost Horizontal merger Income effect Income statement Inelastic Interest Inventory Labor union Law of Supply Law of Variable proportions Limited life Limited partnership Long run marginal analysis Marginal cost Marginal product marginal revenue Marginal utility Market supply curve Merger Microeconomics Multinational Net income Nonprofit organization Overhead Partnership Principal Production function Professional association profit maximizing quantity of output Proprietorship Public utility Quantity supplied Raw materials Shareholder Short run Sole proprietorship Stages of production Stockholder Subsidy Substitutes Substitution effect Supply Supply curve Supply elasticity Supply schedule Theory of production Total cost Total product total revenue Unit elastic Unlimited liability Variable cost Vertical merger Major Concepts What are the three basic types of businesses and what are their advantages and disadvantages What is demand? What is the difference between a change in demand and a change in quantity demanded? How is the elasticity of a good or service determined? What is supply? What are the three stages of production in relation to supply? Major Assignments Supply and Demand Determinants Essay Self-Business Project Supply and Demand Exam 401K plan Assets Balance sheet Bank holiday Barter economy Bear market Bill consolidation loans Bull market Call Capital market Central bank Certificate of deposit Coins Collusion Commercial bank Commodity money coupon Credit union Creditor Currency current yield Deficiency payment Demand deposit account Deregulation Discount rate Dow Jones Industrial Average Economic model Economies of scale Efficient market Equilibrium price Equities Federal Reserve system Fiat money Finance company Financial asset Financial intermediary Financial system Fractional reserve Futures contract Futures market Geographic monopoly Gold certificate Gold standard Government monopoly Imperfect competition Inconvertible fiat money standard Unit III Markets, Prices, and Business Competition Individual Retirement Account (IRA) Price Laissez-faire Price ceiling Legal reserves Price floor Legal tender Price-fixing Liabilities Primary market Liquidity Product differentiation Loose money policy Put option Margin requirement Ration coupon Market equilibrium Rationing Market structure Real estate investment trust maturity Rebate Measure of value Reserve requirement Medium of exchange Risk Member bank Roth IRA Member bank reserve Run on the bank Minimum wage Saving Monetary policy Savings Monetary standard Savings account Monetary unit Savings and loan association Money (S&L) Money market Savings bank Monopolistic competition savings bond Monopoly Secondary market municipal bond Securities exchange Mutual fund Share draft accounts Mutual savings bank Shortage National bank Silver certificate National bank note Specie National currency Spot market Natural monopoly Standard and Poors Net asset value State bank Net worth Stockbroker Non price competition Store of value Non-bank financial institution Surplus Nonrecourse loan Target price NOW accounts tax-exempt Oligopoly Technological monopoly Open market operations Thrift institutions Option Tight money policy Option Treasury bill Options market Treasury coin note Over the counter market Treasury note par value United States note Pension Pension fund Perfect competition Portfolio diversification Premium Major Concepts How do price floors and price ceilings restrict overall supply and demand for goods and services? What are the five characteristics of a perfect competition? What are the different types of monopolies? What is the structure of the Federal Reserve? What are the three major tools of monetary policy? Major Assignments Self Project with Presentations Markets and Financial Institutions Test Unit IV: Government in the American Economy Accelerator Aggregate demand Aggregate supply Automation Base year Business cycles Business fluctuation Capital to labor ratio Consumer price index Creeping inflation Current GDP Cyclical unemployment Deflation Depression Depression scrip Disposable income Earned income tax credit Econometric model Enterprise zone Expansion Family Fiscal policy Food stamps Frictional unemployment Galloping inflation GDP in constant dollars Gross Domestic Product Gross National Product Growth triangle Household Hyperinflation Implicit GDP price deflator Index of leading indicators Inflation Intermediate products Keynesian economics Labor productivity Laffer curve Lorenz curve How is GDP measured What are the various stages of the business cycle? What are the various types of unemployment? Major Assignments Econ Midterm Macroeconomic equilibrium Market basket Monetarism Multiplier National income National income accounting Negative income tax Net exports of goods and services Net national product Nonmarket transactions Output-expenditure model Peak Personal income Personal income Poverty guidelines Price index Price level Producer price index Real GDP Recession Renewable resources Seasonal unemployment Second hand sales Standard of living Structural unemployment Tax base Technological unemployment Trend line Trough Underground economy Unemployed Unemployment rate Unrelated individual Wage-price controls Welfare Workfare Absolute advantage ASEAN Black market Capital flight Capitalism Collectivization Communism Comparative advantage Default Developing country Dumping EU Exports External debt Fixed exchange rate Flexible exchange rate Foreign exchange Free traders Major Assignments Economics Midterm Stock Project Unit V International Economics IMF Imports Infant industries Life expectancy NAFTA Privatization Protectionists Protective tariff Quota Revenue tariff Socialism Tariff Trade deficit Trade surplus Trade-weighted value of the dollar World Bank World Trade Organization Zero population